| United States Patent Application |
20090180987
|
| Kind Code
|
A1
|
|
Stritzker; Jochen Harald
;   et al.
|
July 16, 2009
|
Methods and compositions for detection of microorganisms and cells and
treatment of diseases and disorders
Abstract
Methods for detecting a microorganism or cell in a subject and methods for
detecting, imaging or diagnosing a site, disease, disorder or condition
in a subject using microorganisms or cells and methods that
microorganisms or cells for treating a disease, disorder or condition are
provided. Sites, diseases and disorders include sites of cell
proliferation, proliferative conditions, neoplasms, tumors, neoplastic
disease, wounds and inflammation. Also provided are microorganisms and
cells for use in the methods and compositions, combinations and kits,
including diagnostic and pharmaceutical compositions, containing a
microorganism or cell.
| Inventors: |
Stritzker; Jochen Harald; (Kissing, DE)
; Hill; Phil; (Nottingham, GB)
; Szalay; Aladar A.; (Highland, CA)
; Yu; Yong A.; (San Diego, CA)
|
| Correspondence Name and Address:
|
K&L Gates LLP
3580 Carmel Mountain Road, Suite 200
San Diego
CA
92130
US
|
| Serial No.:
|
008659 |
| Series Code:
|
12
|
| Filed:
|
January 11, 2008 |
| U.S. Current Class: |
424/93.2; 424/93.48 |
| U.S. Class at Publication: |
424/93.2; 424/93.48 |
| Intern'l Class: |
A61K 35/74 20060101 A61K035/74 |
Claims
1. A method for converting a prodrug to an active form,
comprising:administering a Nissle strain Escherichia coli bacteria to a
subject with a tumor, wherein Nissle bacterium encodes a prodrug
converting enzyme for converting a prodrug into an active form;
andadministering a prodrug that is converted by the enzyme, whereby an
active form of the prodrug is produced.
2. The method of claim 1, wherein an active form of the prodrug is a
cytotoxin.
3. The method of claim 1, wherein the Nissle bacterium is administered
systemically.
4. The method of claim 1, wherein the Nissle bacterium is administered
intravenously.
5. The method of claim 1, wherein the prodrug is administered
intravenously.
6. The method of claim 1, wherein the prodrug is selected from among
5-fluorouracil, gancyclovir, 6-methylpurine deoxyriboside,
cephalosporin-doxorubicin,
4-[(2-chloroethyl)(2-mesuloxyethyl)amino]benzoyl-L-glutamic acid,
indole-3-acetic acid,
7-ethyl-10-[4-(1-piperidino)-1-piperidino]carbonyloxycampotothecin,
bis-(2-chloroethyl)amino-4-hydroxyphenylaminomethanone
28,1-chloromethyl-5-hydroxy-1,2-dihyro-3H-benz[e]indole,
epirubicin-glucoronide, 5'-deoxy5-fluorouridine, cytosine arabinoside and
linamarin.
7. The method of claim 1, wherein the prodrug converting enzyme is
selected from among thymidine kinase, cytosine deaminase, purine
nucleoside phosphorylase, beta lactamase, carboxypeptidase G2, cytochrome
P450, horseradish peroxidase, nitroreductase, carboxylesterase,
tyrosinase, beta galactosidase, beta glucuronidase, thymidine
phosphorylase, deoxycytidine kinase and linamerase.
8. The method of claim 1, wherein the prodrug converting enzyme is
endogenous to the Nissle bacterium.
9. The method of claim 1, wherein expression of the gene encoding the
prodrug converting enzyme is directed by an inducible promoter.
10. The method of claim 9, wherein the promoter is selected from among
IPTG-, antibiotic-, heat-, pH-, light-, metal-, aerobic-, host cell-,
drug-, cell cycle-, sugar and tissue specific-inducible promoters.
11. The method of claim 9, wherein the promoter is an arabinose-inducible
promoter or a xylose-inducible promoter.
12. The method of claim 9, wherein the method further comprises
administering to the subject an inducer molecule, whereby the inducible
promoter is activated.
13. The method of claim 12, wherein the inducer molecule is arabinose or
xylose.
14. The method of claim 12, wherein the inducer molecule is administered
systemically.
15. The method of claim 12, wherein the inducer molecule is administered
intravenously or orally.
16. The method of claim 11, wherein one or more genes in the Nissle
bacterium are modified, whereby the Nissle bacterium does not metabolize
L-arabinose.
17. The method of claim 1, wherein the prodrug and enzyme pairs are
selected from among Herpes simplex virus thymidine kinase/gancyclovir,
varicella zoster thymidine kinase/gancyclovir, cytosine
deaminase/5-fluorouracil, purine nucleoside phosphorylase/6-methylpurine
deoxyriboside, beta lactamase/cephalo-sporin-doxorubicin,
carboxypeptidase
G2/4-[(2-chloroethyl)(2-mesuloxyethyl)-amino]benzoyl-L-glutamic acid,
cytochrome P450/acetaminophen, horseradish peroxidase/indole-3-acetic
acid, nitroreductase/CB1954, rabbit
carboxylesterase/7-ethyl-10-[4-(1-piperidino)-1-piperidino]carbonyloxycam-
potothecin, mushroom
tyrosinase/bis-(2-chloroethyl)amino-4-hydroxyphenylaminomethanone 28,
beta galactosidase/1-chloromethyl-5-hydroxy-1,2-dihyro-3H-benz[e]indole,
beta glucuronidase/epirubicin-glucoronide,
glucuronidase/glucuronyldoxorubicin, thymidine
phosphorylase/5'-deoxy-5-fluorouridine, deoxycytidine kinase/cytosine
arabinoside, beta-lactamase and linamerase/linamarin.
Description
RELATED APPLICATIONS
[0001]This application is a continuation of U.S. Ser. No. 11/827,518,
filed Jul. 11, 2007, which claims benefit of priority under 35 U.S.C.
119(e) to U.S. provisional application Ser. No. 60/852,389, to Jochen
Strizker, Phil Hill, Aladar A. Szalay and Yong A. Yu, filed on Oct. 16,
2006, entitled "METHODS AND COMPOSITIONS FOR DETECTION OF MICROORGANISMS
AND CELLS AND TREATMENT OF DISEASES AND DISORDERS," and to U.S.
Provisional Application Ser. No. 60/830,422, to Jochen Strizker, Phil
Hill, Aladar A. Szalay and Yong A. Yu, filed on Jul. 11, 2006, entitled
"METHODS AND COMPOSITIONS FOR DETECTION OF MICROORGANISMS AND CELLS AND
TREATMENT OF DISEASES AND DISORDERS." The subject matter of each of these
applications is incorporated by reference in its entirety.
[0002]This application is related to International Application No.
PCT/US2007/0158 to Jochen Strizker, Phil Hill, Aladar A. Szalay and Yong
A. Yu, filed on Jul. 11, 2007, entitled "METHODS AND COMPOSITIONS FOR
DETECTION OF MICROORGANISMS AND CELLS AND TREATMENT OF DISEASES AND
DISORDERS," which also claims priority to U.S. Provisional Application
Ser. No. 60/852,389 and to U.S. Provisional Application Ser. No.
60/830,422.
[0003]This application is related to U.S. application Ser. No. 11/238,025,
to Aladar A. Szalay; Tatyana Timiryasova; Yong A. Yu; Qian Zhang, filed
on Sep. 27, 2005, entitled "MICROORGANISMS FOR THERAPY," which is a
continuation of U.S. application Ser. No. 10/872,156, to Aladar A.
Szalay; Tatyana Timiryasova; Yong A. Yu; Qian Zhang, filed on Jun. 18,
2004, entitled "MICROORGANISMS FOR THERAPY," which claims the benefit of
priority under 35 U.S.C. .sctn. 119(a) to each of EP 03 013 826.7, filed
18 Jun. 2003, entitled "RECOMBINANT VACCINIA VIRUSES USEFUL AS
TUMOR-SPECIFIC DELIVERY VEHICLE FOR CANCER GENE THERAPY AND VACCINATION;"
EP 03 018 478.2, filed 14 Aug. 2003, entitled "Method for the production
of a polypeptide, RNA or other compound in tumor tissue;" and EP 03 024
283.8, filed 22 Oct. 2003, entitled "USE OF A MICROORGANISM OR CELL TO
INDUCE AUTOIMMUNIZATION OF AN ORGANISM AGAINST A TUMOR."
[0004]This application also is related to International Application Serial
No. PCT/US04/19866, filed on Jun. 18, 2004. This application also is
related to U.S. Application filed Jun. 10, 2004 Ser. No. 10/866,606,
entitled "LIGHT EMITTING MICROORGANISMS AND CELLS FOR DIAGNOSIS AND
THERAPY OF TUMORS," which is a continuation of U.S. application Ser. No.
10/189,918, filed Jul. 3, 2002; U.S. Application filed May 19, 2004 Ser.
No. 10/849,664, entitled, "LIGHT EMITTING MICROORGANISMS AND CELLS FOR
DIAGNOSIS AND THERAPY OF DISEASES ASSOCIATED WITH WOUNDED OR INFLAMED
TISSUE" which is a continuation of U.S. application Ser. No. 10/163,763,
filed Jun. 5, 2003; International PCT Application WO 03/014380, filed
Jul. 31, 2002, entitled "Microorganisms and Cells for Diagnosis and
Therapy of Tumors;" PCT Application WO 03/104485, filed Jun. 5, 2003,
entitled, "LIGHT EMITTING MICROORGANISMS AND CELLS FOR DIAGNOSIS AND
THERAPY OF DISEASES ASSOCIATED WITH WOUNDED OR INFLAMED TISSUE;" EP
Application No. 01 118 417.3, filed Jul. 31, 2001, entitled
"LIGHT-EMITTING MICROORGANISMS AND CELLS FOR TUMOUR DIAGNOSIS/THERAPY;"
EP Application No. 01 125 911.6, filed Oct. 30, 2001, entitled "LIGHT
EMITTING MICROORGANISMS AND CELLS FOR DIAGNOSIS AND THERAPY OF TUMORS;"
EP Application No. 02 0794 632.6, filed Jan. 28, 2004, entitled
"MICROORGANISMS AND CELLS FOR DIAGNOSIS AND THERAPY OF TUMORS;" and EP
Application No. 02 012 552.2, filed Jun. 5, 2002, entitled "LIGHT
EMITTING MICROORGANISMS AND CELLS FOR DIAGNOSIS AND THERAPY OF DISEASES
ASSOCIATED WITH WOUNDED OR INFLAMED TISSUE." The subject matter of each
of these applications is incorporated by reference in its entirety.
[0005]This application also is related to U.S. Provisional Application
Ser. No. 60/852,390, to Nanhai Chen; Aladar A. Szalay; Yong A. Yu; and
Qian Zhang, entitled "MODIFIED VACCINIA VIRUS STRAINS FOR USE IN
DIAGNOSTIC AND THERAPEUTIC METHODS," filed Oct. 16, 2006.
[0006]The subject matter of each of these applications, publications and
international applications is incorporated by reference in its entirety.
INCORPORATION BY REFERENCE OF A SEQUENCE LISTING PROVIDED ON COMPACT DISCS
[0007]An electronic version on compact disc (CD-R) of the Sequence Listing
is filed herewith in duplicate (labeled Copy # 1 and Copy # 2), the
contents of which are incorporated by reference in their entirety. The
computer-readable file on each of the aforementioned compact discs,
created on Jul. 9, 2007, is identical, 1,253 kilobytes in size, and
entitled 4812SEQ.001.txt.
FIELD OF THE INVENTION
[0008]Methods of detecting microorganisms and cells in a subject and
treating diseases and disorders are provided herein. Methods of detecting
or diagnosing sites of cellular proliferation associated with diseases,
disorders and conditions, such as neoplasms, tumors, neoplastic diseases,
cancers, wounds and inflammation, are also provided. Further provided are
microorganisms, cells and compositions, combinations and kits containing
the microorganisms or cells for use in the methods and use in the
preparation of diagnostic and therapeutic or pharmaceutical compositions.
Also provided are methods for enriching a composition with respect to
certain microorganisms and cells.
BACKGROUND
[0009]Various techniques have been reported for use of microorganisms,
such as bacteria and viruses, in transferring substances, e.g., nucleic
acids and proteins, to cells and organisms. Various techniques have also
been reported for detection of microorganisms in samples and in
organisms, including animals. Many such techniques involve incorporation
of nucleic acid encoding a foreign protein (e.g., a detectable marker or
protein of interest for transfer to a sample) into the microorganism. The
amount of foreign protein or detectable signal is related to, and thus
can be dependent on, the amount of the microorganism present in the
sample, the extent to which the microorganism is able to increase in
number, or replicate, in the sample and the degree of expression of the
foreign marker. Additionally, for some microorganisms, toxicity of the
microorganism in the sample, particularly an animal, can necessitate
limiting the amount of the microorganism that is provided to the sample.
[0010]Accordingly, there is a need for alternative methods and
compositions to provide for enhanced detection of microorganisms in a
sample, such as an animal, potentially allowing for rapid growth in the
sample, at lower initial concentrations, reduced toxicities and with
decreased reliance on foreign protein expression.
SUMMARY
[0011]Provided herein are compositions containing a microorganism or cell
and a diagnostic moiety. An exemplary microorganism or cell is, for
example, the bacterial strain Escherichia coli Nissle 1917. In one
embodiment, the bacteria contain a DNA sequence encoding a protein or
polypeptide produced by the bacteria (e.g., an enzyme involved in
siderophore biosynthesis, including production of substrates for
siderophore biosynthesis, an enzyme that modifies or processes a
siderophore, a receptor, a transporter protein, such as a siderophore
uptake protein (e.g., FepA protein, IroN protein, FyuA protein or Iuta
protein), iron acquisition molecule, iron metabolism molecule, an iron
transport protein, or an iron storage molecule, such as a ferritin or
ferritin-like molecule) as a diagnostic moiety; the DNA sequence can be
endogenous or exogenous to the microorganism. In another embodiment, the
bacteria contain a DNA sequence encoding a protein or polypeptide (e.g.,
an enzyme) that cleaves a precursor siderophore to generate a mature
siderophore. In one embodiment, the protein or polypeptide normally
produced by the microorganism or cell is also a therapeutic agent.
Compositions provided herein can be further formulated with any of the
therapeutic agents provided herein. In one embodiment, the microorganism
or cell is recombinant. Provided herein is a composition containing a
microorganism, such as Escherichia coli strain Nissle 1917, and a
therapeutic agent.
[0012]Provided herein is a composition containing a microorganism or cell
(e.g., E. coli strain Nissle 1917), where the microorganism or cell
contains a DNA sequence encoding a therapeutic agent (or encodes a
protein or polypeptide responsible for the production of a therapeutic
agent) and the therapeutic agent is, for example, one or more of the
following molecules: a ferritin-like molecule, a siderophore (e.g.,
enterobactin, salmochelin, yersiniabactin or aerobactin), iron
acquisition molecule, a receptor, a transporter protein, such as a
siderophore uptake protein (e.g., FepA protein, IroN protein, FyuA
protein or Iuta protein), an iron metabolism molecule, or an iron storage
molecule, such as a ferritin or ferritin-like molecule, or a combination
thereof. Such therapeutic agents deplete iron from the tumor environment.
In one embodiment, the one or more molecule(s) is (are) endogenous to the
microorganism, exogenous to the microorganism or cell or a combination
thereof. In one embodiment, the composition is formulated with an
additional therapeutic, such as any of those described herein or known in
the art.
[0013]Provided herein are compositions of microorganisms or cells that
contain one or more heterologous nucleic acid molecules for the
expression one or more gene products useful for therapy or for detection
of the microorganisms or cells. Expression of such gene products can be
controlled by operative linkage to a promoter. In some examples provided
herein the promoter can be an inducible promoter. A non-limiting example
of an inducible promoter provided herein for use in the compositions and
methods provided is sugar-inducible promoter, such as an arabinose
inducible promoter system, e.g., the araBAD system. According to the
methods provided herein, induction of an arabinose inducible promoter can
be carried out in vitro in cell culture or in vivo in a subject that has
been administered the microorganisms or cells that contain the promoter.
In vivo induction of an inducible promoter can be performed by
administering an inducer, such as arabinose, to induce gene expression
from the promoter. Provided herein are methods of inducing a promoter in
vivo by administration of an inducer molecule by a method of
administration, such as orally, for example, by feeding, or injected,
such as by intravenous injection.
[0014]Pharmaceutical compositions containing a microorganism or cell
provided herein can be formulated with a pharmaceutically acceptable
vehicle for use in the methods provided herein. The pharmaceutical
compositions can be formulated for any mode of administration, including,
but not limited to, systemic administration, such as for intravenous
administration. The compositions can contain a delivery vehicle, such as
a lipid-based carrier, including liposomes and micelles associated with
the bacteria.
[0015]Provided herein are methods of detecting and/or treating a site of
proliferation or a proliferative condition, such as a tumor, tumor
tissue, cancer or metastasis by administering to a subject any of the
compositions provided herein. Provided herein uses of the compositions
provided herein for the preparation of a diagnostic or therapeutic
composition for detecting and/or treating a site of proliferation or a
proliferative condition, such as a tumor, tumor tissue, cancer or
metastasis. Provided herein are pharmaceutical compositions for detecting
and/or treating a site of proliferation or a proliferative condition,
such as a tumor, tumor tissue, cancer or metastasis.
[0016]Provided herein are uses of microorganisms or cells (e.g., Nissle)
in the methods provided herein for detecting and/or treating a site of
proliferation or a proliferative condition, such as a tumor, tumor
tissue, cancer or metastasis. Also provided are uses of microorganisms or
cells (e.g., Nissle) for the formulation of compositions for use in the
methods provided herein for detecting and/or treating a site of
proliferation or a proliferative condition, such as a tumor, tumor
tissue, cancer or metastasis.
[0017]Provided herein are methods of detecting a site of proliferation or
a proliferative condition, such as a tumor, tumor tissue, cancer or
metastasis by administering to a subject compositions, containing
microorganism or cells, provided herein, whereby detection of the
microorganism or cell in the subject indicates the site of proliferation
or a proliferative condition. Provided herein are methods of detecting a
site of proliferation or a proliferative condition, in which detection is
performed externally to the subject.
[0018]Provided herein is a method of detecting a site of proliferation or
a proliferative condition, such as a tumor, tumor tissue, cancer or
metastasis, which includes administering to a subject a composition the
contains a recombinant microorganism or cell, wherein the microorganism
or cell contains one or more gene(s) encoding one or more molecule(s).
Exemplary cancers to be treated include, but are not limited to,
pancreatic cancer, lung cancer, ovarian cancer, breast cancer, cervical
cancer, bladder cancer, prostate cancer, glioma cancer, adenocarcinoma,
liver cancer, skin cancer or a combination thereof. In one embodiment,
the tumor is metastatic. The microorganisms and cells used in the methods
provided herein have been attenuated such that they are not lethal to the
subject. Further, the microorganisms and cells preferentially accumulate
in a tumor in the subject.
[0019]Microorganisms or cells for the compositions, methods and uses
provided herein can be, for example, bacteria, viruses and eukaryotic
cells.
[0020]Bacteria employed in the methods provided herein include, but are
not limited to, mutual or commensal strains of Escherichia coli,
Bacteroides, Eubacterium, Streptococcus, Actinomyces, Veillonella,
Nesseria, Prevotella, Campylobacter, Fusobacterium, Eikenella,
Porphyromonas and Priopionibacteria.
[0021]In some examples, the microorganism or cell employed in the methods
provided herein can be one that can form a mutual or commensal
association with the subject, such as strains of Escherichia coli,
Bacteroides, Eubacterium, Streptococcus, Actinomyces, Veillonella,
Nesseria, Prevotella, Campylobacter, Fusobacterium, Eikenella,
Porphyromonas and Propionibacteria, or one that is a probiotic strain of
Escherichia coli, Bacillus cereus, Bacillus licheniformis, Bacillus
pumilus, Bacillus clausii, Bacillus coagulans, Bacillus polyfermenticus,
Brevibacillus laterosporus, Lactococcus, Lactobacillus reuteri,
Lactobacillus amylovorus, Lactobacillus crispatus, Lactobacillus
gallinarum, Lactobacillus gasseri, Lactobacillus johnsonii, Lactobacillus
bifidum, Lactobacillus helveticus, Bifidobacterium lactis,
Bifidobacterium breve, Leuconostoc mesenteroides, Enterococcus faecium,
Pediococcus, Sporolactobacillus inulinus, Saccharomyces. In other
examples, the bacteria employed in the methods provided herein are
selected from nonpathogenic or attenuated E. coli strains of the O6
serotype, bacteria with five or more systems for acquiring iron.
[0022]In a particular example, the bacterium employed in the methods
provided herein is E. coli Nissle 1917. Derivatives of E. coli strain
Nissle 1917 can be employed, such as, for example, Nissle strains that
either do not produce lipopolysaccharide (LPS), or that produce LPS that
lacks the myristic acid moiety of lipid A, strain that do not produce
lipid acyl A transferase, strains that lack one or more cryptic plasmids,
such as pMut1 and/or pMut2, strains that have reduced L-arabinose
metabolism or strains in which the consensus nucleotide sequence for the
Fur protein-binding region of the promoter of one or more genes that is
negatively regulated by iron is inactivated.
[0023]Viruses employed in the methods provided herein include, but are not
limited to, vaccinia virus, baculovirus, sindbis virus, Sendai virus,
adenovirus, AAV virus, parvovirus, retrovirus, Epstein-Barr virus,
papillomavirus, SV40 virus, cytomegalovirus, Newcastle Disease virus,
bovine enterovirus, lymphocytic choriomeningitis virus, lentiviruses, a
derivative of the Edmonton-B strain of measles virus, herpes simplex
virus type 1, or yellow fever virus. Exemplary viruses include, for
example, the Lister strain of vaccinia virus, MVM, H-1, MoMULV, HaMUSV,
MuMTV, RSV or GaLV. In one embodiment, the virus is the LIVP strain of
vaccinia virus.
[0024]Eukaryotic cells employed in the methods provided herein include,
but are not limited to, fibrosarcoma cells and stem cells.
[0025]Provided herein is a method of diagnosing a site of proliferation or
a proliferative condition, such as a tumor, tumor tissue, cancer or
metastasis by administering to a subject a composition containing E. coli
Nissle 1917. E. coli Nissle 1917 can encode one or more or the following
molecule(s): an enzyme involved in siderophore biosynthesis, including
production of substrates for siderophore biosynthesis, an enzyme that
modifies or processes a siderophore, a receptor, a transporter protein, a
ferritin-like molecule, and a combination thereof. Any of the diagnostic
methods provided herein can be combined with any of the therapeutic
methods provided herein. Such diagnostic methods provided herein can be
used to monitor the efficacy of the therapeutic methods provided herein.
[0026]Provided herein is a method of treating a site of proliferation or a
proliferative condition, such as a tumor, tumor tissue, cancer or
metastasis, by administering to a subject a composition containing a
microorganism, wherein the microorganism is E. coli Nissle 1917. The
microorganism or cell can contain one or more gene(s) encoding one or
more molecule(s) chosen from among an enzyme involved in siderophore
biosynthesis, including production of substrates for siderophore
biosynthesis, an enzyme that modifies or processes a siderophore, a
receptor, a transporter protein, a ferritin-like molecule or a
combination thereof.
[0027]A method of treating a site of proliferation or a proliferative
condition, such as a tumor, tumor tissue, cancer or metastasis, provided
herein can include administering to a subject a composition that contains
a recombinant microorganism or cell, wherein the microorganism or cell
contains (a) DNA sequence(s) encoding one or more molecule(s) selected
from among an enzyme involved in siderophore biosynthesis, including
production of substrates for siderophore biosynthesis, an enzyme that
modifies or processes a siderophore, a receptor, a transporter protein, a
ferritin-like molecule, and a combination thereof. In one embodiment, the
microorganism or cell depletes iron from a tumor cell or a tumor
environment, thereby dis-regulating iron hemostasis in the tumor cell or
tumor environment. Ferritin-like molecules provided herein can be a
ferritin produced by a prokaryotic microorganism, a eukaryotic cell or a
virus-infected tumor cell. In a particular embodiment, the ferritin
produced by a prokaryotic microorganism and is one or more of a bacterial
ferritin, a bacterioferritin, a dodecameric ferritin, a rubrerythrin or a
combination thereof. Alternatively, ferritin-like molecules provided
herein can be a ferritin produced by a eukaryotic cell and is one or more
of an H chain, an L chain or a combination thereof. The one or more
ferritin(s) can be endogenous to the microorganism, exogenous to the
microorganism or cell or a combination thereof. In yet another
embodiment, ferritin-like molecules provided herein can be a ferritin
produced by a tumor cell that is infected with a recombinant virus. The
one or more ferritin(s) can be one or more of a bacterial ferritin, a
bacterioferritin, a dodecameric ferritin, a rubrerythrin, an H chain, an
L chain or a combination thereof.
[0028]Provided herein are microorganisms and cells containing DNA
sequences for the expression of one or more siderophores (e.g.,
enterobactin, salmochelin, yersiniabactin or aerobactin). Such
siderophores can be endogenous to the microorganism, exogenous to the
microorganism or cell or a combination thereof. For example, a bacterium
that expresses endogenous siderophores is provided herein. The bacterium
can be further recombinantly engineered to express one or more exogenous
siderophores and/or an enzyme involved in producing the exogenous
siderophore. A microorganism or cell (e.g., bacterium, virus or
eukaryotic cell) that does not normally express a siderophore can be
recombinantly engineered to express one or more exogenous siderophores
and/or an enzyme involved in producing the exogenous siderophore.
[0029]The one or more siderophore(s) can bind(s) to a receptor, and
optionally, can be internalized by the microorganism. In such an
embodiment, the microorganism or cell is a prokaryotic microorganism and
the siderophore is internalized. In another embodiment, the microorganism
is a virus, and the siderophore binds to a receptor on the tumor cell
surface in the form of a siderophore-metal complex. In yet another
embodiment, the cell is a eukaryotic cell, and the siderophore binds to a
receptor on the eukaryotic cell surface in the form of a
siderophore-metal complex.
[0030]Provided herein are methods for diagnosis and/or therapy of tumors
wherein the microorganism or cell administered to the subject expresses a
recombinant receptor that binds a ligand. The recombinant receptor can
be, for example, an outer membrane protein, such as OmpA or OmpC,
expressing a recombinant peptide, such as a streptavidin binding peptide
or an S-peptide. One embodiment further includes administering to the
subject a composition that contains a ligand that binds to the
recombinant peptide. Exemplary ligands are conjugated to a molecule such
as a detectable moiety, a therapeutic agent or a combination thereof.
[0031]In one embodiment, the method further provides for administering to
a subject one or more molecule(s): a siderophore, a metal, a peptide
ligand or a combination thereof. Siderophores can bind to a receptor on
the injected microorganism or cell or on a tumor cell and, optionally,
can be internalized. Molecules provided herein can be conjugated to a
detectable moiety, a therapeutic agent or a combination thereof. In some
embodiments, the detectable moiety and the therapeutic agent are the
same. In one embodiment, where the detectable moiety and the therapeutic
agent are different, the one or more molecule(s) can be conjugated to a
detectable moiety and a therapeutic agent.
[0032]The microorganisms and cells used in the methods herein allow for
detection of a tumor, tumor tissue, cancer or metastasis based on a
signal, such as a signal that is detectable magnetic resonance imaging
(MRI), single-photon emission computed tomography (SPECT), positron
emission tomography (PET), scintigraphy, gamma camera, a .beta..sup.+
detector, a .gamma. detector, fluorescence imaging or bioluminescence
imaging.
[0033]The microorganisms and cells used in the methods herein allow for
detection of a tumor, tumor tissue, cancer or metastasis through
detection of electromagnetic radiation (e.g., light), such as, for
example, by administering a microorganism or cell containing a DNA
sequence encoding a detectable protein or a protein capable of inducing a
detectable signal, such as a fluorescent protein or a luciferase. In some
examples, the microorganism or cell contains a DNA sequence encoding one
or more enzymes for the production of a substrate for the luciferase.
[0034]In some embodiments, the microorganism or cell further acts as a
therapeutic agent by depleting iron from the tumor environment or tumor
cell, such as sequestration by siderophores, ferritin-like molecules, a
receptor that scavenges iron from host, transport proteins or combination
thereof.
[0035]Diagnostic methods provided herein can be combined with therapeutic
methods provided herein. In one non-limiting example, after a tumor,
tumor tissue, cancer or metastasis is detected using any of the imaging
methods provided herein, the method further includes treating tumor,
tumor tissue, cancer or metastasis, which includes administering to a
subject a therapeutic agent.
[0036]In the methods and uses provided herein, the animals can be
non-human animals or can include humans.
[0037]Diagnostic moieties provided herein accumulate in a tumor cell or
tumor environment. Diagnostic moieties include any of those described
herein or known in the art. In some embodiments, the diagnostic moiety is
also a therapeutic moiety. In other embodiments, a therapeutic agent can
be administered to the subject. Compositions that can be used in the
methods herein can be further formulated with a therapeutic agent.
[0038]Diagnostic moieties for the compositions, methods and uses provided
herein can be any of those described or known in the art such as, for
example, a bioluminescent moiety, a fluorescent moiety, a
chemiluminescent moiety, a metal, a radionuclide or a combination
thereof. Exemplary bioluminescent moieties include for example, a
luciferin such as, but not limited to, click beetle luciferin, firefly
luciferin, Cypridina luciferin, bacterial luciferin, derivatives of
luciferins or a synthetic luciferin analog thereof. Exemplary fluorescent
moieties include, for example, a green fluorescent protein (GFP), yellow
fluorescent protein (YFP), orange fluorescent protein (OFP), cyan
fluorescent protein (CFP), blue fluorescent protein (BFP), red
fluorescent protein (RFP), far-red fluorescent protein, or near-infrared
fluorescent protein. Exemplary chemiluminescent moieties include, for
example, luminol, isoluminol, dioxetanes, acridinium esters, thioesters
and sulfonamides, and phenanthridinium esters. Exemplary metals include,
for example, iron, gadolinium, gold or gallium, which act as contrast
agents in the methods and uses provided herein. Metals can, optionally,
be labeled, such as with a radionuclide (e.g., .sup.11Carbon,
.sup.11Fluorine, .sup.13Carbon, .sup.13Nitrogen, .sup.15Nitrogen,
.sup.15Oxygen, .sup.18Flourine, .sup.19Flourine, .sup.24Sodium,
.sup.32Phosphate, .sup.42Potassium, .sup.51Chromium, .sup.55Iron,
.sup.59Iron, .sup.57Cobalt, .sup.60Cobalt, .sup.64Copper, .sup.67Gallium,
.sup.68Gallium, .sup.75Selenium, .sup.81Krypton, .sup.82Rubidium,
.sup.89Strontium, .sup.92Strontium, .sup.90Yttirum, .sup.99Technetium,
.sup.103 Palladium, .sup.106Ruthenium, .sup.111Indium, .sup.117Lutetium,
.sup.123Iodine, .sup.125Iodine, .sup.131Iodine, .sup.133Xenon,
.sup.137Cesium, .sup.153Samarium, .sup.153Gadolinium, .sup.165Dysprosium,
.sup.166Holmium, .sup.169Ytterbium, .sup.177Leutium, .sup.186Rhenium,
Rhenium, .sup.192Iridium, .sup.198Gold, .sup.201Thallium,
.sup.211Astatine, .sup.212Bismuth or .sup.213Bismuth).
[0039]Diagnostic moieties also include those that are produced by a
microorganism, such as a bacterium or eukaryotic cell. Diagnostic
moieties include, for example, a ferritin-like molecule, a siderophore, a
receptor, a transporter protein, an enzyme involved in siderophore
biosynthesis, including production of substrates for siderophore
biosynthesis, an enzyme that modifies or processes a siderophore, and a
combination thereof. Methods of recombinantly engineering a bacterium, a
virus or a eukaryotic cell to carry a gene encoding such a type of
diagnostic moiety are provided herein. Exemplary receptors include, for
example, a recombinant outer membrane protein with an embedded peptide
(e.g., a streptavidin binding peptide or an S-peptide) which, optionally,
can be conjugated to a detectable label. Likewise, the ferritin-like
molecules or siderophores can, optionally, be conjugated to a detectable
moiety. In certain embodiments, the detectable moiety and the therapeutic
agent are the same molecule. In some examples, the siderophore is
conjugated to a metal, such as iron, gallium, gadolinium, manganese,
cobalt, zinc, chromium, gold and indium or a radionuclide.
[0040]Therapeutic agents for the compositions, methods and uses provided
herein can be, for example, an anti-cancer agent. Anti-cancer agents
provided herein include, but are not limited to, cytokines, growth
factors, photosensitizing agents, radionuclides, toxins,
anti-metabolites, signaling modulators, anti-cancer antibiotics,
anti-cancer antibodies, angiogenesis inhibitors, radiation therapy,
chemotherapeutic compounds, or a combination thereof. Exemplary
therapeutic agents are provided herein. In some examples, therapeutic
agents can be expressed by the microorganism or cell for use in the
therapeutic methods provided herein. Such agents include, but are not
limited to, a cytokine, a chemokine, an immunomodulatory molecule, a
single chain antibody, antisense RNA, prodrug converting enzyme, siRNA,
angiogenesis inhibitor, a toxin, an antitumor oligopeptides, an
antimitotic oligopeptide, an anti-cancer polypeptide antibiotic or tissue
factor.
[0041]Provided herein are microorganisms and cells for use in
Gene-Directed Enzyme Prodrug Therapy (GDEPT), in which microorganisms and
cells are engineered to secrete an enzyme, or to express a cell-surface
attached enzyme, that converts a non-toxic prodrug into a cytotoxic drug.
Following administration of the engineered bacteria, eukaryotic cells
and/or viruses, the microorganisms and cells are allowed to proliferate
and produce the prodrug converting enzyme at the site of the tumor. After
a period of time the prodrug is delivered intravenously, or by
alternative delivery method, and the prodrug is converted to the
cytotoxic form at the site of the tumor, causing toxicity in the
surrounding tumor cells. Exemplary prodrug converting enzymes with their
prodrug partners are provided herein.
[0042]Provided herein are combinations of a siderophore, such as
enterobactin, salmochelin, yersiniabactin or aerobactin, and a
microorganism that does not produce a siderophore. Provided herein are
combinations of a siderophore and a microorganism that expresses a
siderophore uptake protein, such as FepA protein, IroN protein, FyuA
protein or Iuta protein. Provided herein are combinations of a metal and
a microorganism that heterologously overproduces a metal-binding molecule
or an iron storage, iron metabolism or iron transport molecule. Provided
herein are combinations of a sugar, such as arabinose, and a
microorganism that contains a heterologous nucleic acid that is
operatively-linked to promoter inducible in the presence of the sugar.
Also provided herein are combinations of a Nissle bacterium and an
anti-tumor or anti-cancer agent. Provided herein are kits containing any
of the combinations provided herein.
DETAILED DESCRIPTION
[0043]Outline [0044]A. Definitions [0045]B. Methods and Compositions for
Detection and Therapy [0046]C. Microorganisms and cells selected or
designed for a enhanced capacity to bind, transport, metabolize, store
and/or accumulate a metal [0047]1. Metal binding, acquisition,
transport, metabolism, storage and regulation [0048]a. Iron storage
[0049]i. Prokaryotic ferritins (a) Bacterial ferritin (b)
Bacterioferritin (c) Dodecameric ferritin (d) Rubrerythrins [0050]ii.
Eukaryotic ferritins [0051]iii. Viruses [0052]b. Iron acquisition and
transport [0053]i. Siderophores (a) Gram negative bacteria (1) Peptide
siderophores a. Oligopeptide-containing siderophores b. Siderophores
with side-chain-connected amino acids along the backbone c. Siderophores
with amino acids acting as functional carriers for chelating groups d.
Siderophores containing cyclized amino acids e. Siderophores containing
amino acids of unusual structure (2) Non-proteinaceous siderophores (3)
Receptor and Transport proteins (b) Gram-positive bacteria (1)
Siderophores (2) Receptor and transport proteins (c) Viruses (d)
Eukaryotic cells (e) Multiple siderophore and uptake systems [0054](f)
Acquisition of metals other than iron [0055]ii. Other (a) Prokaryotic
cells (1) Acquisition of exogenous siderophores (2) Acquisition from
host carriers (b) Eukaryotic cells (c) Viruses [0056]c. Iron
regulation [0057]i. Prokaryotic cells (a) Gram-negative bacteria (b)
Gram-positive bacteria [0058]ii. Eukaryotic cells [0059]2. Ligand
binding [0060]a. Therapeutic agents [0061]b. Detectable moieties
[0062]c. Targeting of peptides [0063]d. Targeting of nanostructures
[0064]i. Nanoparticle-peptide/protein conjugates [0065]ii.
Nanoparticle-antibody conjugates [0066]iii. Nanoparticle-protein
conjugates [0067]e. Siderophores [0068]D. Methods of modifying
microorganisms and cells [0069]1. Recombinant DNA Technology [0070]a.
Endogenous Gene Expression [0071]b. Exogenous Gene Expression [0072]i.
Outer membrane proteins (Omp) [0073]ii. Lpp'OmpA [0074]iii. Lipoproteins
[0075]iv. Ice-nucleation protein (Inp) [0076]v. Detectable gene product
[0077]vi. More than one gene product [0078]c. Inactivation of bacterial
genes [0079]d. Insertion of genes [0080]e. Screening for above
characteristics [0081]E. Microorganism and cell characteristics and
species [0082]1. General characteristics [0083]a. Attenuated [0084]i.
Reduced toxicity [0085]ii. Accumulate in immunoprivileged cells and
tissues, such as tumor, not substantially in other organs [0086]b.
Replication Competent [0087]2. Bacteria [0088]a. Aerobic bacteria
[0089]b. Anaerobic bacteria [0090]3. Viruses [0091]a. Cytoplasmic
viruses [0092]i. Poxviruses (a) Vaccinia Virus (b) Modified Vaccinia
Viruses (c) The Lister Strain [0093]ii. Other cytoplasmic viruses
[0094]b. Adenovirus, Herpes, Retroviruses [0095]4. Eukaryotic cells
[0096]F. Imaging [0097]1. Ferritins [0098]2. Siderophores [0099]3.
Surface ligands [0100]4. Detectable gene products [0101]G. Therapy
[0102]1. Selection of bacteria [0103]2. Administration [0104]a. Steps
prior to administering the microorganism [0105]b. Mode of administration
[0106]c. Dosage [0107]d. Number of administrations [0108]3.
Co-administrations [0109]a. Other therapeutic compounds [0110]b.
Therapeutic gene product expression [0111]4. State of subject [0112]5.
Monitoring tumor size [0113]6. Monitoring general health diagnostics
[0114]H. Enrichment [0115]I. Pharmaceutical compositions, Combinations
and Kits [0116]1. Pharmaceutical compositions [0117]2. Combinations
[0118]3. Kits [0119]J. Examples
A. DEFINITIONS
[0120]Unless defined otherwise, all technical and scientific terms used
herein have the same meaning as is commonly understood by one of skill in
the art to which the invention(s) belong. All patents, patent
applications, published applications and publications, websites and other
published materials referred to throughout the entire disclosure herein,
unless noted otherwise, are incorporated by reference in their entirety.
In the event that there are a plurality of definitions for terms herein,
those in this section prevail. Where reference is made to a URL or other
such identifier or address, it is understood that such identifiers can
change and particular information on the internet can come and go, but
equivalent information is known and can be readily accessed, such as by
searching the internet and/or appropriate databases. Reference thereto
evidences the availability and public dissemination of such information.
[0121]As used herein, the term "microorganism" or "microbe" refers to a
virus and to a life form or organism of small size, generally microscopic
in size. Thus, for example, the term "microorganism" includes viruses and
organisms such as bacteria, archaea, fungi and protists. Microorganisms
include eukaryotic and prokaryotic organisms and can be unicellular or
multicellular. Although the term "microorganism" as used herein includes
unicellular organisms, it does not include a single cell that is not an
organism per se but that rather is a cell that occurs in nature as a part
of a larger multicellular organism.
[0122]As used herein, the term "cell" refers to the basic unit of
structure and function of a living organism as is commonly understood in
the biological sciences. A cell can be a unicellular organism that is
self-sufficient and that can exist as a functional whole independently of
other cells. A cell can also be one that, when not isolated from the
environment in which it occurs in nature, is part of a multicellular
organism made up of more than one type of cell. Such a cell, which can be
thought of as a "non-organism" or "non-organismal" cell, generally is
specialized in that it performs only a subset of the functions performed
by the multicellular organism as whole. Thus, this type of cell is not a
unicellular organism. Such a cell can be a prokaryotic or eukaryotic
cell, including animal cells such as mammalian cells, human cells and
non-human animal cells or non-human mammalian cells. Animal cells include
any cell of animal origin that can be found in an animal. Thus, animal
cells include, for example, cells that make up the various organs,
tissues and systems of an animal.
[0123]As used herein, the term "tissue" refers to a group, collection or
aggregate of similar cells generally acting to perform a specific
function within an organism.
[0124]As used herein, the terms immunoprivileged cells and tissues refer
to cells and tissues, such as solid tumors and wounded tissues, which are
sequestered from the immune system. Generally, administration of a
microorganism elicits an immune response that clears the microorganism;
immunoprivileged sites, however, are shielded or sequestered from the
immune response, permitting the microorganisms or cells to survive and
generally to replicate. Immunoprivileged tissues include inflamed
tissues, wounded tissues, and proliferating tissues, such as tumor
tissues.
[0125]As used herein, the term "detect," "detecting" or "detection" with
reference to a composition such as, for example, a microorganism,
includes any process whereby the presence of the composition is
determined. For example, detection of the composition can be direct or
indirect. Direct detection involves using a directly detectable feature
of the composition itself as a basis for determining its presence. One
example of direct detection is detection of light emitted by a
composition, such as a microorganism that expresses a fluorescent or
luminescent protein. Indirect detection is not based on detecting a
directly detectable feature of the composition but rather can involve
detection of any detectable feature that is specifically associated with
the presence of the composition. For example, indirect detection can
involve detection of a detectably labeled ligand that interacts with or
binds to the composition (e.g., a microorganism) or can involve detection
of a biochemical or physiological effect of the presence of the
composition in a subject. Detection can involve any manner of techniques,
including use of a signal, such as magnetic resonance imaging, ultrasound
signal, X-rays, gamma rays (after annihilation of a positron and an
electron in PET scanning), fluorescence or absorption.
[0126]As used herein, "modified" with reference to a gene refers to a
deleted gene or a gene having one or more truncations, mutations,
insertions or deletions. A gene modification can be such that it results
in truncation, mutation, an insertion or a deletion of a part or all of a
gene product encoded by the gene. A gene modification can be accompanied
by a change in function of the gene product and/or a microorganism or
cell.
[0127]As used herein, to attenuate toxicity of a microorganism or cell
means to reduce or eliminate deleterious or toxic effects to a host upon
administration of the microorganism or cell compared to an un-attenuated
microorganism or cell. As used herein, a microorganism or cell with low
toxicity means that upon administration a microorganism or cells does not
accumulate in organs and tissues in the host to an extent that results in
damage or harm to organs, or that impacts survival of the host to a
greater extent than the disease being treated does.
[0128]As used herein, accumulation of a microorganism or cell in a
targeted tissue refers to the distribution of the microorganism or cell
throughout the organism after a time period long enough for the microbes
to infect the host's organs or tissues. As one skilled in the art will
recognize, the time period for infection of a microbe will vary depending
on the microbe, the targeted organ(s) or tissue(s), the immunocompetence
of the host, and dosage. Generally, accumulation can be determined at
time point from about less than 1 day, about 1 day to about 1 week, about
1 week to about 2, 3 or 4 weeks, about 1 month to about 2, 3, 4, 5, 6
months or longer after infection with the microbes. For purposes herein,
the microorganisms or cells preferentially accumulate in the target
tissue, such as a tumor, but are cleared from other tissues and organs in
the host to the extent that toxicity of the microorganism or cell is mild
or tolerable and at most not fatal. As used herein, preferential
accumulation refers to accumulation of a microorganism or cell at a first
location at a higher level than accumulation at a second location. Thus,
a microorganism or cell that preferentially accumulates in
immunoprivileged tissue such as tumor relative to normal tissues or
organs refers to a microorganism or cell that accumulates in
immunoprivileged tissue, such as tumor, at a higher level (concentration)
than the microorganism or cell accumulates in normal tissues or organs.
[0129]As used herein, a compound produced in a tumor or other
immunoprivileged site refers to any compound that is produced in the
tumor or tumor environment by virtue of the presence of an introduced
microorganism, generally a recombinant microorganism, expressing one or
more gene products. For example, a compound produced in a tumor can be,
for example, a metabolite, an encoded polypeptide or RNA, or compound
that is generated by a recombinant polypeptide (e.g., cell-surface
receptor, a siderophore, a ferritin, an enzyme) and the cellular
machinery of the tumor or immunoprivileged tissue or cells.
[0130]As used herein, bacteria refer to Gram-positive bacteria and
Gram-negative bacteria. As used herein, Gram positive (G+) bacteria refer
to bacteria that retain the violet stain used in Gram's method. The
violet stain is caused by a high amount of peptidoglycan in the cell
wall, which typically, but not always lacks the secondary membrane and
lipopolysaccharide layer found in Gram-negative bacteria. As used herein,
Gram negative (G-) bacteria refer to bacteria that do not retain the
violet stain used in Gram's method. On most Gram-stain preparations,
Gram-negative organisms will appear red or pink because they are
counterstained. In contrast to most Gram-positive bacteria, Gram-negative
bacteria have only a few layers of peptidoglycan, lipopolysaccharide and
a secondary cell membrane. The space between the layers of peptidoglycan
and the secondary cell membrane is called the periplasmic space.
Pathogenicity of Gram negative bacteria is usually associated with
certain components of their cell walls, including the lipopolysaccharide
(endotoxin) layer.
[0131]As used herein, "commensal" when used in reference to an association
between two organisms, is a particular association in which one member of
the association benefits from the association while the other member is
essentially unaffected. In a commensal association of organisms, none of
the members of the association is significantly harmed by the presence of
the other member. Two organisms can form a commensal association under
particular, but not necessarily all, conditions. In such cases, as long
as an organism is capable of forming a commensal association with the
other organism under at least one set of conditions, the organism is
considered to be one that can form a commensal association with the other
organism.
[0132]As used herein, "mutual" when used in reference to an association
between two or more organisms, is a particular association which is
advantageous to both members of the association. In a mutual association
of organisms, none of the members of the association is significantly
harmed by the presence of the other member. Two organisms can form a
mutual association under particular, but not necessarily all, conditions.
In such cases, as long as an organism is capable of forming a mutual
association with the other organism under at least one set of conditions,
the organism is considered to be one that can form a mutual association
with the other organism.
[0133]As used herein, a probiotic microorganism refers to a microorganism
that confers a benefit to a host in which it can occur. The benefit can
be, for example, an overall health benefit to the host, such as
preventing, maintaining remission of, preventing recurrence of, reversing
or reducing the symptoms or detrimental effects of a disorder or disease
of the host. Such disorders/diseases include, but are not limited to,
infectious diseases, inflammation, diarrhea (e.g., antibiotic-induced
diarrhea, infectious diarrhea and traveler's diarrhea), inflammatory
bowel disease, Crohn's disease, pouchitis and colitis. The benefit
conferred by a probiotic microorganism can be stabilization of the host
microbiota or microecology, for example, by improving the microbial
balance of the indigenous microflora (Kruis W. Aliment (2004) Pharmacol.
Ther. 20 (Suppl 4):75-78). Probiotic microorganisms can exert their
effects in a number of ways. For example, a probiotic microorganism can
participate in bacterial (e.g., pathogenic bacteria) interference that
can occur through the production of antimicrobial substances by the
probiotic microorganism and interference of the probiotic microorganism
with bacterial attachment/penetration to/into host cells. A probiotic
microorganism also can stimulate a host to produce antimicrobial
molecules, alter a host's immune response, stimulate mucosal barrier
function or alter immunoregulation, such as by decreasing
pro-inflammatory molecules and promoting protective molecules (Sartor R
B. (2005) Curr. Opin. Gastroenterol. 21(1):44-50). Exemplary probiotic
microorganisms include, but are not limited to, E. coli strain Nissle
1917 (O6:K5:H1; Mutaflor; Ardeypharm GmbH, Germany; Schultz et al. (2005)
J. Microbiol. Methods 61(3):389-398). E. coli strain Nissle 1917 lacks
defined virulence factors such as alpha-hemolysin, other toxins, and
mannose-resistant hemagglutinating adhesins (Blum et al. (1996)
Infection. 23(4):234-236), P-fimbrial adhesins, and the semirough
lipopolysaccharide phenotype and expresses fitness factors such as
microcins, ferritins, six different iron uptake systems, adhesins, and
proteases, which support its survival and successful colonization of the
human gut (Grozdanov et al. (2004) J Bacteriol. 186(16):5432-5441). E.
coli Nissle 1917 interferes with bacterial invasion of other bacteria
cells via a secreted component (Altenhoefer et al. (2004) FEMS Immunol.
Med. Microbiol. 40(3):223-9). E. coli Nissle 1917 can have plasmids
(Mutaflor 06:K5:H1, DSM 6601 by Medipharm, Kagerod, Sweden) or no
plasmids (i.e., can be cured of plasmids).
[0134]Magnetic bacteria can be isolated from fresh and marine sediments
and can produce magnetic particles (Fe.sub.30.sub.4) which can be used
for tumor detection or enrichment of bacterial species. An exemplary
magnetic bacterium is Magnetospirillum magnetic AMB-1 (Yang et al. (2001)
Enzyme Microb. Technol. 29:13-19; Blakemore (1982) Annu. Rev. Microbiol.
36:217-238).
[0135]As used herein, a delivery vehicle for administration refers to a
lipid-based or other polymer-based composition, such as liposome, micelle
or reverse micelle that associates with an agent, such as a microorganism
provided herein, for delivery into a host animal.
[0136]As used herein, the term "viral vector" is used according to its
art-recognized meaning. It refers to a nucleic acid vector construct that
includes at least one element of viral origin and can be packaged into a
viral vector particle. The viral vector particles can be used for the
purpose of transferring DNA, RNA or other nucleic acids into cells either
in vitro or in vivo. Viral vectors include, but are not limited to,
retroviral vectors, vaccinia vectors, lentiviral vectors, herpes virus
vectors (e.g., HSV), baculoviral vectors, cytomegalovirus (CMV) vectors,
papillomavirus vectors, simian virus (SV40) vectors, semliki forest virus
vectors, phage vectors, adenoviral vectors, and adeno-associated viral
(AAV) vectors.
[0137]As used herein, oncolytic viruses refer to viruses that replicate
and lyse tumor cells. Oncolytic viruses generally are designed or
selected to selectively replicate in tumor cells.
[0138]As used herein, angiogenesis is encompasses the totality of
processes directly or indirectly involved in the establishment and
maintenance of new vasculature (neovascularization), including, but not
limited to, neovascularization associated with tumors and
neovascularization associated with wounds.
[0139]As used herein, "disease or disorder" refers to a pathological
condition in an organism resulting from, for example, infection or
genetic defect, and characterized by identifiable symptoms.
[0140]As used herein, neoplasia refers to the process of abnormal growth,
for example, of a cell, tissue or organ. The growth is abnormal in that
it is an uncontrolled, generally unrestrained and progressive
multiplication of cells typically under conditions that would not
normally induce growth and/or that normally would prevent growth. Such
abnormal growth can result in the generation of an abnormal mass,
referred to as a neoplasm or tumor, which can be benign or malignant.
Unlike hyperplasia, neoplastic proliferation persists even in the absence
of the original stimulus.
[0141]As used herein, neoplastic disease refers to any disease or disorder
associated with neoplasia, whether benign or malignant. Examples of such
diseases or disorders include, but are not limited to, malignant
neoplastic diseases or disorders involving cancer, including tumor
development, growth, metastasis and progression. For example,
hematological malignancies affecting blood, bone marrow and/or lymph
nodes, including leukemia, lymphoma and multiple myeloma, are types of
neoplastic diseases or disorders.
[0142]As used herein, malignant, as it applies to tumors, refers to
primary tumors that have the capacity to invade surrounding tissues and
metastasize with loss of growth control and positional control. In
contrast, benign tumors do not invade surrounding tissues or metastasize
to other areas of an organism.
[0143]As used herein, metastasis refers to a growth of abnormal or
neoplastic cells distant from the site primarily involved by the morbid
process. For example, in the metastatic process, malignant cells can
spread from the site of the primary tumor in which they arose and move
into lymphatic and blood vessels which transport the cells to normal
tissues elsewhere in an organism where the cells continue to proliferate.
[0144]As used herein, cancer is a general term for diseases caused by or
characterized by any type of malignant tumor. Exemplary cancers include,
but are not limited to carcinoma, sarcoma, mesothelioma, and, in
particular, pancreatic cancer, lung cancer, ovarian cancer, breast
cancer, cervical cancer, bladder cancer, prostate cancer, colorectal
cancer, glioma tumors, adenocarcinomas, liver cancer and skin cancer.
[0145]As used herein, the term "proliferative condition" refers to any
abnormal condition that includes proliferation and/or recruitment of
cells. While the condition is abnormal, the cellular proliferation that
occurs in the condition can be considered normal or abnormal. For
example, the cellular proliferation can be a transient increase in cell
numbers such as might occur in typically normal physiological processes
including, but not limited to, wound healing and immune responses, for
example as occurs in the inflammatory response. The cellular
proliferation can be abnormal, such as occurs in neoplasia (both benign
and malignant), excessive, misdirected and/or inappropriate immune
responses and hyperplasia. An area in which such a proliferative
condition occurs is referred to herein as a proliferative site or site of
proliferation.
[0146]As used herein, hyperplasia refers to an increase in the number of
cells of an organ or tissue and generally is associated with an increase
in size of the organ or tissue. Examples of hyperplasia include, but are
not limited to, polycystic ovary syndrome, congenital adrenal
hyperplasia, benign prostatic hyperplasia and hyperplasia of the breast
(e.g., benign ductal or lobular hyperplasia).
[0147]As used herein, inflammation refers to a condition normally arising
due to an immune response to a stimulus, such as, an external or internal
insult, for example, an infection (e.g., fungal, parasitic, bacterial or
viral), foreign substance or irritation. Inflammation can be local or
systemic within an organism and is often characterized by swelling, pain,
redness as well as organ dysfunction. Inflammation involves the movement
of fluid and cells (e.g., white blood cells or leukocytes, neutrophils,
monocytes and T- and B-cells) into the affected area, site or tissue. In
some instances, the immune system can trigger an inflammatory response in
the absence of a typical insult. Such excessive, misdirected and/or
inappropriate immune inflammatory responses can lead to damage of normal,
healthy body tissues and are associated with certain diseases and
disorders, including, for example, autoimmune diseases and disorders.
There are a number of diseases and disorders that can involve
inflammation, both neoplastic and non-neoplastic or non-malignant
(benign) diseases. Examples of such diseases and disorders include, but
are not limited to, arteritis, arthritis, psoriasis, fibroproliferative
disorders, restinosis, stenosis, neurodegenerative diseases, sepsis,
appendicitis, myocarditis, nephritis, colitis, gastritis, atherosclerosis
or arteriosclerosis, inflammatory bowel disease, systemic lupus
erythematosis, multiple sclerosis, type 1 diabetes, Crohn's disease, and
coronary artery disease.
[0148]As used herein, the term "wound" refers to a physical trauma to an
organism that can damage cells, tissues, organs and systems of the
organism. Wounds include open wounds, such as incisions, burns,
lacerations, abrasions, puncture wounds and penetration wounds, which are
exposed to the environment, and closed wounds, which are typically
internal to the organism and include, for example, contusions, hematomas
and crushing injuries.
[0149]As used herein, an anti-cancer agent or compound (used
interchangeably with "anti-tumor or anti-neoplastic agent") refers to any
agents, or compounds, used in anti-cancer treatment. These include any
agents, when used alone or in combination with other compounds, that can
alleviate, reduce, ameliorate, prevent, or place or maintain in a state
of remission of clinical symptoms or diagnostic markers associated with
neoplastic disease, tumors and cancer, and can be used in methods,
combinations and compositions provided herein. Exemplary anti-neoplastic
agents include, but are not limited to, the microorganisms and cells
provided herein used singly or in combination and/or in combination with
other agents, such as alkylating agents, anti-metabolite, certain natural
products, platinum coordination complexes (e.g., cisplatin, carboplatin,
and oxaliplatinum), anthracenediones, substituted ureas, methylhydrazine
derivatives, adrenocortical suppressants, certain hormones, antagonists
and anti-cancer polysaccharides.
[0150]As used herein, a method for treating or preventing neoplastic
disease means that any of the symptoms, such as the tumor, metastasis
thereof, the vascularization of the tumors or other parameters by which
the disease is characterized are reduced, ameliorated, prevented, placed
in a state of remission, or maintained in a state of remission. It also
means that the hallmarks of neoplastic disease and metastasis can be
eliminated, reduced or prevented by the treatment. Non-limiting examples
of the hallmarks include uncontrolled degradation of the basement
membrane and proximal extracellular matrix, migration, division, and
organization of the endothelial cells into new functioning capillaries,
and the persistence of such functioning capillaries.
[0151]As used herein, therapeutic agents are agents that ameliorate the
symptoms of a disease or disorder or ameliorate the disease or disorder.
Therapeutic agent, therapeutic compound, therapeutic regimen, or
chemotherapeutic include conventional drugs and drug therapies, including
vaccines, which are known to those skilled in the art and described
elsewhere herein. Therapeutic agents include, but are not limited to,
moieties that inhibit cell growth or promote cell death, that can be
activated to inhibit cell growth or promote cell death, or that activate
another agent to inhibit cell growth or promote cell death. Optionally,
the therapeutic agent can exhibit or manifest additional properties, such
as, properties that permit its use as an imaging agent, as described
elsewhere herein. Exemplary therapeutic agents include, for example,
cytokines, growth factors, photosensitizing agents, radionuclides,
toxins, anti-metabolites, signaling modulators, anti-cancer antibiotics,
anti-cancer antibodies, angiogenesis inhibitors, radiation therapy,
chemotherapeutic compounds or a combination thereof.
[0152]As used herein, a prodrug is a compound that, upon in vivo
administration, is metabolized or otherwise converted to the
biologically, pharmaceutically or therapeutically active form of the
compound. To produce a prodrug, the pharmaceutically active compound is
modified such that the active compound is regenerated by metabolic
processes. The prodrug can be designed to alter the metabolic stability
or the transport characteristics of a drug, to mask side effects or
toxicity, to improve the flavor of a drug or to alter other
characteristics or properties of a drug. By virtue of knowledge of
pharmacodynamic processes and drug metabolism in vivo, those of skill in
this art, once a pharmaceutically active compound is known, can design
prodrugs of the compound (see, e.g., Nogrady (1985) Medicinal Chemistry A
Biochemical Approach, Oxford University Press, New York, pages 388-392).
Prodrugs include, but are not limited to, 5-fluorouracil, gancyclovir,
and other as described elsewhere herein.
[0153]As used herein, a compound conjugated to a moiety refers to a
complex that includes a compound bound to a moiety, where the binding
between the compound and the moiety can arise from one or more covalent
bonds or non-covalent interactions such as hydrogen bonds, or
electrostatic interactions. A conjugate also can include a linker that
connects the compound to the moiety. Exemplary compounds include, but are
not limited to, nanoparticles and siderophores. Exemplary moieties,
include, but are not limited to, detectable moieties and therapeutic
agents.
[0154]As used herein, nanoparticle refers to a microscopic particle whose
size is measured in nanometers. Often such particles in nanoscale are
used in biomedical applications acting as drug carriers or imaging
agents. Nanoparticles can be conjugated to other agents, including, but
not limited to detectable/diagnostic agents or therapeutic agents.
[0155]As used herein, a detectable label or detectable moiety or
diagnostic moiety (also imaging label, imaging agent, or imaging moiety)
refers to an atom, molecule or composition, wherein the presence of the
atom, molecule or composition can be directly or indirectly measured. As
used herein, a detectable moiety or an imaging moiety refer to moieties
used to image a microorganism or cell in any of the methods provided
herein. Imaging (detectable) moieties include, for example,
chemiluminescent moieties, bioluminescent moieties, fluorescent moieties,
radionuclides and metals. Such a label can be detected, for example, by
visual inspection, by fluorescence spectroscopy, by reflectance
measurement, by flow cytometry, by X-rays, by a variety magnetic
resonance methods such as magnetic resonance imaging (MRI) and magnetic
resonance spectroscopy (MRS), and also include any of a variety of
tomographic methods including computed tomography (CT), computed axial
tomography (CAT), electron beam computed tomography (EBCT), high
resolution computed tomography (HRCT), hypocycloidal tomography, positron
emission tomography (PET), single-photon emission computed tomography
(SPECT), spiral computed tomography and ultrasonic tomography. Direct
detection of a detectable label refers to, for example, measurement of a
physical phenomenon, such as energy or particle emission or absorption of
the moiety itself, such as by X-ray or MRI. Indirect detection refers to
measurement of a physical phenomenon, such as energy or particle emission
or absorption, of an atom, molecule or composition that binds directly or
indirectly to the detectable moiety. In a non-limiting example of
indirect detection, a detectable label can be biotin, which can be
detected by binding to avidin. Non-labeled avidin can be administered
systemically to block non-specific binding, followed by systemic
administration of labeled avidin. Thus, included within the scope of a
detectable label or detectable moiety is a bindable label or bindable
moiety, which refers to an atom, molecule or composition, wherein the
presence of the atom, molecule or composition can be detected as a result
of the label or moiety binding to another atom, molecule or composition.
Exemplary diagnostic agents include, for example, metals such as
colloidal gold, iron, gadolinium, and gallium-67, fluorescent moieties
and radionuclides. Exemplary fluorescent moieties and radionuclides are
provided elsewhere herein.
[0156]As used herein, magnetic resonance imaging (MRI) refers to the use
of a nuclear magnetic resonance spectrometer to produce electronic images
of specific atoms and molecular structures in solids, especially human
cells, tissues and organs. MRI is non-invasive diagnostic technique that
uses nuclear magnetic resonance to produce cross-sectional images of
organs and other internal body structures. The subject lies inside a
large, hollow cylinder containing a strong electromagnet, which causes
the nuclei of certain atoms in the body (such as, for example, .sup.1H,
.sup.13C and .sup.19F) to align magnetically. The subject is then
subjected to radio waves, which cause the aligned nuclei to flip; when
the radio waves are withdrawn the nuclei return to their original
positions, emitting radio waves that are then detected by a receiver and
translated into a two-dimensional picture by computer. For some MRI
procedures, contrast agents such as gadolinium are used to increase the
accuracy of the images.
[0157]As used herein, an X-ray refers to a relatively high-energy photon,
or a stream of such photons, having a wavelength in the approximate range
from 0.01 to 10 nanometers. X-rays also refer to photographs taken with
x-rays.
[0158]As used herein, an in vivo method refers to a method performed
within the living body of a subject.
[0159]As used herein, a positive result refers to detection of a tumor
using the methods provided herein relative to non-tumorous tissues or
organs.
[0160]As used herein, a negative result refers to absence of detection of
a tumor relative to non-tumorous tissues or organs using the methods
provided herein. As used herein, absence of detection of a tumor refers
to the inability to distinguish a tumor relative to non-tumorous tissues
or organs using the methods provided herein.
[0161]As used herein, enrichment refers to a selective isolation and/or
collection of one type of bacterium from a mixed culture of bacteria.
Enrichment can be any level of percentage of increase in one type of
bacterium, including but not limited to, about 1%, 2%, 3%, 4%, 5%, 10%,
20%, 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 90%, 95% or 100% of one type of
bacterium compared to a mixed culture of bacteria. Bacterial cultures and
plating of serial dilutions on agar, for example, can be used to
determine the percentage of enrichment.
[0162]As used herein, a subject includes any organism, including an
animal, for whom diagnosis, screening, monitoring or treatment is
contemplated. Animals include mammals such as primates and domesticated
animals. An exemplary primate is human. A patient refers to a subject
such as a mammal, primate, human or livestock subject afflicted with a
disease condition or for which a disease condition is to be determined or
risk of a disease condition is to be determined.
[0163]As used herein, treatment means any manner in which the symptoms of
a condition, disorder or disease are ameliorated or otherwise
beneficially altered. Treatment also encompasses any pharmaceutical use
of the microorganisms or cells described and provided herein.
[0164]As used herein, amelioration of the symptoms of a particular
disorder such as by administration of a particular pharmaceutical
composition refers to any lessening, whether permanent or temporary,
lasting or transient that can be attributed to or associated with
administration of the composition.
[0165]As used herein, an effective amount of a microorganism, cell, or
compound for treating a particular disease is an amount that is
sufficient to ameliorate, or in some manner reduce the symptoms
associated with the disease. Such an amount can be administered as a
single dosage or can be administered according to a regimen, whereby it
is effective. The amount can cure the disease but, typically, is
administered in order to ameliorate the symptoms of the disease. Repeated
administration can be required to achieve the desired amelioration of
symptoms.
[0166]As used herein, nucleic acids include DNA, RNA and analogs thereof,
including peptide nucleic acids (PNA) and mixtures thereof. Nucleic acids
can be single or double-stranded. Gene can encode, for example, DNA, DNA
encoding regulatory RNAs, siRNAs, functional RNAs, etc. When referring to
probes or primers, which are optionally labeled, such as with a
detectable label, such as a fluorescent or radiolabel, single-stranded
molecules are provided. Such molecules are typically of a length such
that their target is statistically unique or of low copy number
(typically less than 5, generally less than 3) for probing or priming a
library. Generally a probe or primer contains at least 14, 16 or 30
contiguous nucleotides of sequence complementary to or identical to a
gene of interest. Probes and primers can be 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10 or more, 20
or more, 30 or more, 50 or more, 100 or more nucleic acids long.
[0167]As used herein, operative linkage of heterologous nucleic acids to
regulatory and effector sequences of nucleotides, such as promoters,
enhancers, transcriptional and translational stop sites, and other signal
sequences refers to the relationship between such nucleic acid, such as
DNA, and such sequences of nucleotides. For example, operative linkage of
heterologous DNA to a promoter refers to the physical relationship
between the DNA and the promoter such that the transcription of such DNA
is initiated from the promoter by an RNA polymerase that specifically
recognizes, binds to and transcribes the DNA. Thus, operatively linked or
operationally associated refers to the functional relationship of a
nucleic acid, such as DNA, with regulatory and effector sequences of
nucleotides, such as promoters, enhancers, transcriptional and
translational stop sites, and other signal sequences. For example,
operative linkage of DNA to a promoter refers to the physical and
functional relationship between the DNA and the promoter such that the
transcription of such DNA is initiated from the promoter by an RNA
polymerase that specifically recognizes, binds to and transcribes the
DNA. In order to optimize expression and/or transcription, it can be
necessary to remove, add or alter 5' untranslated portions of the clones
to eliminate extra, potentially inappropriate alternative translation
initiation (i.e., start) codons or other sequences that can interfere
with or reduce expression, either at the level of transcription or
translation. In addition, consensus ribosome binding sites can be
inserted immediately 5' of the start codon and can enhance expression
(see, e.g., Kozak (1991) J. Biol. Chem. 266:19867-19870; Shine and
Dalgarno (1975) Nature 254(5495):34-38). The desirability of (or need
for) such modification can be empirically determined.
[0168]As used herein, a sequence complementary to at least a portion of an
RNA, with reference to antisense oligonucleotides, means a sequence of
nucleotides having sufficient complementarity to be able to hybridize
with the RNA, generally under moderate or high stringency conditions,
forming a stable duplex; in the case of double-stranded antisense nucleic
acids, a single strand of the duplex DNA (or dsRNA) can thus be tested,
or triplex formation can be assayed. The ability to hybridize depends on
the degree of complementarily and the length of the antisense nucleic
acid. Generally, the longer the hybridizing nucleic acid, the more base
mismatches with an encoding RNA it can contain and still form a stable
duplex (or triplex, as the case can be). One skilled in the art can
ascertain a tolerable degree of mismatch by use of standard procedures to
determine the melting point of the hybridized complex.
[0169]As used herein, primer refers to an oligonucleotide containing two
or more deoxyribonucleotides or ribonucleotides, typically more than
three, from which synthesis of a primer extension product can be
initiated. Typically a primer contains a free 3' hydroxy moiety.
Experimental conditions conducive to synthesis of a gene product include
the presence of nucleoside triphosphates and an agent for polymerization
and extension, such as DNA polymerase, and a suitable buffer,
temperature, and pH.
[0170]As used herein, a promoter region or promoter element or regulatory
region refers to a segment of DNA or RNA that controls transcription of
the DNA or RNA to which it is operatively linked. The promoter region
includes specific sequences that are sufficient for RNA polymerase
recognition, binding and transcription initiation. This portion of the
promoter region is referred to as the promoter. In addition, the promoter
region includes sequences that modulate this recognition, binding and
transcription initiation activity of RNA polymerase. These sequences can
be cis acting or can be responsive to trans acting factors. Promoters,
depending upon the nature of the regulation, can be constitutive or
regulated. Exemplary promoters contemplated for use in prokaryotes
include, but are not limited to, the bacteriophage T7 and T3 promoters,
E. coli araBAD promoter (GenBank Accession No. K00953, SEQ ID NO:2), E.
coli ompA promoter (SEQ ID NO:4), E. coli lac promoter (SEQ ID NO:61,
Schnetz (1995) Embo J. 14(11):2545-2550), E. coli trp promoter (SEQ ID
NO:62, de Boer et al. (1983) PNAS 80, 21), E. coli tac promoter (SEQ ID
NO:63, deBoer et al. (1983) PNAS USA 80(1); 21-5), Bacillus subtilis rpsJ
promoter (GenBank Accession No. U43929, SEQ ID NO:3), and Bacillus
megaterium xylA promoter (Genbank Accession No. Z71474, SEQ ID NO:15).
[0171]As used herein, production by recombinant means by using recombinant
DNA methods means the use of the well known methods of molecular biology
for expressing proteins encoded by cloned DNA.
[0172]As used herein, vector (or plasmid) refers to discrete elements that
are used to introduce heterologous nucleic acid into cells for either
expression or replication thereof. The vectors typically remain episomal,
but can be designed to effect stable integration of a gene or portion
thereof into a chromosome of the genome. Also contemplated are vectors
that are artificial chromosomes, such as yeast artificial chromosomes and
mammalian artificial chromosomes. Selection and use of such vectors are
well known to those of skill in the art. An expression vector includes
vectors capable of expressing DNA that is operatively linked with
regulatory sequences, such as promoter regions, that are capable of
effecting expression of such DNA fragments. Thus, an expression vector
refers to a recombinant DNA or RNA construct, such as a plasmid, a phage,
recombinant virus or other vector that, upon introduction into an
appropriate host cell, results in expression of the cloned DNA.
Appropriate expression vectors are well known to those of skill in the
art and include those that are replicable in eukaryotic cells and/or
prokaryotic cells and those that remain episomal or those which integrate
into the host cell genome. Exemplary vectors include, but are not limited
to the plasmid vectors ColE1, pBR322, p15A, pEMBLex2, pMAL-p2, pUC18A2 (a
pUC18-derived plasmid containing the ftn gene), pUC118, pGS281, pMK4,
pUNK1, pAM.beta.1 and pTA1060.
[0173]Methods for modifying vectors (or plasmids) to affect replication
and maintenance of the vector in bacteria are well known to one skilled
in the art based on the early characterization of the molecule, including
its nucleotide sequence, replication and maintenance mechanisms, and
determination of its coding regions (Balbas and Bolivar (2004) Methods
Mol. Biol. 267:77-90; Grabherr and Bayer (2002) Trends Biotechnol.
20(6):257-260; Jung and Lee (1995) Mol. Biol. Rep. 22(2-3): 195-200).
[0174]As used herein, production by recombinant means by using recombinant
DNA methods means the use of the well known methods of molecular biology
for expressing proteins encoded by cloned DNA.
[0175]As used herein, an amplifiable signaling nucleic acid refers to a
nucleic acid that can be amplified using known amplification methods such
as polymerase chain reaction (PCR).
[0176]As used herein, genetic therapy or gene therapy involves the
transfer of heterologous nucleic acid, such as DNA or RNA, into certain
cells, target cells, of a mammal, particularly a human, with a disorder
or conditions for which such therapy is sought. As used herein, genetic
therapy or gene therapy can involve the transfer of heterologous nucleic
acid, such as DNA, into a microorganism or cell (e.g., a virus, a
bacterium, or a eukaryotic cell), which microorganism or cell can be
transferred to a mammal, particularly a human, with a disorder or
conditions for which such therapy is sought. The nucleic acid, such as
DNA, is introduced into the selected target cells, such as directly or
indirectly, in a manner such that the heterologous nucleic acid, such as
DNA, is expressed and a therapeutic product encoded thereby is produced.
Alternatively, the heterologous nucleic acid, such as DNA, can in some
manner mediate expression of DNA that encodes the therapeutic product, or
it can encode a product, such as a peptide or RNA that is in some manner
a therapeutic product, or which mediates, directly or indirectly,
expression of a therapeutic product. Genetic therapy also can be used to
deliver nucleic acid encoding a gene product that replaces a defective
gene or supplements a gene product produced by the mammal or the cell in
which it is introduced. The introduced nucleic acid can encode a
therapeutic compound. The heterologous nucleic acid, such as DNA,
encoding the therapeutic product can be modified prior to introduction
into the cells of the afflicted host in order to enhance or otherwise
alter the product or expression thereof. Genetic therapy also can involve
delivery of an inhibitor or repressor or other modulator of gene
expression.
[0177]As used herein, a heterologous nucleic acid (or an exogenous nucleic
acid) refers to a nucleic acid that is not normally produced in vivo by
the microorganism or cell from which it is expressed or that is produced
by a microorganism or cell but is at a different locus or expressed
differently or that mediates or encodes mediators that alter expression
of endogenous nucleic acid, such as DNA, by affecting transcription,
translation, or other regulatable biochemical processes. Heterologous
nucleic acid is often not endogenous to the cell into which it is
introduced, but has been obtained from another cell or prepared
synthetically. Heterologous nucleic acid, however, can be endogenous, but
is nucleic acid that is expressed from a different locus or altered in
its expression or sequence (e.g., a plasmid). Generally, although not
necessarily, such nucleic acid encodes RNA and proteins that are not
normally produced by the cell or in the same way in the cell in which it
is expressed. Heterologous nucleic acid, such as DNA, also can be
referred to as foreign nucleic acid, such as DNA. Thus, heterologous
nucleic acid or foreign nucleic acid includes a nucleic acid molecule not
present in the exact orientation or position as the counterpart nucleic
acid molecule, such as DNA, is found in a genome. It also can refer to a
nucleic acid molecule from another organism or species (i.e., exogenous).
Any nucleic acid, such as DNA, that one of skill in the art would
recognize or consider as heterologous or foreign to the cell in which the
nucleic acid is expressed is herein encompassed by heterologous nucleic
acid; heterologous nucleic acid includes exogenously added nucleic acid
that also is expressed endogenously. Examples of heterologous nucleic
acid include, but are not limited to, nucleic acid that encodes exogenous
peptides/proteins (e.g., cell surface receptors, siderophores, ferritins,
etc.), nucleic acid that encodes traceable marker proteins (e.g., a
protein that confers drug resistance), nucleic acid that encodes
therapeutically effective substances (e.g., anti-cancer agents, enzymes
and hormones), and nucleic acid, such as DNA, that encodes other types of
proteins, such as antibodies. Antibodies that are encoded by heterologous
nucleic acid can be secreted or expressed on the surface of the cell in
which the heterologous nucleic acid has been introduced.
[0178]As used herein, the terms overproduce or overexpress when used in
reference to a substance, molecule, compound or composition made in a
cell or microorganism refers to production or expression at a level that
is greater than a baseline, normal or usual level of production or
expression of the substance, molecule, compound or composition by the
cell or microorganism. A baseline, normal or usual level of production or
expression includes no production/expression or limited, restricted or
regulated production/expression. Such overproduction or overexpression is
typically achieved by modification of a microorganism or cell. For
example, a microorganism or cell can be modified or supplemented to
contain extra or additional components, such as nucleic acids, that are
involved in the production or expression of the substance, molecule,
compound or composition. A microorganism or cell can be modified such
that any existing production/expression systems are altered to increase
production/expression, such as, for example, eliminating or reducing
repression of the expression of an existing gene or altering the timing
of expression of a gene. Such modifications can be achieved, for example,
using standard methods of recombinant DNA technologies known to those of
skill in the art. Such modification is referred to as heterologous
overproduction or overexpression and the microorganism or cell is
referred to as one that heterologously overproduces or overexpresses.
Modification of a microorganism or cell to obtain overproduction or
overexpression can be also be achieved by mutagenesis, for example, by
subjecting a microorganism or cell to conditions, such as growth under
particular selective or mutagenic conditions followed by identification
of a modified microorganism or cell that overproduces or overexpresses.
[0179]As used herein, a therapeutically effective product for gene therapy
is a product that is encoded by heterologous nucleic acid, typically DNA,
or an RNA product such as dsRNA, RNAi, including siRNA, that upon
introduction of the nucleic acid into a host, a product is expressed that
ameliorates or eliminates the symptoms, manifestations of an inherited or
acquired disease or that cures the disease. Also included are
biologically active nucleic acid molecules, such as RNAi and antisense.
[0180]As used herein, an agent or compound that modulates the activity of
a protein or expression of a gene or nucleic acid either decreases or
increases or otherwise alters the activity of the protein or, in some
manner, up- or down-regulates or otherwise alters expression of the
nucleic acid in a cell.
[0181]As used herein, recitation that amino acids of a polypeptide
"correspond to" amino acids in a disclosed sequence, such as amino acids
set forth in the Sequence listing, refers to amino acids identified upon
alignment of the polypeptide with the disclosed sequence to maximize
identity or homology (where conserved amino acids are aligned) using a
standard alignment algorithm, such as the GAP algorithm. By aligning the
sequences of polypeptides, one skilled in the art can identify
corresponding residues, using conserved and identical amino acid residues
as guides.
[0182]As used herein, the terms "homology" and "identity"" are used
interchangeably, but homology for proteins can include conservative amino
acid changes. In general, to identify corresponding positions, the
sequences of amino acids are aligned so that the highest order match is
obtained (see, e.g.: Computational Molecular Biology, Lesk, A. M., ed.,
Oxford University Press, New York, 1988; Biocomputing: Informatics and
Genome Projects, Smith, D. W., ed., Academic Press, New York, 1993;
Computer Analysis of Sequence Data, Part I, Griffin, A. M., and Griffin,
H. G., eds., Humana Press, New Jersey, 1994; Sequence Analysis in
Molecular Biology, von Heinje, G., Academic Press, 1987; and Sequence
Analysis Primer, Gribskov, M. and Devereux, J., eds., M Stockton Press,
New York, 1991; Carillo et al. (1988) SIAM J Applied Math 48:1073).
[0183]As use herein, "sequence identity" refers to the number of identical
amino acids (or nucleotide bases) in a comparison between a test and a
reference polypeptide or polynucleotide. Homologous polypeptides refer to
a pre-determined number of identical or homologous amino acid residues.
Homology includes conservative amino acid substitutions as well identical
residues. Sequence identity can be determined by standard alignment
algorithm programs used with default gap penalties established by each
supplier. Homologous nucleic acid molecules refer to a pre-determined
number of identical or homologous nucleotides. Homology includes
substitutions that do not change the encoded amino acid (i.e., "silent
substitutions") as well identical residues. Substantially homologous
nucleic acid molecules hybridize typically at moderate stringency or at
high stringency all along the length of the nucleic acid or along at
least about 70%, 80% or 90% of the full-length nucleic acid molecule of
interest. Also contemplated are nucleic acid molecules that contain
degenerate codons in place of codons in the hybridizing nucleic acid
molecule. (For determination of homology of proteins, conservative amino
acids can be aligned as well as identical amino acids; in this case,
percentage of identity and percentage homology vary). Whether any two
nucleic acid molecules have nucleotide sequences (or any two polypeptides
have amino acid sequences) that are at least 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, 96%,
97%, 98% or 99% "identical" can be determined using known computer
algorithms such as the "FAST A" program, using for example, the default
parameters as in Pearson et al. (1988) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 85:2444
(other programs include the GCG program package (Devereux, J., et al.
(1984) Nucleic Acids Research 12(I):387), BLASTP, BLASTN, FASTA (Atschul,
S. F., et al. (1990) J. Molec. Biol. 215:403; Guide to Huge Computers,
Martin J. Bishop, ed., Academic Press, San Diego (1994), and Carillo et
al. (1988) SIAMJ Applied Math 48:1073). For example, the BLAST function
of the National Center for Biotechnology Information database can be used
to determine identity. Other commercially or publicly available programs
include, DNAStar "MegAlign" program (Madison, Wis.) and the University of
Wisconsin Genetics Computer Group (UWG) "Gap" program (Madison Wis.)).
Percent homology or identity of proteins and/or nucleic acid molecules
can be determined, for example, by comparing sequence information using a
GAP computer program (e.g., Needleman et al. (1970) J. Mol. Biol. 48:443,
as revised by Smith and Waterman (1981) Adv. Appl. Math. 2:482. Briefly,
a GAP program defines similarity as the number of aligned symbols (i.e.,
nucleotides or amino acids) which are similar, divided by the total
number of symbols in the shorter of the two sequences. Default parameters
for the GAP program can include: (1) a unary comparison matrix
(containing a value of 1 for identities and 0 for non identities) and the
weighted comparison matrix of Gribskov et al. (1986) Nucl. Acids Res.
14:6745, as described by Schwartz and Dayhoff, eds. (1979) Atlas of
Protein Sequence and Structure, National Biomedical Research Foundation,
pp. 353-358; (2) a penalty of 3.0 for each gap and an additional 0.10
penalty for each symbol in each gap; and (3) no penalty for end gaps.
Therefore, as used herein, the term "identity" represents a comparison
between a test and a reference polypeptide or polynucleotide. In one
non-limiting example, "at least 90% identical to" refers to percent
identities from 90 to 100% relative to the reference polypeptides.
Identity at a level of 90% or more is indicative of the fact that,
assuming for exemplification purposes a test and reference polynucleotide
length of 100 amino acids are compared, no more than 10% (i.e., 10 out of
100) of amino acids in the test polypeptide differs from that of the
reference polypeptides. Similar comparisons can be made between a test
and reference polynucleotides. Such differences can be represented as
point mutations randomly distributed over the entire length of an amino
acid sequence or they can be clustered in one or more locations of
varying length up to the maximum allowable, e.g., 10/100 amino acid
difference (approximately 90% identity). Differences are defined as
nucleic acid or amino acid substitutions, insertions or deletions. At the
level of homologies or identifies above about 85-90%, the result should
be independent of the program and gap parameters set; such high levels of
identity can be assessed readily, often without relying on software.
[0184]The term substantially identical or homologous or similar varies
with the context as understood by those skilled in the relevant art and
generally means at least 60% or 70%, preferably means at least 80%, more
preferably at least 90%, and most preferably at least 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%,
99% or greater identity. As used herein, substantially identical to a
product means sufficiently similar so that the property of interest is
sufficiently unchanged so that the substantially identical product can be
used in place of the product.
[0185]As used herein, substantially pure means sufficiently homogeneous to
appear free of readily detectable impurities as determined by standard
methods of analysis, such as thin layer chromatography (TLC), gel
electrophoresis and high performance liquid chromatography (HPLC), used
by those of skill in the art to assess such purity, or sufficiently pure
such that further purification would not detectably alter the physical
and chemical properties, such as enzymatic and biological activities, of
the substance. Methods for purification of the compounds to produce
substantially chemically pure compounds are known to those of skill in
the art. A substantially chemically pure compound can, however, be a
mixture of stereoisomers or isomers. In such instances, further
purification might increase the specific activity of the compound.
[0186]As used herein equivalent, when referring to two sequences of
nucleic acids, means that the two sequences in question encode the same
sequence of amino acids or equivalent proteins. When equivalent is used
in referring to two proteins or peptides or other molecules, it means
that the two proteins or peptides have substantially the same amino acid
sequence with only amino acid substitutions (such as, but not limited to,
conservative changes) or structure and the any changes do not
substantially alter the activity or function of the protein or peptide.
When equivalent refers to a property, the property does not need to be
present to the same extent (e.g., two peptides can exhibit different
rates of the same type of enzymatic activity), but the activities are
usually substantially the same. Complementary, when referring to two
nucleotide sequences, means that the two sequences of nucleotides are
capable of hybridizing, typically with less than 25%, 15% or 5%
mismatches between opposed nucleotides. If necessary, the percentage of
complementarity will be specified. Typically the two molecules are
selected such that they will hybridize under conditions of high
stringency.
[0187]As used herein, a receptor refers to a molecule that has an affinity
for a ligand. Receptors can be naturally-occurring or synthetic
molecules. Receptors also can be referred to in the art as anti-ligands.
As used herein, the receptor and anti-ligand are interchangeable.
Receptors can be used in their unaltered state or bound to other
polypeptides, including as homodimers. Receptors can be attached to,
covalently or noncovalently, or in physical contact with, a binding
member, either directly or indirectly via a specific binding substance or
linker. Examples of receptors, include, but are not limited to:
antibodies, cell membrane receptors surface receptors and internalizing
receptors, monoclonal antibodies and antisera reactive with specific
antigenic determinants (such as on viruses, cells, or other materials),
drugs, polynucleotides, nucleic acids, peptides, cofactors, lectins,
sugars, polysaccharides, cells, cellular membranes, and organelles.
[0188]As used herein, bind, bound and binding refer to the binding between
atoms or molecules with a K.sub.d in the range of 10.sup.-2 to 10.sup.-15
mole/L, generally, 10.sup.-6 to 10.sup.-15, 10.sup.-7 to 10.sup.-15 and
typically 10.sup.-8 to 10.sup.-15 (and/or a K.sub.a of
10.sup.-5-10.sup.12, 10.sup.7-10.sup.12, 10.sup.8-10.sup.12 L/mole). As
used herein, luminescence refers to the detectable electromagnetic (EM)
radiation, generally, ultraviolet (U V), infrared (IR) or visible EM
radiation that is produced when the excited product of an exergic
chemical process reverts to its ground state with the emission of light.
Chemiluminescence is luminescence that results from a chemical reaction.
Bioluminescence is chemiluminescence that results from a chemical
reaction using biological molecules (or synthetic versions or analogs
thereof) as substrates and/or enzymes. Fluorescence is luminescence in
which light of a visible color is emitted from a substance under
stimulation or excitation by light or other forms radiation such as
ultraviolet (UV), infrared (IR) or visible EM radiation.
[0189]As used herein, chemiluminescence refers to a chemical reaction in
which energy is specifically channeled to a molecule causing it to become
electronically excited and subsequently to release a photon thereby
emitting visible light. Temperature does not contribute to this channeled
energy. Thus, chemiluminescence involves the direct conversion of
chemical energy to light energy.
[0190]As used herein, bioluminescence, which is a type of
chemiluminescence, refers to the emission of light by biological
molecules, particularly proteins. The essential condition for
bioluminescence is molecular oxygen, either bound or free in the presence
of an oxygenase, a luciferase, which acts on a substrate, a luciferin.
Bioluminescence is generated by an enzyme or other protein (luciferase)
that is an oxygenase that acts on a substrate luciferin (a
bioluminescence substrate) in the presence of molecular oxygen and
transforms the substrate to an excited state, which, upon return to a
lower energy level releases the energy in the form of light.
[0191]As used herein, the substrates and enzymes for producing
bioluminescence are generically referred to as luciferin and luciferase,
respectively. When reference is made to a particular species thereof, for
clarity, each generic term is used with the name of the organism from
which it derives such as, for example, click beetle luciferase or firefly
luciferase.
[0192]As used herein, luciferase refers to oxygenases that catalyze a
light emitting reaction. For instance, bacterial luciferases catalyze the
oxidation of flavin mononucleotide (FMN) and aliphatic aldehydes, which
reaction produces light. Another class of luciferases, found among marine
arthropods, catalyzes the oxidation of Cypridina (Vargula) luciferin and
another class of luciferases catalyzes the oxidation of Coleoptera
luciferin.
[0193]Thus, luciferase refers to an enzyme or photoprotein that catalyzes
a bioluminescent reaction (a reaction that produces bioluminescence). The
luciferases, such as firefly and Gaussia and Renilla luciferases, are
enzymes which act catalytically and are unchanged during the
bioluminescence generating reaction. The luciferase photoproteins, such
as the aequorin photoprotein to which luciferin is non-covalently bound,
are changed, such as by release of the luciferin, during bioluminescence
generating reaction. The luciferase is a protein, or a mixture of
proteins (e.g., bacterial luciferase), that occurs naturally in an
organism or a variant or mutant thereof, such as a variant produced by
mutagenesis that has one or more properties, such as thermal stability,
that differ from the naturally-occurring protein. Luciferases and
modified mutant or variant forms thereof are well known. For purposes
herein, reference to luciferase refers to either the photoproteins or
luciferases.
[0194]Thus, reference, for example, to Renilla luciferase refers to an
enzyme isolated from member of the genus Renilla or an equivalent
molecule obtained from any other source, such as from another related
copepod, or that has been prepared synthetically. It is intended to
encompass Renilla luciferases with conservative amino acid substitutions
that do not substantially alter activity. Conservative substitutions of
amino acids are known to those of skill in this art and can be made
generally without altering the biological activity of the resulting
molecule. Those of skill in this art recognize that, in general, single
amino acid substitutions in non-essential regions of a polypeptide do not
substantially alter biological activity (see, e.g., Watson et al.
Molecular Biology of the Gene, 4th Edition, 1987, The Benjamin/Cummings
Pub. co., p. 224).
[0195]As used herein, bioluminescence substrate refers to the compound
that is oxidized in the presence of a luciferase and any necessary
activators and generates light. These substrates are referred to as
luciferins herein, are substrates that undergo oxidation in a
bioluminescence reaction. These bioluminescence substrates include any
luciferin or analog thereof or any synthetic compound with which a
luciferase interacts to generate light. Typical substrates include those
that are oxidized in the presence of a luciferase or protein in a
light-generating reaction. Bioluminescence substrates, thus, include
those compounds that those of skill in the art recognize as luciferins.
Luciferins, for example, include firefly luciferin, Cypridina (also known
as Vargula) luciferin (coelenterazine), bacterial luciferin, as well as
synthetic analogs of these substrates or other compounds that are
oxidized in the presence of a luciferase in a reaction the produces
bioluminescence.
[0196]As used herein, capable of conversion into a bioluminescence
substrate refers to being susceptible to chemical reaction, such as
oxidation or reduction, that yields a bioluminescence substrate. For
example, the luminescence producing reaction of bioluminescent bacteria
involves the reduction of a flavin mononucleotide group (FMN) to reduced
flavin mononucleotide (FMNH.sub.2) by a flavin reductase enzyme. The
reduced flavin mononucleotide (substrate) then reacts with oxygen (an
activator) and bacterial luciferase to form an intermediate peroxy flavin
that undergoes further reaction, in the presence of a long-chain
aldehyde, to generate light. With respect to this reaction, the reduced
flavin and the long chain aldehyde are substrates.
[0197]As used herein, a bioluminescence generating system refers to the
set of reagents required to conduct a bioluminescent reaction. Thus, the
specific luciferase, luciferin and other substrates, solvents and other
reagents that can be required to complete a bioluminescent reaction form
a bioluminescence system. Thus a bioluminescence generating system refers
to any set of reagents that, under appropriate reaction conditions, yield
bioluminescence. Appropriate reaction conditions refers to the conditions
necessary for a bioluminescence reaction to occur, such as pH, salt
concentrations and temperature. In general, bioluminescence systems
include a bioluminescence substrate, luciferin, a luciferase, which
includes enzymes luciferases and photoproteins and one or more
activators. A specific bioluminescence system can be identified by
reference to the specific organism from which the luciferase derives; for
example, the Renilla bioluminescence system includes a Renilla
luciferase, such as a luciferase isolated from Renilla or produced using
recombinant methods or modifications of these luciferases. This system
also includes the particular activators necessary to complete the
bioluminescence reaction, such as oxygen and a substrate with which the
luciferase reacts in the presence of the oxygen to produce light.
[0198]As used herein, a fluorescent protein (FP) refers to a protein that
possesses the ability to fluoresce (i.e., to absorb energy at one
wavelength and emit it at another wavelength). For example, a green
fluorescent protein (GFP) refers to a polypeptide that has a peak in the
emission spectrum at 510 nm or about 510 nm. A variety of FPs that emit
at various wavelengths are known in the art. Exemplary FPs include, but
are not limited to, a green fluorescent protein (GFP), yellow fluorescent
protein (YFP), orange fluorescent protein (OFP), cyan fluorescent protein
(CFP), blue fluorescent protein (BFP), red fluorescent protein (RFP),
far-red fluorescent protein, or near-infrared fluorescent protein.
Extending the spectrum of available colors of fluorescent proteins to
blue, cyan, orange yellow and red variants, provides a method for
multicolor tracking of fusion proteins.
[0199]As used herein, Aequora GFP refers to GFPs from the genus Aequora
and to mutants or variants thereof. Such variants and GFPs from other
species, such as Anthozoa reef coral, Anemonia sea anemone, Renilla sea
pansy, Galaxea coral, Acropora brown coral, Trachyphyllia and Pectimidae
stony coral and other species are well known and are available and known
to those of skill in the art. Exemplary GFP variants include, but are not
limited to BFP, CFP, YFP and OFP. Examples of flurescent proteins and
their variants include GFP proteins, such as Emerald (InVitrogen,
Carlsbad, Calif.), EGFP (Clontech, Palo Alto, Calif.), Azami-Green (MBL
International, Woburn, Mass.), Kaede (MBL International, Woburn, Mass.),
ZsGreenl (Clontech, Palo Alto, Calif.) and CopGFP (Evrogen/Axxora, LLC,
San Diego, Calif.); CFP proteins, such as Cerulean (Rizzo (2004) Nat.
Biotechnol. 22(4):445-9), mCFP (Wang et al. (2004) PNAS USA. 101
(48):16745-9), AmCyan1 (Clontech, Palo Alto, Calif.), MiCy (MBL
International, Woburn, Mass.), and CyPet (Nguyen and Daugherty (2005)
Nat. Biotechnol. 23(3):355-60); BFP proteins such as EBFP (Clontech, Palo
Alto, Calif.); YFP proteins such as EYFP (Clontech, Palo Alto, Calif.),
YPet (Nguyen and Daugherty (2005) Nat Biotechnol. 23(3):355-60), Venus
(Nagai et al. (2002) Nat. Biotechnol. 20(1):87-90), ZsYellow (Clontech,
Palo Alto, Calif.), and mCitrine (Wang et al. (2004) PNAS USA. 101 (48):
16745-9); OFP proteins such as cOFP (Strategene, La Jolla, Calif.), mKO
(MBL International, Woburn, Mass.), and mOrange; and others (Shaner N C,
Steinbach P A, and Tsien R Y. (2005) Nat. Methods. 2(12):905-9).
[0200]As used herein, red fluorescent protein, or RFP, refers to the
Discosoma RFP (DsRed) that has been isolated from the corallimorph
Discosoma (Matz et al. (1999) Nature Biotechnology 17:969-973), and red
or far-red fluorescent proteins from any other species, such as
Heteractis reef coral and Actinia or Entacmaea sea anemone, as well as
variants thereof. RFPs include, for example, Discosoma variants, such as
mRFP1, mCherry, tdTomato, mStrawberry, mTangerine (Wang et al. (2004)
PNAS U S A. 101(48):16745-9), DsRed2 (Clontech, Palo Alto, Calif.), and
DsRed-T1 (Bevis and Glick (2002) Nat. Biotechnol. 20:83-87), Anthomedusa
J-Red (Evrogen) and Anemonia AsRed2 (Clontech, Palo Alto, Calif.).
Far-red fluorescent proteins include, for example, Actinia AQ143 (Shkrob
et al. (2005) Biochem J 392(Pt 3):649-54), Entacmaea eqFP611 (Wiedenmann
et al. (2002) Proc Natl Acad Sci USA. 99(18):11646-51), Discosoma
variants such as mPlum and mRasberry (Wang et al. (2004) PNAS USA.
101(48):16745-9), and Heteractis HcRed1 and t-HcRed (Clontech, Palo Alto,
Calif.).
[0201]As used herein the term assessing or determining is intended to
include quantitative and qualitative determination in the sense of
obtaining an absolute value for the activity of a product, and also of
obtaining an index, ratio, percentage, visual or other value indicative
of the level of the activity. Assessment can be direct or indirect.
[0202]As used herein, activity refers to the in vivo activities of a
compound or microorganisms and cells on physiological responses that
result following in vivo administration thereof (or of a composition or
other mixture). Activity, thus, encompasses resulting therapeutic effects
and pharmaceutical activity of such compounds, compositions and mixtures.
Activities can be observed in in vitro and/or in vivo systems designed to
test or use such activities.
[0203]As used herein, sample refers to anything that can contain an
analyte for which an analyte assay is desired. The sample can be a
biological sample, such as a biological fluid or a biological tissue.
Examples of biological fluids include urine, blood, plasma, serum,
saliva, semen, stool, sputum, cerebral spinal fluid, tears, mucus,
amniotic fluid or the like. Biological tissues are aggregates of cells,
usually of a particular kind together with their intercellular substance
that form one of the structural materials of a human, animal, plant,
bacterial, fungal or viral structure, including connective, epithelium,
muscle and nerve tissues. Examples of biological tissues also include
organs, tumors, lymph nodes, arteries and individual cell(s).
[0204]As used herein, an immunoassay is defined as any method using a
specific or preferential binding of an antigen with a second material
(i.e., a binding partner, usually an antibody, antibody fragment or
another substance having an antigen binding site) that specifically or
preferentially binds to an epitope of the antigen. The immunoassay
methods provided herein include any known to those of skill in the art,
including, but not limited to, sandwich, competition, agglutination or
precipitation assays.
[0205]As used herein, antibody refers to an immunoglobulin, whether
natural or partially or wholly synthetically produced, including any
derivative thereof that retains the specific binding ability of the
antibody. Hence antibody includes any protein having a binding domain
that is homologous or substantially homologous to an immunoglobulin
binding domain. Antibodies include members of any immunoglobulin class,
including IgG, IgM, IgA, IgD and IgE.
[0206]As used herein, antibody fragment refers to any derivative of an
antibody that is less then full length, retaining at least a portion of
the full-length antibody's specific binding ability. Examples of antibody
fragments include, but are not limited to, Fab, Fab', F(ab)2,
single-chain Fvs (scFV), FV, dsFV diabody and Fd fragments. The fragment
can include multiple chains linked together, such as by disulfide
bridges.
[0207]An antibody fragment generally contains at least about 50 amino
acids and typically at least 200 amino acids.
[0208]As used herein, an Fv antibody fragment is composed of one variable
heavy chain domain (VH) and one variable light chain domain linked by
noncovalent interactions.
[0209]As used herein, a dsFV refers to an Fv with an engineered
intermolecular disulfide bond, which stabilizes the VH-VL pair.
[0210]As used herein, a F(ab).sub.2 fragment is an antibody fragment that
results from digestion of an immunoglobulin with pepsin at pH 4.0-4.5; it
can be recombinantly produced to produce the equivalent fragment.
[0211]As used herein, Fab fragments are antibody fragments that result
from digestion of an immunoglobulin with papain; it can be recombinantly
produced to produce the equivalent fragment.
[0212]As used herein, scFVs refer to antibody fragments that contain a
variable light chain (VL) and variable heavy chain (VH) covalently
connected by a polypeptide linker in any order. The linker is of a length
such that the two variable domains are bridged without substantial
interference. Included linkers are (Gly-Ser)n residues with some Glu or
Lys residues dispersed throughout to increase solubility.
[0213]As used herein, humanized antibodies refer to antibodies that are
modified to include human sequences of amino acids so that administration
to a human does not provoke an immune response. Methods for preparation
of such antibodies are known. For example, to produce such antibodies,
the encoding nucleic acid in the hybridoma or other prokaryotic or
eukaryotic cell, such as an E. coli or a CHO cell that expresses the
monoclonal antibody is altered by recombinant nucleic acid techniques to
express an antibody in which the amino acid composition of the
non-variable region is based on human antibodies. Computer programs have
been designed to identify such non-variable regions.
[0214]As used herein, diabodies are dimeric scFV; diabodies typically have
shorter peptide linkers than scFvs, and they generally dimerize.
[0215]As used herein, a molecule, such as an antibody, that specifically
binds to a polypeptide typically has a binding affinity (Ka) of at least
about 10.sup.6 l/mol, 10.sup.7 l/mol, 10.sup.8 l/mol, 10.sup.9 l/mol,
10.sup.10 l/mol or greater and binds to a protein of interest generally
with at least 2-fold, 5-fold, generally 10-fold or even 100-fold or
greater, affinity than to other proteins. In one non-limiting example, an
antibody that specifically binds to an epitope in, for example, a
streptavidin binding peptide, binds with at least about 2-fold, typically
5-fold, 10-fold higher affinity or 100-fold higher affinity, than it
binds to another peptide. Such specific binding also is referred to as
selective binding. Thus, specific or selective binding refers to greater
binding affinity (generally at least 2-fold, 5-fold, 10-fold or more) to
a targeted site or locus compared to a non-targeted site or locus.
[0216]As used herein, complex refers generally to an association between
two or more species regardless of the nature of the interaction between
the species (i.e., ionic, covalent, or electrostatic).
[0217]As used herein, a combination refers to any association between two
or among more items.
[0218]As used herein, a composition refers to any mixture. It can be a
solution, a suspension, an emulsion, liquid, powder, a paste, aqueous,
non-aqueous or any combination thereof.
[0219]As used herein, fluid refers to any composition that can flow.
Fluids thus encompass compositions that are in the form of semi-solids,
pastes, solutions, aqueous mixtures, gels, lotions, creams and other such
compositions.
[0220]As used herein, a kit is a packaged combination, optionally,
including instructions for use of the combination and/or other reactions
and components for such use.
[0221]For clarity of disclosure, and not by way of limitation, the
detailed description is divided into the subsections that follow.
B. METHODS AND COMPOSITIONS FOR DETECTION AND THERAPY
[0222]Provided herein are methods of detecting a location(s) in a subject
in which a microorganism or cell administered to the subject accumulates
and compositions for use in the methods. Combinations and kits that
include such compositions and that can be used in the methods are also
provided. The methods can be used, for example, to detect or image sites
of cellular proliferation, tumors, tumor tissues, metastases, areas of
inflammation, immunoprivileged sites or tissues, wounds and infections.
Such methods find applications in, for example, detection and diagnosis
of diseases and disorders, evaluating the efficacy of a treatment or
therapy for a disease or disorder, developing non-human animal models for
diseases and disorders, assaying or screening compositions for potential
use as therapeutic agents for the treatment of diseases and disorders and
in tracking or monitoring delivery of compositions to cells and tissues,
including, sites of cellular proliferation, tumors, tumor tissues,
metastases, areas of inflammation, wounds and infections. In one
embodiment, the methods for determining the presence or absence of a
microorganism or cell, or disease or disorder, involve monitoring a
subject or patient to whom a microorganism or cell has been administered
for detection of the microorganism or cell. A particular microorganism
that is monitored for detection in such methods is one that
heterologously overproduces one or more of an iron acquisition, storage,
metabolism, binding or transport molecule. Such microorganisms can be
monitored for detection using a number of techniques, including, but not
limited to techniques capable of detecting a metal, and in particular,
iron, in a subject. A particular detection technique that can be used in
such methods is magnetic resonance imaging (MRI). In another embodiment,
the methods for determining the presence or absence of a microorganism or
cell, or disease or disorder, involve monitoring a subject to whom a
microorganism or cell and a ligand have been administered for detection
of the ligand. In such methods, the microorganism or cell expresses a
siderophore uptake protein and the ligand is one that interacts with the
siderophore uptake protein. A particular ligand that can be monitored for
detection in such methods is a siderophore. The siderophore can be
detected in a number of ways, including, for example, through interaction
with a detectable moiety, such as a metal, which in some embodiments can
be a radionuclide. In another embodiment, the methods for determining the
presence or absence of a microorganism or cell, or disease or disorder,
involve monitoring a subject to whom a virus has been administered for
detection of one or more molecules produced upon expression of one or
more peptides or proteins encoded by heterologous nucleic acid of the
virus. In a particular embodiment, the peptide is contained with in a
fusion protein of a bacterial outer membrane protein, such as OmpA or
OmpC, and the peptide within an extracellular domain of the outer
membrane protein. In a further particular embodiment of such methods, the
molecule(s) produced upon expression of the peptide(s) or protein(s)
encoded by the nucleic acid of the virus is one or more of an iron
storage, metabolism, binding or transport molecule.
[0223]Also provided herein are methods of treating diseases and disorders
and compositions for use in such methods. Such diseases and disorders
include, for example, proliferative conditions, neoplastic diseases,
tumors, tumor tissue, cancer, metastasis, inflammation, wounds and
infections. Combinations and kits that include such compositions and that
can be used in the treatment methods are further provided. The methods
include administering a microorganism or cell to a subject or patient
having, at risk of having or suspected of having a disease or disorder,
such as a proliferative condition, neoplastic disease, tumor, tumor
tissue, cancer, metastasis, inflammation, wounds or infection. In one
embodiment of the methods for treating a disease or disorder, the
microorganism or cell contains nucleic acid that encodes or provides for
the production of a therapeutic composition. In another embodiment, the
method includes administration of a microorganism or cell and
administration of a metal-binding or metal-chelating molecule or of a
metal that is or is complexed with a therapeutic composition. Examples of
therapeutic compositions that can be used in such methods include, but
are not limited to, compositions that are deleterious to a tumor or
cancer cell, antiproliferative agents, anti-inflammatory compositions,
antibiotics and compositions that promote wound healing. In another
embodiment, the treatment method includes administration of a
microorganism or cell that heterologously overproduces one or more of an
iron storage, metabolism, binding or transport molecule. In a further
embodiment, a microorganism or cell is and a metal-binding or -chelating
molecule are administered to the subject together or separately as a
combination therapy for treatment of a disease, disorder or condition as
described herein.
[0224]Microorganisms and cells, as well as compositions, combinations and
kits that include the microorganisms or cells, are also provided herein
and can be used in the methods provided herein. In particular
embodiments, the microorganisms or cells tend to accumulate in a certain
area or areas of a subject to whom the microorganisms or cells are
administered. Microorganisms and cells used in the methods of detecting
and/or treating a site of proliferation of a proliferative condition
(e.g., a tumor, tumor tissue, cancer, metastasis, neoplasm, neoplastic
disease, site of inflammation, wound, wound tissue and infection) are
capable of selectively accumulating in such sites or in immunoprivileged
sites relative to other locations in a subject. Accumulation is selective
in that the microorganisms and cells tend to accumulate at such sites to
at least an equal and typically detectably greater extent than they
accumulate at other locations in a subject. The degree of selective
accumulation can be demonstrated in a number ways describe herein such
as, for example, by evaluating and comparing the extent of accumulation
of the microorganisms or cells in different locations in a subject after
systemic, e.g., intravenous, administration of the microorganism or cells
to a subject having a site of proliferation or proliferative condition as
described herein. Accordingly, detection of the microorganisms or cells
provides for detection and evaluation of such sites. Furthermore, because
such microorganisms and cells selectively accumulate at such sites, they
can be used to specifically deliver substances and compositions to the
sites, including therapeutic substances and compositions for use in
treating diseases, disorders and conditions associated with proliferation
sites and conditions, including, for example, tumors, cancers, neoplasms,
neoplastic diseases, inflammation, wounds and other diseases, conditions
and disorders as described herein. Also provided are embodiments of the
treatment methods in which the microorganisms and cells themselves
provide a therapeutic benefit in the treatment of diseases, disorders
and/or conditions without providing for delivery of a separate
therapeutic substance or composition.
[0225]A factor in the selective accumulation of the microorganisms and
cells may be that they tend to be cleared from most of the body of the
subject to whom they are administered by the activity of the subject's
immune system, indicative of recognition of the microorganisms and cells
by the subject's immune system. However, in the environment of a
proliferative site or condition (including, for example, a tumor, tumor
tissue, cancer, metastasis, neoplasm, neoplastic disease, site of
inflammation, wound, wound tissue and infection) the microorganisms and
cells can nevertheless survive, replicate, proliferate and accumulate.
Accordingly, for enhanced accumulation, the microorganisms and cells in
particular embodiments are replication competent. The selective
accumulation of such microorganisms and cells is thus not attributable to
a targeting moiety, such as a heterologous protein that binds to a
molecule that is fairly unique to the targeted site in the subject that
has been incorporated into the microorganism or cell to direct it to a
particular site. Rather, in this case the selective accumulation can be
viewed as a result of the conditions of the environment at the site of
proliferation or of a proliferative condition. In some embodiments,
however, the selective accumulation of the microorganism at a target site
can be enhanced through the incorporation of a targeting moiety into the
microorganism or cell.
[0226]In methods provided herein for detecting the location of a
microorganism or cell that has been administered to a subject, the degree
of selective accumulation capable by the microorganism or cell is not a
consideration. In such methods, the microorganism's or cell's location(s)
and distribution in the subject is what is determined, not necessarily
the site of a proliferative condition or disease or disorder. Thus, in
such methods, any of the detectable microorganisms or cells provided
herein can be used.
[0227]Microorganisms and cells provided herein include microorganisms and
cells that are readily detectable within a cell, tissue or subject and/or
that coexist in a commensal or mutualistic relationship with a subject
such as, for example, an animal, including human and non-human animals.
In particular embodiments, the microorganism is a bacterium, fungus or
virus. Readily detectable microorganisms and cells provided and/or used
herein include microorganisms and cells that possess features that
facilitate specific detection, or have been modified to facilitate
specific detection, in a subject. For example, microorganisms and cells,
and in particular, bacteria, that contain at least two, three, four, five
or six or more iron acquisition systems are provided that are well suited
for detection using methods and techniques based on detection of metals
(including but not limited to iron) that can be accumulated by such
microorganisms and cells. The microorganism or cell can be one that
naturally possesses the iron acquisition systems or can be one that has
been modified, such as through introduction of heterologous nucleic acids
and recombinant expression, to contain more and/or different iron
acquisition systems than it naturally possesses. In another example,
microorganisms and cells that heterologously overproduce one or more of
an iron acquisition, storage, metabolism, binding or transport molecule
are provided. Because of the iron-accumulating capacity of such
microorganisms and cells, they are also useful in methods of treating
diseases and disorders provided herein. For example, administration of
such microorganisms and cells to a subject or patient having a disease,
disorder or condition, such as a proliferative condition as described
herein, provides for specific binding and accumulation of metals, which
can have therapeutic effects, or be complexed to a therapeutic
composition, in a site or sites that are associated with the disease or
disorder in a subject. In a particular example, the diseases, disorder or
condition is a proliferative condition, neoplastic disease, tumor, tumor
tissue, cancer, metastasis, inflammation, wound or infection. In methods
of treating a tumor, tumor tissue, cancer, metastasis, such
microorganisms and cells reduce the amount of iron available to tumor and
cancer cells, thereby having a deleterious effect on the tumor cells and
their growth and growth of tumors. In other embodiments, microorganisms
and cells are provided that have been modified to facilitate specific
detection in a subject through incorporation of a detectable marker that
is or specifically complexes with a readily detectable moiety. In a
particular embodiment, the readily detectable microorganism is a
bacterium containing nucleic acid encoding a heterologous fusion protein
that is expressed on the surface of the bacterium. In another embodiment,
the microorganism is a virus containing nucleic acid encoding a
heterologous fusion protein that is expressed on the surface of cells and
tissues in which the virus specifically accumulates, such as, for
example, tumors, tumor tissues, a metastasis, inflamed tissues, wounds or
wounded tissues, or sites of infection. The fusion protein in a
particular embodiment is a fusion of a bacterial outer membrane protein
and a peptide contained within an extracellular domain of the outer
membrane protein. The peptide thus expressed on the surface of the
microorganism, cells or tissues provides a site for labeling with a
detectable moiety that specifically interacts with the peptide to
facilitate detection of the microorganisms, cells or tissues. The peptide
expressed on the surface of target cells and tissues also provides a site
at which a therapeutic composition or substance can be specifically
delivered in methods of treating diseases, disorders and conditions
provided herein.
[0228]Particular microorganisms that can be used in the methods provided
herein include, for example, mutual, commensal and/or probiotic strains
of Escherichia coli, Bacteroides, Eubacterium, Streptococcus,
Actinomyces, Veillonella, Nesseria, Prevotella, Campylobacter,
Fusobacterium, Eikenella, Porphyromonas and Priopionibacteria. E. coli
strain Nissle 1917 and vaccinia virus, e.g., a Lister strain of vaccinia
virus such as LIVP, and derivatives thereof, are also particular
microorganisms provided herein and that can be used in methods described
herein. Particular bacteria for use in the methods include Escherichia
coli, such as, for example, E. coli strains of the O6 serotype and E.
coli strain Nissle 1917 and derivatives thereof, such as, for example,
Nissle strains that either do not produce lipopolysaccharide (LPS), or
that produce LPS that lacks the myristic acid moiety of lipid A, strains
that lack one or more cryptic plasmids, such as pMut1 and/or pMut2, and
strains in which the consensus nucleotide sequence for the Fur
protein-binding region of the promoter of one or more genes that is
negatively regulated by iron is inactivated.
[0229]The microorganisms, cells and compositions can be used in the
preparation of a composition for detection, diagnosis or treatment of a
disease or disorder, including, for example, proliferative conditions,
neoplastic diseases, tumors, tumor tissue, cancer, metastasis,
inflammation, wounds and infections. Such uses of the microorganisms,
cells and compositions, which contain an amount effective for detection,
diagnosis or treatment, are provided herein.
[0230]Compositions provided herein can also be used in methods of
enriching microbial (such as, for example, bacterial) populations. Such
enrichment methods include selecting for a recombinant feature, such as,
for example, a metabolic feature, a marker, such as antibiotic
resistance, a cell surface molecule that can be used as a ligand, or an
intracellular protein that can be used as a ligand, using techniques
known in the art and described below.
C. MICROORGANISMS AND CELLS SELECTED OR DESIGNED FOR A ENHANCED CAPACITY
TO BIND, TRANSPORT, METABOLIZE, STORE AND/OR ACCUMULATE A METAL
[0231]Microorganism and cells provided herein and/or for use in the
methods of detection and/or treatment provided herein are selected or
designed to optimize and enhance detectability or therapeutic effect in a
subject and/or to reduce toxicity or adverse effects on a subject that
may result upon administration to a subject.
[0232]In a particular embodiment in which a microorganisms or cell for use
in the methods provided herein is selected or designed to optimize and
enhance detectability and/or therapeutic effect, the microorganism or
cell is selected or designed for a substantial or enhanced capacity to
bind, transport, metabolize, store and/or accumulate a metal, including,
for example, iron. In another embodiment, the microorganism or cell is
selected or designed for enhancing the capacity of a target cell or
tissue to bind, transport, metabolize, store and/or accumulate a metal,
including, for example, iron. Particular microorganisms or cells that can
be used in such embodiments include, for example, a virus or
intracellular bacterium containing nucleic acid that encodes one or more
products involved in production of a metal (e.g., iron) storage,
metabolism, binding or transport molecule. In yet another embodiment, the
microorganism or cell is designed such that it expresses a heterologous
surface peptide or protein that provides a site for specific interaction
with an administered molecule, substance or composition that is directly
or indirectly detectable and/or is therapeutic in the treatment of a
proliferative site or condition or a disease, disorder or condition as
described herein. Other examples are provided throughout the
specification, and the compositions and methods can be combined to
optimize detection and/or therapy of proliferative sites and conditions,
and diseases, disorders and conditions as described herein.
Administration of microorganisms or cells as provided herein can result
in increased detectability or imaging capacity, the ability to detect or
image target sites using a lower concentration of microorganisms or
cells, increased therapeutic effect at sites of proliferation, increased
killing of tumor cells, delays in the progression of a disease, disorder
or condition and/or prolonging of survival of a subject afflicted with a
disease, disorder or condition as described herein.
[0233]A microorganism or cell selected or designed for a substantial or
enhanced capacity to bind, transport, metabolize, store and/or accumulate
a metal can naturally exhibit such properties or can be engineered to
have such attributes.
[0234]Microorganisms and cells can be recombinantly engineered to express
or over-express one or more endogenous gene(s) to express proteins or
molecules (e.g., those that (1) bind iron, (2) transport iron, (3) store
iron, or a combination thereof), that increase the capacity of imaging a
tumor or tissue in which the microorganisms or cells accumulate, or that
depletes iron from the environment, thereby starving a tumor of a
nutrient. In another example, nanoparticles or siderophores conjugated to
a detectable moiety, a therapeutic agent or a combination thereof can be
administered concurrent with, or subsequent to, the recombinantly
engineered microorganism or cell, where the nanoparticles or siderophores
then localize to the microorganism or cell. In yet another example, the
microorganism or cells provided herein can be recombinantly engineered to
over-express an exogenous recombinant gene, such as, for example, ompA
carrying binding peptide(s) in permissible sites, via which ligands will
bind and accumulate a diagnostic agent or a therapeutic agent, thereby
imaging the tumor or tissue or cause an inhibition/killing of the tissues
or cells in which the microorganism or cell accumulates.
[0235]1. Metal Binding, Acquisition, Transport, Metabolism, Storage and
Regulation
[0236]Iron is important for life processes of all eukaryotes and most
prokaryotes. In nature, iron exists as Fe.sup.+2 (ferrous) or Fe.sup.+3
(ferric) states. Iron, as the ferrous or ferric ion, is essential for the
life processes of all eukaryotes and most prokaryotes; however, the
element is toxic when in excess of that needed for cellular homeostasis.
Although widely distributed, there is little free iron in vivo (10.sup.-9
to 10.sup.-18 M). Highly efficient iron acquisition systems are used to
scavenge iron from the environment under iron-restricted conditions.
[0237]In the mammalian body, iron is chelated to proteins or other
molecules to maintain solubility, limit oxygen redox chemistry and limit
availability to microbes. Chelates include transferrin (in serum and
mucosa), lactoferrin (mucosa, milk) and heme containing proteins (e.g.,
hemoglobin), intracellularly stored in ferritin and ferritin-like
molecules. Iron is stored in the ferritin and ferritin-like molecules
until needed for cellular processes.
[0238]Bacteria need iron for growth, and successful bacterial pathogens
have evolved to compete successfully for iron in the highly iron-stressed
environment of the host's tissues and body fluids. Bacteria employ a
variety of mechanisms to obtain iron for survival. Such mechanisms
include scavenging iron from host carriers/sources, such as heme,
hemoglobin, hemopexin and iron bound to transferring and lactoferrin, in
addition to synthesis of iron-binding proteins such as siderophores,
bacterial ferritin, bacterioferritin and dodecameric ferritin. In
response to conditions of low iron, bacteria that do not produce
siderophores have developed capabilities for scavenging iron from host
carriers/sources (Wooldridge and Williams (1993) FEMS Microbiol. Rev.
12(4):325-348).
[0239]a. Iron Storage
[0240]Mechanisms have evolved in living systems for iron detoxification
and for the removal of excess ferrous ions from the cytosol. These
detoxification mechanisms involve the oxidation of excess ferrous ions to
the ferric state and storage of the ferric ions in ferritin-like proteins
(Smith J L (2004) Crit. Rev. Microbiol. 30(3):173-185). Organisms have
evolved for existence in different environments and can possess
ferritin-like compounds with different properties, such as higher
affinity for iron or other metals. Metals other than iron, such as
Gallium-67 (Ga.sup.+3), have been shown to be able to be bind and be
incorporated into ferritins. Ga.sup.+3 is virtually irreducible under
physiological conditions, which prevents it from entering heme, unlike
Fe.sup.+2 (Bernstein (1998) Pharmacol. Rev. 50(4):665-682; Chiancone et
al. (2004) Biometals 17(3):197-202, Pulliainen et al. (2005) Mol.
Microbiol. 57(4):1086-1100; Reindel et al. (2005) Biometals.
18(4):387-397; Grove and Wilkinson. (2005) J. Mol. Biol. 347(3):495-508).
[0241]Highly efficient iron acquisition systems are used to scavenge iron
from the environment under iron-restricted conditions. Bacterial iron
storage proteins provide intracellular iron reserves for use when
external supplies are restricted. The expression of the iron homeostatic
machinery is subject to iron-dependent global control ensuring that iron
acquisition, storage and consumption are geared to iron availability and
that intracellular levels of free iron do not reach toxic levels (Andrews
et al. (2003) FEMS Microbiol. Rev. 27(2-3):215-237). Ferritin-like
compounds not only protect bacterial cells from iron overload, but they
also serve as an iron source when iron is limited, protect the bacterial
cells against oxidative stress and/or protect DNA against enzymatic or
oxidative attack (Smith J L. (2004) Crit. Rev. Microbiol. 30(3):
173-185).
[0242]Ferritins are a class of iron storage and mineralization proteins
found throughout the animal, plant and microbial kingdoms. Iron is stored
within the protein shell of ferritin as a hydrous ferric oxide
nanoparticle with a structure similar to that of the mineral
"ferrihydrite."
[0243]i. Prokaryotic Ferritins
[0244]Ferritins control the reversible transition between hydrated
Fe.sup.+2 in solution and the solid Fe.sup.+3 mineral core inside its
cavity and stores the resulting ferric ions in a non-reactive state,
thereby protecting bacteria (prokaryotic and eukaryotic) from
iron-induced oxidative damage. Ferritins differ with respect to their
iron binding capacity and basic structure (J L Smith. (2004) Crit. Rev.
in Microbiol. 30:173-185).
[0245]Ferritin-like proteins are widespread in bacteria, with at least 39
examples known. Some bacteria contain two bacterioferritin subunits, or
two ferritin subunits, that in most cases co-assemble. Others possess
both a bacterioferritin and a ferritin, while some appear to lack any
type of iron-storage protein (Andrews S C. (1998) Adv. Microb. Physiol.
40:281-351).
[0246]There are at least four types of ferritin-like proteins in bacteria:
bacterial ferritin, bacterioferritin, dodecameric ferritin and
rubrerythrins. These bacterial proteins are related to the ferritins
found in eukaryotes. The importance of iron to bacteria can be
illustrated in the diversity in number and types of these ferritin-like
proteins in various bacteria (S C Andrews (1998) Advances in Microbial
Physiology 40:281-351). Table 1 lists a representative sampling of
ferritin-like proteins in a variety of bacterial species.
TABLE-US-00001
TABLE 1
Diversity of ferritins, bacterioferritins and rubrerythrins
Bacterio- Dps
Species Ferritins ferritins Rubrerythrins ferritins
A. eutrophus 1
A. fulgidus 1 4
A. chroococcum 1
A. tumefaciens 1
A. vinelandii 1
B. anthracis 1
B. fragilis 1
B. melitensis 1
C. jejuni 1 1
C. acetobutylicum 1 1 1
C. perfringens 1
D. vulgaris 2
E. coli 2 1 1
H. pylori 1 1
H. influenzae 2
M. magnetotacticum 2
M. thermoautotrophicum 1 2
M. smegmatis 1
M. jannaschii 1
M. avium 1
M. leprae 1
M. paratuberculosis 1
M. tuberculosis 1 1
N. gonorrhoeae 2
N. meningitides 2
N. winogradskii 1
P. aeruginosa 2
P. gingivalis 1 1
P. putida 1
R. capsulatus 1
R. sphaeroides 1
R. rubrum 1
S. mutans 1
S. suis 1
S. PCC6803 2
T. maritime 1 1
V. cholerae 1 1
Data from (1) SC Andrews (1998) Advances in Microbial Physiology 40:
281-351 and JL Smith (2004) Crit. Rev. Microbiol. 30: 173-185.
[0247]In addition to the diversity of numbers and types of ferritin-like
proteins, the proteins vary with respect to function depending upon the
bacteria in which they are found. A representative sampling of
ferritin-like proteins and associated functions is presented Table 2.
TABLE-US-00002
TABLE 2
Function of prokaryotic ferritin-like proteins
Bacterial Ferritin-like
Species Compound(s) Function(s)
A. tumifaciens Dodecameric ferritin Binds iron
Protects against H.sub.2O.sub.2
B. anthracis Dodecameric ferritin Binds iron
Protects against iron over-load
B. melitensis Bacterioferritin Binds iron
Induces a Th1 response
C. jejuni Bacterial ferritin Binds iron
Serves as an iron source
Protects against H.sub.2O.sub.2
Dodecameric ferritin Binds iron
Protects against H.sub.2O.sub.2
E. coli Bacterioferritin Binds iron
Bacterial ferritin Binds iron
Serves as an iron source
Dodecameric ferritin Binds iron
Binds DNA
Serves as an iron source
Protects DNA against cleavage
by H.sub.2O.sub.2:Fe
H. pylori Bacterial ferritin Binds iron
Protects against Fe+2, Cu+2 and
Mn+2 overload
Necessary for colonization of
gastric mucosa
Dodecameric ferritin Binds iron
Binds DNA
Activates neutrophils and
monocytes
Protects against oxygen toxicity
M. smegmatis Dodecameric ferritin Binds iron
Binds DNA
Protects DNA against cleavage
by H.sub.2O.sub.2:Fe
and DNaseI cleavage
N. gonorrhoeae Bacterioferritin Binds iron
Serves as an iron source
Protects DNA against cleavage
by H.sub.2O.sub.2 and paraquat
P. gingivalis Bacterial ferritin Binds iron
Serves as an iron source
Dodecameric ferritin Binds iron
Binds DNA
Protects against H.sub.2O.sub.2
P. aeruginosa Bacterioferritin Binds iron
Protects against H.sub.2O.sub.2
P. putida Bacterioferritin Binds iron
S. mutans Dodecameric ferritin Binds iron
Protects against O.sub.2 and H.sub.2O.sub.2
S. suis Dodecameric ferritin Binds iron
Protects against H.sub.2O.sub.2
Information from JL Smith. (2004) Crit. Rev. Microbiol. 30: 173-185.
Note:
The content of this table is not meant to be exhaustive. Any other similar
ferritin-like compounds from other bacterial strains, which are not
listed in this table, are also considered to be included.
[0248]Bacteria can be recombinantly engineered to express genes encoding
prokaryotic ferritins and/or ferritin-like molecules (e.g., Bacterial
ferritin, Bacterioferritin, Dodecameric ferritin, and Rubrerythrins),
including but not limited to examples of prokaryotic ferritins and/or
ferritin-like molecules listed herein. The prokaryotic ferritins and/or
ferritin-like molecules can be endogenous to the bacteria, or can be
exogenous (e.g., from another bacteria), or a combination thereof. The
bacteria can be an extracellular bacteria or an intracellular bacteria.
In one example, bacteria, such as E. coli Nissle 1917, can be
recombinantly engineered to express genes encoding prokaryotic ferritins
and/or ferritin-like molecules. The prokaryotic ferritins and/or
ferritin-like molecules can be endogenous to E. coli Nissle 1917, or can
be exogenous (e.g., from another bacteria), or a combination thereof.
[0249]Optionally, bacteria can be recombinantly engineered to over-express
ferritin-like compounds and/or remove transcriptional iron-repression
systems in addition to expression of iron acquisition systems. In a
further embodiment, the bacteria can be recombinantly engineered to
express or over-express one or more siderophores (endogenous or
exogenous), one or more outer membrane proteins or transport proteins, or
a combination thereof as described elsewhere in this application to
increase iron acquisition, transport and storage. These methods can be
combined with any of the other methods provided herein.
[0250]Bacteria (e.g., E. coli Nissle 1917) recombinantly engineered as
described herein can be administered for accumulation in tumors and other
hyperproliferative tissue, such as caused by inflammation, wounds, and
infections. Increased iron uptake and/or storage can result in increased
contrast for visualization and detection. Administration of labeled
metals can also be used to increase contrast for any of the imaging
methods described herein. Additionally, labeled methods can also be used
for therapeutic purposes, such as, for example, radiolabeled iron, to
specifically target a tumor.
[0251]Tumor tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously injected
bacteria (e.g., E. coli Nissle 1917) recombinantly engineered as
described herein. Increased iron uptake and/or storage can result in, not
only, increased contrast for visualization and detection, but also iron
depletion from the tumor environment. Iron depletion from the tumor
environment removes a vital nutrient from the tumors, thereby
dis-regulating iron hemostasis in tumor cells and delaying tumor
progression and/or killing the tumor.
[0252]Additionally, iron, or other labeled metals, can be administered to
a tumor-bearing subject, either alone, or in a conjugated form. An iron
conjugate can include, for example, iron conjugated to an imaging moiety
or a therapeutic agent. In some cases, the imaging moiety and therapeutic
agent are the same, e.g., a radionuclide. Bacterial cell internalization
of iron in the tumor, wound, area of inflammation or infection allows the
internalization of iron alone, a supplemental imaging moiety, or a
therapeutic agent (which can deliver cytotoxicity specifically to tumor
cells or deliver the therapeutic agent for treatment of the wound, area
of inflammation or infection). These methods can be combined with any of
the other methods provided herein.
[0253](a) Bacterial Ferritin
[0254]Bacterial ferritin has a tetracosameric structure, and each subunit
is approximately 19.5 kDa for an overall approximate molecular weight of
465 kDa. The cavity of bacterial ferritin can hold approximately 2500
iron atoms.
[0255]Iron enters ferritin as Fe.sup.+2 and is oxidized to insoluble
Fe.sup.+3. For example, ferritins bind soluble Fe.sup.+2 use oxygen as
the electron acceptor and catalyze its oxidation to di-ferric compounds.
The insoluble ferric ions are deposited in the central cavity, forming a
ferrihydrite core (Wandersman and Delepelaire (2004) Ann. Rev. Microbiol.
58:611-647). Release of iron from ferritin occurs through reduction and
exit through a channel in the molecule.
[0256]Bacterial ferritin can be found in bacterial species including, but
not limited to, C. jejuni, E. coli, H. pylori and P. gingivalis. The
ferritin protein, Pfr, of H. pylori has been shown to be homologous to
eukaryotic and prokaryotic ferritins (Choe et al. (2001) Helicobacter
6(1):55-59). The function of the non-heme ferritin of E. coli (EcFtnA) is
similar to recombinant human H chain ferritin (HuHF), in that it oxidizes
Fe.sup.+2 at a dinuclear ferroxidase center situated at a central
position within each subunit. Iron is more evenly distributed between
molecules in the bacterial ferritins than the mammalian ferritins, which
can account for its greater accessibility (Bauminger et al. (1999)
Biochemistry 38(24):7791-7802).
[0257]Bacteria can be recombinantly engineered to express genes encoding
one or more bacterial ferritins. In one example, bacteria, such as E.
coli Nissle 1917, can be recombinantly engineered to express genes
encoding a bacterial ferritin. In a further embodiment, bacteria can be
transformed with multiple plasmids having genes encoding one or more
ferritin-like molecules that are endogenous and/or exogenous to the
bacteria. For example, bacteria, such as E. coli Nissle 1917, can be
recombinantly engineered to express or over-express genes encoding
bacterioferritin, dodecameric ferritin, rubrerythrin and/or high copy
plasmids having genes encoding the eukaryotic H chain, L chain or H and L
chains. In a further embodiment, bacteria, such as E. coli Nissle 1917,
can be recombinantly engineered to express or over-express one or more
siderophores (endogenous or exogenous), no siderophores, one or more
outer membrane proteins, transport proteins or a combination thereof as
described elsewhere to increase iron acquisition and transport of iron.
These methods can be combined with any of the other methods provided
herein.
[0258](b) Bacterioferritin
[0259]Bacterioferritin (Bfr) has a tetracosameric structure, the cavity of
which can hold approximately 1800 iron atoms. Bacterioferritin differs
from bacterial ferritin and mammalian ferritin in that it contains heme
located between each two subunits with a methionine from each subunit
serving as the heme ligand Thus, each bacterioferritin molecule binds 12
hemes. Bacterioferritins bind soluble Fe.sup.+2, use peroxide as the
electron acceptor and catalyze its oxidation to di-ferric compounds. The
insoluble ferric ions are deposited in the central cavity, forming a
ferrihydrite core (Wandersman and Delepelaire (2004) Ann. Rev. Microbiol.
58:611-647). Many bfr genes are associated with a bfd gene that encodes
the Bfr-associated ferroxidin (Bfd), which plays a role in intracellular
reduction of ferrichrome (Andrews et al. (2003) FEMS Microbiol. Rev.
27:215-237).
[0260]Bacterioferritin can be found in bacteria including, but not limited
to, Brucella melitensis, E. coli, Neisseria gonorrhoeae, Magnetospirillum
magnetotactum, Treponema pallidum, Azobacter vinelandii, Pseudomonas
aeruginosa and Pseudomonas putida. The size of the subunits and 24mers
varies slightly from species to species as described in Table 3.
TABLE-US-00003
TABLE 3
Characteristics of bacterioferritins
Size (kDa) Hemes/ Fe atoms/ Fe:Phosphate Subunits
Species Subunit 24-mer holomer holomer (mole:mole) (no. types)
E. coli 18.5 452 12 ~980 2.2:1 1
P. aeruginosa 18 and 18.5 430 3-9 700-800 1.7:1 2
A. vinelandii 18 443 12 600-2400 1.4:1 Likely 1
N. winogradski 19.5 260 12 ~100 1
R. spaeroides 16 >100 10 1
R. rubrum 23 450 Yes 1
A. chroococcum 17 ~410 Yes 1
Synechocystis 19 400 6 2300 1.5:1 1 (or 2)
A. spinosa 20 and 20 ~480 Yes 750 2
R. capsulatus 18.2 437 6 600-950 1.6-1.9:1 1
Data from SC Andrews (1998) Advances in Microbial Physiology 40: 281-351).
[0261]Organisms have evolved for existence in different environments and
can possess ferritin-like compounds with different properties. For
example, bacterioferritin of Magnetospirillum magnetotactum is a
heterodimer compared to homodimeric bacterioferritin of E. coli (Bertani
et al. (2001) Gene 264:257-263).
[0262]Bacterioferritin from E. coli is able to accumulate large quantities
of iron in the form of an inorganic Fe.sup.+3 mineral core. Iron uptake
and storage by E. coli bacterioferritin involves both the core surface
and the ferroxidase center. Core formation rates are pH- and
Fe.sup.+2-dependent and depend on the amount of iron already present in
the core. Even at optimal pH (i.e., pH 6.5), the effective iron capacity
is approximately 2700 per holomer, i.e., almost half of the theoretical
limit of approximately 4500. Therefore, competing oxidation/precipitation
processes have a major influence on the amount of iron accumulated
(Baaghil et al. (2003) Biochemistry 42(47):14047-14056).
[0263]Bacterioferritin of E. coli is an iron-mineralizing heme-containing
complex composed of 24 identical bacterioferritin proteins, each
containing a di-nuclear metal-binding site known as the ferroxidase
center. Oxidation of two Fe.sup.+2 per H.sub.2O.sub.2 occurs at the
ferroxidase center, thereby avoiding hydroxyl radical production and most
of the H.sub.2O.sub.2 produced from O.sub.2 is rapidly consumed in a
subsequent ferroxidase reaction with Fe.sup.+2 to produce H.sub.2O.
Bacterioferritins facilitate the pair-wise oxidation of Fe.sup.+2 by
H.sub.2O.sub.2, thereby avoiding odd electron reduction products of
oxygen and oxidative damage to the protein and cellular components
(Bou-Abdallah et al. (2002) J. Biol. Chem. 277(40):37064-37069).
[0264]The nucleotide sequence of the Rhodobacter capsulatus
bacterioferritin gene (bfr) was determined and found to encode a protein
of 161 amino acids with a predicted molecular mass of 18,174 Da. Amino
acids that are involved in heme ligation, and those that provide ligands
in the binuclear metal centre in bacterioferritin from E. coli are
conserved in the R. capsulatus protein (Penfold et al. (1996) FEMS
Microbiol Lett. 139(2-3):143-148).
[0265]Bacterioferritin (Bfr) from Neisseria gonorrhoeae strain F62 has
been identified in cell-free extracts. Gonococcal Bfr has an estimated
molecular mass of 400 kDa and is composed of 18 kDa (BfrA) and 22 kDa
(BfrB) subunits. The two gonococcal bfr genes are located in tandem with
an intervening gap of 27 bp. A potential Fur-binding sequence (12 of 19
bp identical to the consensus neisserial fur sequence) was identified
within the 5' flanking region of bfrA in front of a putative -35 hexamer
(Chen and Morse (1999) Microbiology. 145(Pt 10):2967-2975). The bfr gene
has been introduced into an expression vector and produced to a high
level in E. coli (Penfold et al. (1996) FEMS Microbiol. Lett.
139(2-3):143-148).
[0266]Bacteria can be recombinantly engineered to express genes encoding
one or more bacterioferritins. In one example, bacteria, such as E. coli
Nissle 1917, can be recombinantly engineered to express genes encoding a
bacterioferritin. In a further embodiment, bacteria can be transformed
with multiple plasmids having genes encoding one or more ferritin-like
molecules that are endogenous and/or exogenous to the bacteria. For
example, bacteria, such as E. coli Nissle 1917, can be recombinantly
engineered to express or over-express genes encoding bacterial ferritin,
dodecameric ferritin, rubrerythrin and/or high copy plasmids having genes
encoding the eukaryotic H chain, L chain or H and L chains. In a further
embodiment, bacteria, such as E. coli Nissle 1917, can be recombinantly
engineered to express or over-express one or more siderophores
(endogenous or exogenous), no siderophores, one or more outer membrane
proteins, transport proteins or a combination thereof as described
elsewhere to increase iron acquisition and transport of iron. These
methods can be combined with any of the other methods provided herein.
[0267](c) Dodecameric Ferritin
[0268]The dodecameric ferritin, Dps (DNA-binding proteins during
stationary phase), of E. coli belong structurally to the ferritin
super-family but differ from ferritins in their function and regulation.
The Dps family members constitute a distinct group of multimeric and
ferritin-like iron binding proteins (up to 500 iron atoms/12-mer) that
have a role in regulating in oxidative stress resistance and virulence.
[0269]Iron ions in Dps molecules are oriented with tetrahedral symmetry
where the tetrahedron center is occupied by iron ions and the vertices by
oxygen. Similar to mammalian ferritins, iron in Dps molecules does not
remain bound to the site after oxidation has taken place (Ilari et al.
(2002) J. Biol. Chem. 277(40):37619-37623).
[0270]Dps is shown to be a Fe-binding and storage protein where Fe.sup.+2
oxidation is most effectively accomplished by H.sub.2O.sub.2 rather than
by O.sub.2 (as is observed in ferritins). Two Fe.sup.+2 ions bind at each
of the 12 putative dinuclear ferroxidase sites in the protein. The
ferroxidase site-bound iron is then oxidized, where two Fe.sup.+2 are
oxidized per H.sub.2O.sub.2 reduced, thus avoiding hydroxyl radical
production.
[0271]Dps acquires a ferric core of approximately 500 Fe.sup.+3 with a 2
Fe.sup.+2/H.sub.2O.sub.2 stoichiometry. The protein forms a similar
ferric core with O.sub.2 as the oxidant, albeit at a slower rate. Dps
attenuates hydroxyl radical production during Fe.sup.+2 oxidation by
H.sub.2O.sub.2 and the protective effect of Dps on DNA most likely is
exerted through a dual action: the physical association with DNA and the
ability to nullify the toxic combination of Fe.sup.+2 and H.sub.2O.sub.2
(Wandersman and Delepelaire (2004) Ann. Rev. Microbiol. 58:611-647; Zhao
et al. (2002) J. Biol. Chem. 277(31):27689-27696).
[0272]Dodecameric ferritin can be found in bacterial species such as, for
example, Agrobacterium tumifaciens, Bacillus anthracis, Campylobacter
jejuni, E. coli, Helicobacter pylori, Mycobacterium smegmatis,
Porphyromonas gingivalis, Listeria monocytogenes, Streptococcus mutans
and Streptococcus suis.
[0273]E. coli Dps is a 205 kDa Dodecameric sphere and can hold
approximately 500 ferric ions in the central cavity. Ferritin-like
compounds such as Dps proteins have been shown to (1) store iron, thereby
protecting bacterial cells from iron overload, (2) serve as an iron
source when iron is limited and/or (3) protect bacterial cells against
oxidative attack. Two Dps present in the B. anthracis genome are
homologous to E. coli Dps. The two proteins (Dlp-1 and Dlp-2) are
sphere-like proteins with an internal cavity that act as ferritins and
are thus involved in iron uptake and regulation (Wandersman and
Delepelaire (2004) Ann. Rev. Microbiol. 58:611-647; Papinutto et al.
(2002) J. Biol. Chem. 277(17):15093-15098).
[0274]Bacteria can recombinantly engineered to express genes encoding one
or more dodecameric ferritins. In one example, a bacteria, such as E.
coli Nissle 1917, can be recombinantly engineered to express genes
encoding a dodecameric ferritin. In a further embodiment, bacteria can be
transformed with multiple plasmids having genes encoding one or more
ferritin-like molecules that are endogenous and/or exogenous to the
bacteria. For example, bacteria, such as E. coli Nissle 1917, can be
recombinantly engineered to express or over-express genes encoding a
bacterioferritin, bacterial ferritin, rubrerythrin and/or high copy
plasmids having genes encoding the eukaryotic H chain, L chain or H and L
chains. In a further embodiment, bacteria, such as E. coli Nissle 1917,
can be recombinantly engineered to express or over-express one or more
siderophores (endogenous or exogenous), no siderophores, one or more
outer membrane proteins, transport proteins or a combination thereof as
described elsewhere to increase iron acquisition and transport of iron.
These methods can be combined with any of the other methods provided
herein.
[0275](d) Rubrerythrins
[0276]Rubrerythrins are produced by anaerobic bacteria, are
structurally-related to ferritins and exhibit ferroxidase activity
similar to ferritins. Rubrerythrins are homodimeric, with each subunit
being 22 kDa, and are found in anaerobic bacteria. Anaerobic bacteria
used in the methods provided herein are those bacteria that do not
require oxygen to survive and grow. In some embodiments, the bacteria
must be in an oxygen-limiting (e.g., intratumor) or oxygen-free
environment in order to survive and grow. Exemplary anaerobic bacteria
provided herein include, but are not limited to, A. fulgidus, C.
acetobutylicum, C. perfringens, D. vulgaris, M. jannaschii, M
thermo-autotrophicum and T. maritime.
[0277]In addition to rubrerythrins, some anaerobic bacteria have genes
that encode other ferritin-like molecules. For example, A.
actinomycetemcomitans has two genes, afnA and afnB that encode proteins
that are similar to ferritin-like proteins of bacteria such as E. coli.
The proteins encoded by afnA and afnB play a role in helping anaerobic
bacteria adapt to oxidative environmental changes (Hirosue et al. (2001)
Microbiol. Immunol. 45(10):721-727).
[0278]Bacteria can be recombinantly engineered to express genes encoding
one or more rubrerythrins. In one example, bacteria, such as C.
perfringens, can be recombinantly engineered to express afnA and afnB
genes, the gene(s) encoding the one or more rubrerythrin(s), or a
combination thereof. In a further embodiment, C. perfringens can
recombinantly engineered to express genes encoding one or more
ferritin-like molecules that are endogenous and/or exogenous to the
bacteria. For example, C. perfringens can be recombinantly engineered to
express genes encoding a bacterioferritin, a bacterial ferritin, a
dodecameric ferritin and/or high copy plasmids having genes encoding the
eukaryotic H chain, L chain or H and L chains. In a further embodiment,
bacteria, such as C. perfringens, can be recombinantly engineered to
express or over-express one or more siderophores (endogenous or
exogenous), no siderophores, one or more outer membrane proteins,
transport proteins or a combination thereof as described elsewhere to
increase iron acquisition and transport of iron. These methods can be
combined with any of the other methods provided herein.
[0279]ii. Eukaryotic Ferritins
[0280]Eukaryotic ferritins contain 24 subunits (M(r).about.18,000 each)
which define a rhombic dodecahedral protein shell that encloses up to
4000 iron atoms in an oxide/hydroxide/phosphate core (Grossman et al.
(1992) PNAS USA 89:2419-2423). Eight hydrophilic channels that traverse
the protein shell are thought to be the primary avenues by which iron
gains entry to the interior of eukaryotic ferritins. Mammalian ferritins,
have H and L chains, which have complementary functions in iron uptake.
The H chain contains a dinuclear ferroxidase site that is located within
the four-helix bundle of the subunit; it catalyzes the oxidation of
ferrous iron by O.sub.2, producing H.sub.2O.sub.2. The L subunit lacks
this site but contains additional glutamate residues on the interior
surface of the protein shell which produce a microenvironment that
facilitates mineralization and the turnover of Fe.sup.3+ at the H subunit
ferroxidase site (Arosio et al. (1978) J. Biol. Chem. 253(12):4451-4458;
Chasteen and Harrison. J. Struct. Biol. 126(3):182-194 (1999); Rouault
and Klausner (1997) Curr. Top. Cell. Reg. 35:1-19).
[0281]Also encompassed within are diagnostic and therapeutic methods using
eukaryotic cells. Eukaryotic cells include cells from multicellular
eukaryotes, including mammals such as primates, where exemplary cells are
human cells. Typically the cells are isolated cells. For example,
eukaryotic cells can be fibrosarcoma cells such as human fibrosarcoma
cells. Exemplary human fibrosarcoma cells include HT1080 (ATCC Accession
Nos. CCL-121, CRL-12011 or CRL-12012). In another example, eukaryotic
cells can include stem cells, including mammalian stem cells such as
primate stem cells, where exemplary primate stem cells are human stem
cells.
[0282]Also provided herein are modifications of eukaryotic cells to
enhance one or more characteristics relative to the wild type cells. Such
characteristics can include, but are not limited to, increased capacity
to capture and store iron.
[0283]Strategies for expression of recombinant rat liver H and L ferritin
homopolymers in both prokaryotic and eukaryotic expression systems have
been developed (Guo et al. (1998) Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun.
242(1):3945). In another example, over-expression of recombinant human
apoferritin heteromers (heavy (H) and light (L) chains) in E. coli used
T7 RNA polymerase dependent expression, induced by isopropyl
beta-D-thiogalactopyranoside (IPTG) and rifampicin (Grace et al. (2000)
Arch Biochem Biophys. 384(1):116-122). In another example, inserting a
ferritin gene into the plasmid pEMBLex2 has been shown to direct the
synthesis of the ferritin H chain in E. coli up to a concentration of 15%
of total soluble proteins with correct folding of the protein (Bereswill
et al. (1998) Microbiology 144 (Pt 9):2505-2516; Hudson et al. (1993)
Eur. J. Biochem. 218:985-995; Levi et al. (1987) Gene 51(2-3):269-274;
Izuhara et al. (1991) Mol. & Gen. Genet. 225:510-513; Andrews et al.
(1993) Eur. J. Biochem. 213:329-338; Vieira and Messing (1987) Methods
Enzymol. 153:3-11).
[0284]In one embodiment, eukaryotic cells can be recombinantly engineered
to over-express an H chain, an L chain or a combination thereof. For
example, human fibrosarcoma cells, for example, can be transfected with a
plasmid carrying genes encoding H and L chains. In another embodiment,
human fibrosarcoma cells can be transformed with plasmids carrying genes
encoding bacterial ferritin. In a further embodiment, eukaryotic cells
can be transformed with multiple plasmids having genes encoding one or
more ferritins that are endogenous and/or exogenous to the cells. For
example, eukaryotic cells can be transfected with plasmids carrying genes
encoding one or more siderophores and/or one or more outer membrane
proteins or transport proteins as described elsewhere herein to increase
iron acquisition and transport of iron.
[0285]Tumor tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously injected
recombinant eukaryotic cells and/or extracellular bacteria recombinantly
engineered as described herein. Increased iron uptake and/or storage can
result in, not only, increased contrast for visualization and detection,
but also iron depletion from the tumor environment. Iron depletion from
the tumor environment removes a vital nutrient from the tumors, thereby
dis-regulating iron hemostasis in tumor cells and delaying tumor
progression and/or killing the tumor. Additionally, iron or other metal,
can be administered to a tumor-bearing subject, either alone, or in a
conjugated form. An iron conjugate can include, for example, iron
conjugated to an imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In some cases,
the imaging moiety and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g., a
radionuclide. Eukaryotic cell internalization of iron in the tumor
environment allows the internalization of iron alone, a supplemental
imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent (which in turn delivers
cytotoxicity specifically to the tumor cells).
[0286]iii. Viruses
[0287]Viruses can be used to recombinantly express any of the iron storage
proteins in the tumor cell cytosol using methods described herein and
known in the art. Delivery of such proteins to the tumor cell cytosol
using a virus increases metal acquisition, which in turn, increases
contrast agents that can be used for imaging of the tumor in vitro and/or
in vivo. Administration of labeled metals can also be used to increase
contrast for any of the imaging methods described herein. Additionally,
labeled methods can also be used for therapeutic purposes, such as, for
example, radiolabeled iron, to specifically target a tumor. Exemplary
viruses provided herein that express a ferritin include GLV-1h82 and
GLV-1h83.
[0288]In one non-limiting example, tumor tissues can be specifically
infected by intravenously injected viruses (such as Vaccinia virus)
recombinantly engineered to express genes encoding, for example, a H
chain, a L chain, a transferrin receptor, or a combination thereof.
Increased iron uptake and/or storage can result in, not only, increased
contrast for visualization and detection, but also iron accumulation in
the tumor cells. Iron accumulation in the tumor cells can be increased to
toxic levels, thereby dis-regulating iron hemostasis in tumor cells and
delaying tumor progression and/or killing the tumor. Additionally, iron
can be administered to a tumor-bearing subject, either alone, or in a
conjugated form. An iron conjugate can include, for example, iron
conjugated to an imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In some cases,
the imaging moiety and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g., a
radionuclide. In some cases where the imaging moiety and therapeutic
agent are different, a sequential administration of conjugated iron is
contemplated. Internalization of iron in the tumor cells allows the
internalization of iron alone, a supplemental imaging moiety or a
therapeutic agent (which in turn delivers cytotoxicity specifically to
the tumor cells).
[0289]b. Iron Acquisition and Transport
[0290]Iron acquisition systems of bacteria are generally of two-types: (1)
synthesis of molecules, such as siderophores, that are released by a
bacterium into the extracellular milieu and that scavenge iron or heme
from various sources and (2) direct contract between a bacterium and
exogenous iron/heme sources.
[0291]Bacteria can be recombinantly engineered to over-express iron
acquisition systems. Acquired iron is stored in increased amounts in
ferritin-like compounds such as bacterial ferritin, bacterioferritin and
dodecameric ferritin, as described elsewhere herein. Optionally, bacteria
can be recombinantly engineered to over-express ferritin-like compounds
and/or remove transcriptional iron-repression in addition to expression
of iron acquisition systems. Increased iron acquisition can result in,
not only, increased contrast for visualization and detection of tumors
and other hyperproliferative tissue, such as caused by inflammation,
wounds and infections, but also iron depletion from cells, such tumor
cells and/or the tumor environment. Iron depletion from tumor cells
and/or the tumor environment removes a vital nutrient from the tumors,
thereby dis-regulating iron hemostasis and delaying tumor progression
and/or killing the tumor.
[0292]Bacteria can be used to label tumors with an imaging moiety, a
therapeutic agent, or a combination thereof. For example, tumor tissues
can be specifically infected by intravenously injected bacteria which
acquire iron through a variety of mechanisms thereby producing a contrast
agent that can be visualized using the methods described herein.
Administration of labeled metals can be used to increase contrast for any
of the imaging methods described herein. Additionally, iron, or other
labeled metals, can be administered to a tumor-bearing subject, either
alone, or in a conjugated form. An iron conjugate can include, for
example, iron conjugated to an imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In
some cases, the imaging moiety and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g.,
a radionuclide. Bacterial cell internalization of iron in the tumor,
wound, area of inflammation or infection allows the internalization of
iron alone, a supplemental imaging moiety, or a therapeutic agent (which
can deliver cytotoxicity specifically to tumor cells or deliver the
therapeutic agent for treatment of the wound, area of inflammation or
infection). These methods can be combined with any of the other methods
provided herein.
[0293]i. Siderophores
[0294]Plants, bacteria, fungi, and yeast use organic siderophores, which
are iron chelators, to establish commensal and pathogenic relationships
with hosts and to survive as free-living organisms. Siderophores
solubilize iron from mineral complexes in the environment and/or compete
iron from transferrin and lactoferrin in a host, such as a vertebrate
host, under conditions of iron limitation (Ferguson and Deisenhofer
(2002) Biochim. Biophys. Acta. 1565(2):318-332; Raymond et al. (2003)
PNAS USA. 100(7):3584-3588; Drechsel and Jung. (1998) J Pept. Sci.
4(3):147-181; Braun and Braun (2002) FEBS Lett. 529(1):78-85; G.
Winkelmann (2002) Biochem. Soc. Trans. 30(4):691-696). Exemplary
siderophores from a multitude of bacterial species are presented in Table
4.
TABLE-US-00004
TABLE 4
Endogenous Exogenous Host iron
Bacterial Species siderophores siderophores compounds
A. pleuropneumoniae Transferrin
A. hydrophila Amonobactins
A. salmonicida Salmonicida Transferrin,
siderophore lactoferrin
Bacteroides spp. Transferrin
B. pertussis Transferrin,
ovotransferrin,
lactoferrin
C. jejuni Enterochelin Heme,
hemoglobin
Citrobacter spp. Aerobactin
C. diphtheriae corynebacterial Aerobactin
siderophore
Erwinia spp. Ferrioxamine-type
E. coli Enterochelin, Ferrichrome, Heme
dihydroxybenzoic ferricrosin,
acid, ferricrosin, coprogen,
dihydroxy- rhodotorulic acid,
benzoylserine, citrate, ferrioxamine
aerobactin
E. coli Nissle 1917 Enterobactin, Heme
aerobactin,
yersiniabactin,
salmochelin
H. influenzae Enterochelin Heme,
hemoglobin,
transferring
H. parainfluenzae Enterochelin
H. paraphrophilus Enterochelin
H. somnus Transferrin
Hafnia spp. Ferrioxamine- Aerobactin
type
K. pneumoniae Aerobactin, Aerobactin
enterochelin,
ferrioxamine-type
Morganella spp. .alpha.-Keto acids, Aerobactin
.alpha.-hydroxycarboxylic
acids
M. neoaurum Exochelin,
mycobactin
M. smegmatis Exochelin,
mycobactin
M. leprae Exochelin
N. meningitides Heme,
hemoglobin,
transferrin,
lactoferrin
N. gonorrhoeae Aerobactin Heme,
hemoglobin,
transferrin,
lactoferrin
Pantoea spp. Ferrioxamine-type
Proteus spp. .alpha.-Keto acids,
.alpha.-hydroxycarboxylic
acids,
aerobactin
Providencia spp. .alpha.-Keto acids,
.alpha.-hycroxycarboxylic
acids
P. aeruginosa Pyoverdin, Enterochelin
pyochelin
Salmonella spp. Enterochelin,
aerobactin,
hydroxamate-type
Serratia spp. Aerobactin Heme
Shigella spp. Enterochelin,
aerobactin
S. aureus Staphylobactin
S. epidermidis Staphylobactin
S. hyicus Staphyloferrin A, B
V. anguillarum Anguibactin,
enterochelin
V. cholerae Vibriobactin Heme,
hemoglobin
V. vulnificus Catechol-type,
hydroxamate-type
Yersinia spp. Yersiniabactin Aerobactin Heme,
hemoglobin
Note:
The content of this table is not meant to be exhaustive. Any other similar
siderophores from other bacterial strains, which are not listed in this
table, are also considered to be included.
[0295]The structure of siderophores is highly diverse; siderophores can be
proteinaceous or small organic molecules. Pathogenic bacteria are highly
flexible and can use siderophores produced by other organisms, but which
they do not themselves make (Neilands J B. (1984) Microbiol. Sci.
1(1):9-14). Proteins, such as the biosynthetic enzymes that make
siderophores, can be encoded in the bacterial genome or on a plasmid.
Exemplary siderophore biosynthetic enzymes include synthetases, such as
non-ribosomal peptide synthetases (NRPS).
[0296]Bacteria have developed numerous systems to transfer iron from the
extracellular milieu to the intracellular environment. For example,
siderophore-iron complexes can be transported into the cell cytosol by
membrane receptor and transport systems including, but not limited to,
outer membrane proteins, ABC transporters and TonB receptors (Crosa J H.
(1989) Microbiol. Rev. 53(4):517-30; Rohde and Dyer (2003) Frontiers in
Bioscience 8: d1186-d1218). In Gram-negative bacteria, iron usually
transported through a specific outer membrane receptor. In Gram-positive
bacteria, a receptor protein is usually anchored by a covalently linked
lipid and a periplasmic transport protein and several inner
membrane-associated proteins complete the transport of iron into the
bacterial cell, using, for example, an ABC transporter. Bacterial iron
uptake systems are diverse and use a combination of extracellular,
membrane-bound and intracellular proteins to uptake and store iron
(Clarke et al. (2001) Current Topics in Medicinal Chemistry 1:7-30).
[0297]Provided herein are bacteria that over-express siderophores,
including but not limited to the siderophores described herein. The
siderophores can be endogenous to the bacterium, exogenous to the
bacteria, or a combination thereof. The bacteria can be an intracellular
bacterium or an extracellular bacterium. Increased expression and
secretion of the siderophores results in increased iron acquisition by
the bacterium, or the bacteria surrounding it. The bacteria can be
engineered to over-express the siderophores using any method known in the
art or provided herein. In one non-limiting example, the bacteria is
recombinantly engineered to express or over-express one or more
siderophore(s). In one embodiment, bacteria can be recombinantly
engineered to overexpress a siderophore. Also provided herein are
bacteria that have been engineered to inactivate transcriptional iron
suppression using any method known in the art or provided herein.
[0298]Tumor tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously injected
microorganisms and cells recombinantly engineered to express or
over-express any of the siderophores provided herein, thereby creating
iron uptake systems or supplementing a bacteria's own iron uptake and
storage, thereby increasing iron acquisition by the microorganism.
Increased iron acquisition can result in, not only, increased contrast
for visualization and detection, but also iron depletion from the tumor
environment.
[0299]In a further embodiment, iron or iron-loaded siderophores can be
administered to a tumor-bearing subject, either alone, or in a conjugated
form. An iron conjugate can include, for example, iron conjugated to an
imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In some cases, the imaging moiety
and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g., a radionuclide. Bacterial cell
internalization of iron in the tumor environment allows the
internalization of iron alone, a supplemental imaging moiety or a
therapeutic agent (which in turn delivers cytotoxicity specifically to
the tumor cells). These methods can be combined with any of the other
methods provided herein.
[0300]Provided herein are compositions of E. coli Nissle 1917 bacteria
that over-express exogenous siderophores. E. coli Nissle 1917, can be
recombinantly engineered to over-express iron-acquiring mechanisms from
other bacteria to complement its own iron-acquiring systems. Expression
and secretion of the exogenous siderophores increases iron acquisition by
the bacteria. Increased iron acquisition can result in, not only,
increased contrast for visualization and detection, but also iron
depletion from the tumor environment as described above. The bacteria can
be engineered to over-express the siderophores using any method known in
the art or provided herein. In one non-limiting example, E. coli Nissle
1917 are transformed with high copy plasmids having genes encoding
proteins involved in siderophore biosynthesis. Also provided herein are
E. coli Nissle 1917 that have been further engineered to inactivate
transcriptional iron suppression using any method known in the art or
provided herein. For example, E. coli Nissle 1917 can be recombinantly
engineered to remove transcriptional iron-repression by mutation or
deletion of all or part of the fur consensus sequence using any method
known in the art or provided herein. Optionally, E. coli Nissle 1917 can
also be recombinantly engineered to over-express ferritin-like compounds.
These methods can be combined with any of the other methods provided
herein.
[0301]In one embodiment, tumor tissues can be specifically infected by
intravenously injected E. coli Nissle 1917 recombinantly engineered to
over-express siderophores, including but not limited to the siderophores
described herein, to complement their own iron-acquiring systems. Such
engineered bacteria can be used in any of the methods provided herein.
[0302]In another embodiment, bacteria can be recombinantly engineered to
inactivate the genes involved in siderophore biosynthesis. In one
non-limiting example, tumor tissues can be specifically infected by
intravenously injected bacteria (e.g., E. coli Nissle 1917) recombinantly
engineered to have inactivated siderophore-expressing systems, but retain
functional receptors and/or transporters that bind siderophores.
Concomitantly with, or subsequent to, administration of the bacteria,
iron-loaded exogenous siderophores can be systemically administered such
that the siderophores specifically hone to the bacteria. The iron-loaded
siderophores can further be conjugated to a detectable and/or therapeutic
label.
[0303](a) Gram Negative Bacteria
[0304]Gram negative bacteria produce a wide variety of siderophores, use
siderophores from other bacteria, and employ a variety of receptors to
uptake and store iron. Generally, siderophores are proteinaceous or small
organic molecules.
[0305](1) Peptide Siderophores
[0306]The peptidic backbone of siderophores combined with
non-proteinogenic amino acid units embedded in the iron chelators
indicates that some siderophores have a non-ribosomal peptide compound
structure. Many of the proteins involved in biosynthesis of siderophores
are non-ribosomal peptide synthetases (NRPS), which are multi-modular
enzymes that produce peptide products having a particular sequence in the
absence of an RNA template. The order of monomeric amino acids that are
activated and incorporated is dictated by the order of NRPS domains, and
the chains grow as a series of intermediates covalently tethered to the
NRPS domains by peptidyl carrier protein domains (Crosa and Walsh (2002)
Microbiol. Mol. Biol. Rev. 66(2):223-249; Quadri L E. (2000) Mol.
Microbiol. 37(1):1-12). Proteinaceous siderophores from a variety of
bacterial species are presented in Table 4.
[0307]a. Oligopeptide-Containing Siderophores
[0308]Siderophores that are most similar to peptides contain amino acids
in a sequence of .alpha.-amino acids that are linked via underivatized
peptide bonds between carboxy and .alpha.-amino groups. Side chains of
this type of siderophore bind to ferric ions.
[0309]Oligopeptide-containing siderophores include, for example, members
of the ferrichrome family. Ferrichrome siderophores are cyclohexapeptides
of three side-chain derivatized L-ornithines and three other amino acids
(glycine, L-serine or L-alanine).
[0310]Pyoverdins and pseudobactins are fluorescent peptide siderophores
that are largely produced by the Pseudomonad family. Ferribactins, also
produced by Pseudomonads, are likely precursors of pyoverdins. Azobactins
share a peptidic component with pyoverdins, but differ with respect to
the N-terminal chromophore. A variety of chromophores that are
N-acylations of pyoverdins include, for example, malic acid and succinic
acid. Ornibactins are pyoverdin-like siderophores in their oligopeptide
component, but lack a chromophore and carry different .beta.-hydroxy
fatty acids on the N-hydroxylated side chains of the N-terminal
ornithine. Provided herein are bacteria that over-express siderophores,
such as oligopeptide-containing siderophores. In one embodiment, bacteria
can be recombinantly engineered to overexpress a siderophore, such as
pyoverdin.
[0311]The genes encoding synthesis and uptake of pyoverdins are clustered
in the pvd region of the Pseudomonad genome and are regulated by the
promoter region pvdS. The promoter region has been shown to match the
consensus binding side of E. coli Fur protein and transcription of the
pvd region is iron-repressible similar to E. coli (Drechsel and Jung
(1998). J. Pept. Sci. 4(3): 147-181). In one non-limiting example, the
bacterium, such as Pseudomonas aeruginosa, can be recombinantly
engineered to remove transcriptional iron-repression by deleting all or
part of the pvdS promoter region, and transformed with plasmids encoding
proteins involved in siderophore biosynthesis and/or ferritin-like
compounds.
[0312]In another embodiment, tumor tissues can be specifically infected by
intravenously injected P. aeruginosa recombinantly engineered to acquire
iron via expression or over-expression of siderophores in the absence of
transcriptional regulation. Alternatively, or in addition, P. aeruginosa,
can be recombinantly engineered to over-express one or more siderophores.
[0313]b. Siderophores with Side-Chain-Connected Amino Acids Along the
Backbone
[0314]Siderophores can contain amino acids connected to side chains of the
peptide back bone. Fusarinines are a class of hydroxamate siderophores
constructed of N5-acyl-N5-hydroxy-L-ornithine and anhydromevalonic acid,
and have been isolated from a variety of fungi. Amonabactins, on the
other hand, are bacterial catecholate siderophores having amino groups
acylated with 2,3-dihydroxybenzoic acid with or without a glycine reside.
Biosynthesis of 2,3-dihydroxybenzoic acid is functionally similar to the
2,3-dihydroxybenzoic acid operon of E. coli (Drechsel and Jung. J (1998)
Pept. Sci. 4(3): 147-181). Provided herein are bacteria that over-express
siderophores, such as siderophores that contain amino acids connected to
side chains of the peptide backbone. In one embodiment, bacteria can be
recombinantly engineered to overexpress a siderophore, such as
amonabactin.
[0315]c. Siderophores with Amino Acids Acting as Functional Carriers for
Chelating Groups
[0316]Another group of siderophores are those with amino acids acting as
functional carriers for chelating groups, one of which is enterobactin.
Enterobactin (also known as enterochelin) is a tricatecholate siderophore
that can be found in E. coli and other enterobacteriaceae. Chelating
groups of enterobactin result from three residues of 2,3-dihydroxybenzoic
acid (DHBA) anchored on a skeleton of the cyclotriester of L-serine.
2,3-dihydroxybenzoic acid is formed from chorismate by the gene products
of entC, which encodes an isochorismate synthetase, entB, which encodes
2,3-dihydro-2,3-dihydroxybenzoate synthetase, and entA, which encodes
2,3-dihydro-2,3-dihydroxybenzoate dyhydrogenase. Proteins encoded by
genes entD, entE, entF, together with an assembly activity located at the
carboxy terminus of entB, catalyze the formation of the enterobactin
molecule from three molecules each of 2,3-dihydroxybenzoic acid and
L-serine. Further, transport of ferric enterobactin into the bacterial
cell cytosol requires additional genes, such as the fepB, fepC, fepD,
fepE and fepG genes which uptake ferric enterobactin through the
periplasm and cytoplasmic membrane, fepA (encodes the outer membrane
receptor) and fes (intracellular release of iron from enterobactin; Crosa
and Walsh (2002) Microbiol. and Molec. Biol. Reviews 66(2):223-249).
[0317]Other siderophores related catecholate siderophores include, for
example, protochelin, azotochelin and aminochelin, whereas staphyloferrin
A is a member of the carboxylate class of siderophores; however, each has
amino acids acting as functional carriers for chelating groups (Drechsel
and Jung (1998) J. Pept. Sci. 4(3):147-181).
[0318]Provided herein are bacteria that over-express siderophores, such as
siderophores with amino acids acting as functional carriers for chelating
groups. In one embodiment, bacteria can be recombinantly engineered to
over-express a siderophore, such as enterobactin.
[0319]In one embodiment, extracellular bacteria, such as E. coli Nissle
1917, can also be recombinantly engineered to overexpress entABC and
entDEF gene products, thereby increasing production of enterobactin.
Further, bacteria can be recombinantly engineered to over-express
endogenous iron acquiring mechanisms including, but not limited to,
transport of ferric enterobactin into the bacterial cell cytosol requires
additional genes, such as the fepB, fepC, fepD, fepE and fepG genes which
uptake ferric enterobactin through the periplasm and cytoplasmic
membrane, fepA which encodes the outer membrane receptor and fes which
encodes intracellular release of iron from enterobactin.
[0320]d. Siderophores Containing Cyclized Amino Acids
[0321]Some siderophores contain cyclized amino acids. Such siderophores
include, for example, agrobactin, parabactin, fluvibactin, vibriobactin,
vulnibactin, anguibactin, acinetobactin, mycobactin, exochelin,
maduraferrin, pyochelin and yersiniabactin. Agrobactin and parabactin are
structurally similar to protochelins. Analogs of agrobactin and
parabactin include, for example, fluvibactin, vibriobactin and
vulnibactin. Others in the same class include acinetobactin, which is a
monocatecolate/monohydroxamate siderophore containing
2,3-dihydroxybenzoic acid (DHBA) as part of the structure. Anguibactin is
a thiazoline analog of acinetobactin.
[0322]The genes for the biosynthesis of 2,3-dihydroxybenzoic acid are
located on the chromosome of Vibrio anguillarum, whereas the genes for
anguibactin expression are plasmid-mediated. Two regions of the Vibrio
cholerae chromosome are involved with vibriobactin-mediated iron uptake:
one cluster contains the vibriobactin transport and usation genes viuA
and viuB and the biosynthetic gene vibF and the other cluster containes
genes for the synthesis of DHBA from chorismate (vibABC), a gene for
activation of DHBA (vibE), and genes for a periplasmic binding
protein-dependent ABC transport system which transports vibriobactin and
enterobactin through the periplasm and across the inner membrane.
Additionally, gene products of vibD and vibH are required for assembly of
vibriobactin from DHBA, threonine and norspermidine (Crosa and Walsh
(2002) Microbiol. and Molec. Biol. Reviews 66(2):223-249).
[0323]The genes pchA, pchB, pchC and pchD (pchDCBA) and pchEF are required
to form the siderophore pyochelin and its precursors, salicyclic acid and
dihyroaeruginoate (Dha) in P. aeruginosa. Three additional genes, pchG,
pchH and pchI, are located downstream of pchEF and encode a protein
having features similar to the ATP binding cassette transport proteins
that have export functions (Drechsel and Jung (1998) J Pept. Sci.
4(3):147-181; Crosa and Walsh (2002) Microbiol. and Molec. Biol. Reviews
66(2):223-249).
[0324]A cluster of the genes mbtA, mbtB, mbtC, mbtD, mbtE, mbtF, mbtG,
mbtH, mbtI and mbtJ encode the enzymes for assembly of mycobactin and
transport of iron (Crosa and Walsh (2002) Microbiol. and Molec. Biol.
Reviews 66(2):223-249).
[0325]Provided herein are bacteria that over-express siderophores, such as
siderophores containing cyclized amino acids. In one embodiment, bacteria
can be recombinantly engineered to over-express one or more siderophores,
such as agrobactin, parabactin, fluvibactin, vibriobactin, vulnibactin,
anguibactin, acinetobactin, mycobactin, exochelin, maduraferrin,
pyochelin or yersiniabactin.
[0326]In one embodiment, extracellular bacteria, such as E. coli Nissle
1917, can be recombinantly engineered to over-express siderophores from,
for example, V. anguillarum or P. aeruginosa. In one non-limiting
example, tumor tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously
injected E. coli Nissle 1917 recombinantly engineered to encode gene
products of pchDCBA, thereby increasing production of salicyclic acid,
which in turn, causes over-expression of pyochelin siderophores. Further,
bacteria can be, optionally, recombinantly engineered to over-express
endogenous iron acquiring mechanisms including, but not limited to,
transport of ferric enterobactin into the bacterial cell cytosol requires
additional genes, such as the fepB, fepC, fepD, fepE and fepG genes which
uptake ferric enterobactin through the periplasm and cytoplasmic
membrane, fepA which encodes the outer membrane receptor and fes which
encodes intracellular release of iron from enterobactin.
[0327]Intracellular bacteria, such as S. typhimurium, can be recombinantly
engineered to over-express siderophores from, for example, V. anguillarum
or P. aeruginosa. In one non-limiting example, tumor tissues can be
specifically infected by intravenously injected S. typhimurium
recombinantly engineered to encode gene products of pchDCBA, thereby
increasing production of salicyclic acid, which in turn, causes
over-expression of pyochelin siderophores. Optionally, S. typhimurium can
also be recombinantly engineered to over-express ferritin-like compounds
and/or remove transcriptional iron-repression by Fur. S. typhimurium, can
be further recombinantly engineered to over-express iron-acquiring
mechanisms from other bacteria, such as Neisseria, to complement its own
iron-acquiring systems.
[0328]e. Siderophores Containing Amino Acids of Unusual Structure
[0329]Another class of siderophores that contain amino acids having
unusual structures. Rhizobactin DM4 belongs to the carboxylate class of
siderophores. The amino group of the Rhizobactin DM4 alanine is
ethylene-bridged to the amino group of lysine, the side chain of which is
acylated with L-malic acid. Other peptide siderophores that have unusual
structures include, for example, members the schizokinen/aerobactin
family, rhodotorulic acid, and phytosiderophores. The
schizokinen/aerobactin family is characterized by citric acid with amino
acids or diamines amidated on both carboxy groups. Exemplary members of
the schizokinen/aerobactin family include schizokinen, arthrobactin,
rhizobactin 1021, acinetoferrin, aerobactin and nannochelin A,
nannochelin B, and nannochelin C. Schizokinen, arthrobactin, rhizobactin
1021, acinetoferrin contain amidated diamines, and are thus considered
non-proteinaceous (see Non-proteinaceous siderophores below), while
aerobactin and nannochelins contain amidated amino acids. Aerobactin
contains side-chain amino groups that are N-hydroxylated and acetylated,
while nannochelins have cinnamoyl residues in place of the acetylation.
Rhodotorulic acid, and a similar siderophore dimerum acid, are
characterized by diketopiperazine rings from
N.sup.5-acylated-N.sup.5-hydroxylated ornithine. Phytosiderophores
contain .alpha.-amino acid substructures, no amide bonds and bonds formed
by N-alkylations. Exemplary phytosiderophores include mugineic acid,
nicotianamine, avenic acid, and distichonic acid.
[0330]In addition to enterobactin, E. coli produce the siderophore,
aerobactin, which steals iron from human iron carriers such as
transferrin. Aerobactin is a hydroxamate-type siderophore is a derivative
of citrate and can leach iron from ferric transferrin (Neilands J B
(1984) Microbiol. Sci. 1(1):9-14). The aerobactin gene of E. coli has
been shown to be encoded on the pColV plasmid, and four genes (aerA
(lysine-N.sup.6-oxidase), aerB (N.sup.6-hydroxylysine:acetyl CoA
N.sup.6-acetyltransferase), aerC and aerD) encode the biosynthetic
enzymes that assemble the aerobactin siderophore (Drechsel and Jung
(1998) J. Pept. Sci. 4(3):147-181).
[0331]Provided herein are bacteria that over-express siderophores, such as
siderophores containing amino acids having unusual structures. In one
embodiment, bacteria can be recombinantly engineered to over-express a
siderophore, such as aerobactin.
[0332]Bacteria (e.g., E. coli Nissle 1917) can be recombinantly engineered
to over-express iron-acquiring mechanisms of other bacteria such as P.
aeruginosa. In one non-limiting example, tumor tissues can be
specifically infected by intravenously injected E. coli Nissle 1917
recombinantly engineered to encode aerA, aerB, aerC and aerD gene
products under the control of a high replication promoter, thereby
increasing production of aerobactin.
[0333](2) Non-Proteinaceous Siderophores
[0334]Non-peptide siderophores include, for example, those that contain
diamines instead of amino acids and/or can be N-hydroxylated to form
hydroxamates (e.g., ferioxamine, schizokinen, arthrobactin, rhizobactin
1021, acinetoferrin) or serve as carriers for other chelating
substructures (e.g., the rhizoferrins, staphyloferrin B) (Drechsel and
Jung (1998) J. Pept. Sci. 4(3):147-181). Non-proteinaceous siderophores
from a variety of bacterial species are presented in Table 4.
[0335]Provided herein are bacteria that over-express non-peptide
siderophores. In one embodiment, bacteria can be recombinantly engineered
to over-express one or more siderophores, such as ferioxamine,
schizokinen, arthrobactin, rhizobactin 1021, acinetoferrin, rhizoferrin
or staphyloferrin B. Bacteria (e.g., E. coli Nissle 1917) can be
recombinantly engineered to express or over-express non-peptide
siderophores. In one non-limiting example, tumor tissues can be
specifically infected by intravenously injected E. coli Nissle 1917
recombinantly engineered to express non-peptide siderophores.
[0336](3) Receptor and Transport Proteins
[0337]Many bacteria have developed multiple systems regulating the intake
and storage of iron. For example, E. coli uses at least five outer
membrane proteins that are receptors for siderophores and other iron
complexes. E. coli also expresses several envelope-associated proteins in
addition to the outer membrane receptors, some of which are involved in
transport across the outer membrane, transport iron (alone or as a
ferric-siderophore complex), across the periplasm and cytoplasmic
membrane.
[0338]Numerous bacterial proteins are involved in microbial iron uptake
and transport, and considerable variation has been found in the uptake
schemes used by different bacterial species.
[0339]The outer membrane of Gram-negative bacteria constitutes a
permeability barrier that protects the cell from exterior hazards, but
also complicates the uptake of nutrients, such as iron. Bacteria have
evolved such that receptor, transporter and energy-transducing proteins
ensure that there is a sufficient supply of iron to the cell
(Faraldo-Gomez and Sansom (2003) Nat. Rev. Mol. Cell. Biol. 4(2):
105-116).
[0340]Certain transport proteins also function in siderophore-mediated
signaling cascades that start at the cell surface and flow to the
cytoplasm to initiate transcription of genes encoding proteins for
biosynthesis of transporter proteins and siderophores (Braun and Braun
(2002) FEBS Lett. 529(1):78-85). Gram-negative pathogenic bacteria employ
outer membrane receptors, periplasmic binding proteins and inner membrane
associated proteins such as a transporter coupled with an ATP-hydrolyzing
protein to extract iron from siderophores. Gram-negative bacteria couple
the chemiosmotic gradient of the cytoplasmic membrane with
ferric-siderophore transport across the outer membrane. Siderophore
uptake into the cytoplasm is mediated by periplasmic binding
protein-dependent ABC transporters.
[0341]In Gram-negative bacteria, transport of siderophores into the
periplasm is often mediated by TonB-dependent receptors. A complex of
three membrane-spanning proteins TonB, ExbB and ExbD couples the
chemiosmotic potential of the cytoplasmic membrane with siderophore
uptake across the outer membrane. Siderophore binding induces distinct
local and allosteric transitions that establish the structural basis of
signal transduction across the outer membrane and suggest a transport
mechanism (Ferguson and Deisenhofer (2002) Biochim. Biophys. Acta.
1565(2):318-332).
[0342]In one example of the above-described systems, Escherichia coli
forms sophisticated Fe.sup.+3-siderophore and heme transport systems
across the outer membrane. E. coli transports its own siderophores as
well as those derived from other bacterial species, and even some fungi,
across the outer membrane. Siderophores are transported across the double
membrane envelope of E. coli via a gating mechanism linking the inner and
outer membranes (Neilands J B. (1995) J. Biol. Chem. 270(45):26723-26726;
Klebba P E (2003) Frontiers in Bioscience 8: s1422-s1436). The E. coli
genome has a number of genes that encode transport systems: FecABCDE
transports ferric citrate; FepABCDG transports ferrienterobactin;
FhuABCDE transports ferrichrome, ruodoturulate and coprogen; and Cir is a
dihydroxybenzylserine outer membrane receptor. Proteins involved in iron
up-take by E. coli are summarized in Table 5.
TABLE-US-00005
TABLE 5
Siderophore
system Activity
FepA Receptor for endogenous catechol siderophore enterochelin
(a cyclic trimester of 2,3-dihydroxy-N-benzoyl serine); and
transporter of iron complexes of the enterochelin precursor,
dihydroxybenzoic acid and the enterochelin breakdown
product, dihyroxybenzoylserine.
FhuA Receptor for ferrichrome (a cyclic trihydroxamate
siderophore), produced by many fungal species (e.g.,
Ustilago sphaerogena and Penicillium spp.); receptor for
hydroxamate siderophores ferricrysin and ferricrosin
produced by Aspergillus spp..
FhuE Receptor for linear hydroxamate siderophores coprogen
produced by Penicillium and Neurospora species and
rhodotorulic acid produced by Rhodotorula,
Sporobolomyces and Leucosporidium species.
Cir and Fiu Susceptible to catechol-substituted cephalosporins and .beta.-
lactams for transport of monocatecholic iron complexes;
and transporter of iron complexes of the enterochelin
precursor, dihydroxybenzoic acid and the enterochelin
breakdown product, dihyroxybenzoylserine.
FecA Required for usation of ferric dicitrate as an iron source.
FoxB Receptor for ferrioxamine B (a hydroxamate siderophore
synthesized by certain strains of Streptomyces) induced in
E. coli K-12 only in the presence of its cognate ligand.
IutA Outer membrane protein encoded on plasmid ColV-K30
that secretes the hydroxamate siderophore, aerobactin,
produced by K. pneumoniae. Scavenged by several E. coli
strains.
[0343]FecI from Escherichia coli K-12 is an alternative sigma factor
protein of the extracytoplasmic function (ECF) family involved in iron
acquisition and hence named the iron-starvation sigmas. FecI causes
expression of genes for uptake of ferric citrate and forms part of a
signaling system that responds to the presence of ferric citrate.
Fec-like signaling systems are present in a wide range of species and
many such systems can be present in a single species.
[0344]A variety of other bacteria use other proteins to direct transport
of siderophores across the bacterial membrane: PupAB of P. putida
transports pseuobactin; FuyA, FoxA and FcuA are Yersinia enterocolotica
outer membrane receptors for yersiniabactin, ferrioxamine B and
ferrichrome, respectively; and FhuBCDB transports ferrichrome for
Azotobacter vinelandii and Bacillus subtilis. Other outer membrane
receptors such as BfeA or BfrABC, can be used by bacteria to transport
siderophores and would be known to one skilled in the art (Clarke et al.
(2001) Curr. Top. In Med. Chem. 1:7-30; Koster W. (2001) Res. Microbiol.
152(3-4):291-301).
[0345]Two regions of the Vibrio cholerae chromosome are involved with
vibriobactin-mediated iron uptake: one cluster contains the vibriobactin
transport and usation genes viuA and viuB and the other cluster containes
genes for a periplasmic binding protein-dependent ABC transport system
which transports vibriobactin and enterobactin through the periplasm and
across the inner membrane (Crosa and Walsh (2002) Microbiol. and Molec.
Biol. Reviews 66(2):223-249).
[0346]Different periplasmic ligand binding proteins exercise distinct
mechanisms for ligand binding and release. For example, E. coli uses the
outer membrane siderophore transport proteins FepA and FhuA and an
unusual periplasmic siderophore binding protein, FhuD, for ligand
transport through the bacterial outer membrane. Neisseria species and
Haemophilus influenzae use the prototypical periplasmic ferric binding
protein FbpA for ligand binding and release, which is structurally
different from the E. coli proteins. Serratia marcescens uses the
hemophore HasA to extract and use heme. The proteins that provide energy
for iron transport at the outer membrane, such as the TonB-ExbB-ExbD
system, are structurally very similar across bacterial species, and
allows for use of siderophores from different species in the same
bacteria (Clarke et al. (2001) Curr. Top. Med. Chem. 1(1):7-30; Poole and
McKay (2003) Front Biosci. 8: d661-686).
[0347]One of skill in the art recognizes that any gene of the transporter
pathways described herein could be recombinantly engineered such that the
encoded protein is overexpressed, thereby facilitating binding of
siderophores to the bacterial cell surface, eukaryotic cell surface or
tumor cell surface (via recombinant viruses). Increased expression of the
receptors increases binding of iron-siderophore complexes to the
receptor. Increased iron binding can increase contrast for use in any of
the imaging methods provided herein. Additionally, siderophores linked to
a therapeutic agent can be used to specifically target bacteria in the
tumor environment, thereby specifically delivering the therapeutic agent
to the tumor(s). For example, the gene(s) that encode FepA can be placed
under the control of a strong promoter on the microbial chromosome, or
recombinantly engineered on a plasmid with a high replication rate,
resulting in over-expression of FepA.
[0348]Tumor tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously injected
recombinant extracellular microorganism or cell (e.g., extracellular
bacteria or eukaryotic cell), thereby increasing iron-siderophore binding
and/or transport by the microorganism or cell in the tumor environment.
In one non-limiting example, E. coli Nissle 1917 is recombinantly
engineered to express FhuE such that the bacteria binds linear
hydroxamate siderophores. In another embodiment, bacteria (e.g., E. coli
Nissle 1917) can be recombinantly engineered to inactivate the genes
encoding the siderophore biosynthetic enzymes. Concomitantly with, or
subsequent to, administration of the bacteria, iron-loaded siderophores
can be systemically administered such that the siderophores specifically
hone to the bacteria. The iron-loaded siderophores can further be
conjugated to a detectable label and/or therapeutic agent. In one
non-limiting example, the linear hydroxamate siderophores that bind FhuE
can be administered in a conjugated form, where the conjugated moiety is
an imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. This method can be combined
with any of the other methods provided herein.
[0349]Tumor tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously injected
recombinant intracellular microorganism (e.g., intracellular bacteria),
thereby increasing iron-siderophore binding by the receptor expressed on
the cell surface of an intracellular bacteria in the tumor cell cytosol.
In one non-limiting example, S. typhimurim is recombinantly engineered to
express FepA on the bacterial cell surface within the tumor cell cytosol.
Increased iron binding in the form of iron-siderophore complexes can
result in, not only, increased contrast for visualization and detection,
but also iron depletion from tumor cells and/or the tumor environment as
described herein.
[0350](b) Gram-Positive Bacteria
[0351](1) Siderophores
[0352]Relatively few siderophores are known to be produced by
Gram-positive organisms. Bacillus subtilis secretes the siderophore
2,3-dihydroxybenzoyl glycine (DHBG) in response to iron stress, whereas
C. diphtheria produces a corynebacterial siderophore, and M. smegmatis
produces the siderophores exochelin and mycobactin (U.S. Pat. No.
5,554,507; Wooldridge and Williams (1993) FEMS Microbiol. Rev.
12(4):325-348).
[0353]B. subtilis DHBG is a catecholic siderophore similar in structure
and synthesis to E. coli enterobactin, 2,3-dihydroxybenzoyl serine
(DHBS). Biosynthesis of DHBG in B. subtilis is carried out by a similar
set of enzymes, encoded within the dhb operon, dhbA, dhbc, dhbE, dhbB and
dhbF. Amino-acid identities between E. coli and B. subtilis gene product
homologs are: EntA and DhbA, 41%; EntC and DhbC, 35%; EntE and DhbE, 48%;
EntB and DhbB, 54%; and EntF and DhbF, 29%. The promoter region of the
dhb operon contains a consensus binding site of the Fur protein and
transcription of the dhb region is iron-repressible similar to E. coli.
B. subtilis can express three Fur homologs, ferric uptake repressor
(Fur), zinc uptake repressor (Zur) and peroxide regulon repressor (PerR).
[0354]Bacteria (intracellular, extracellular, Gram-positive or
Gram-negative) can be recombinantly engineered to express or over-express
one or more Gram-positive bacterial siderophores.
[0355]Gram positive bacteria (intracellular or extracellular), can be
recombinantly engineered to inactivate the genes involved in siderophore
biosynthesis. Concomitantly with, or subsequent to, administration of the
bacteria, iron-loaded siderophores can be systemically administered such
that the siderophores specifically hone to the bacteria. The iron-loaded
siderophores can further be conjugated to a detectable and/or therapeutic
label.
[0356]In one non-limiting example, bacteria, such as B. subtilis, can be
recombinantly engineered to over-express the genes encoding the enzymes
required for DHBG biosynthesis, thereby over-expressing siderophores.
Optionally, B. subtilis can also be recombinantly engineered to
over-express ferritin-like compounds and/or remove transcriptional
iron-repression by mutation or deletion of all or part of the fur
consensus sequence using any method known in the art or provided herein.
In one non-limiting example, tumor tissues can be specifically infected
by intravenously injected recombinantly engineered B. subtilis causing
increased production of DHBG, thereby dis-regulating iron hemostasis in
the tumor environment.
[0357]Alternatively, bacteria such as B. subtilis can be recombinantly
engineered to express or over-express siderophores, such as
corynebacterial siderophore. Tumor tissues can be specifically infected
by intravenously injected recombinantly engineered B. subtilis, thereby
secreting the corynebacterial siderophore, increasing iron acquisition
and dis-regulating iron hemostasis in the tumor environment.
[0358]In another embodiment, a Gram-negative bacteria such as E. Coli
Nissle 1917 can be recombinantly engineered to over-express the genes
encoding DHBG biosynthetic enzymes and/or the receptor for DHBG.
Optionally, E. coli Nissle 1917 also can be recombinantly engineered to
over-express ferritin-like compounds and/or remove transcriptional
iron-repression. Tumor tissues can be specifically infected by
intravenously injected recombinantly engineered E. coli Nissle 1917.
Increased iron binding in the form of iron-DHBG complexes can result in,
not only, increased contrast for visualization and detection, but also
iron depletion from tumor cells and/or the tumor environment. Iron
depletion from tumor cells and/or the tumor environment removes a vital
nutrient from the tumor cells, thereby dis-regulating iron hemostasis in
tumor cells and delaying tumor progression and/or killing the tumor.
Additionally, iron can be administered to a tumor-bearing subject, either
alone, or in a conjugated form. An iron conjugate can include, for
example, iron conjugated to an imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In
some cases, the imaging moiety and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g.,
a radionuclide. Alternatively, DHBG can be administered in a conjugated
form, where the conjugated moiety is an imaging moiety or a therapeutic
agent. In some cases, the imaging moiety and therapeutic agent are the
same, e.g., a radionuclide. This method can be combined with any of the
other methods provided herein.
[0359]In another embodiment, an intracellular bacteria, such as S.
typhimurium can be recombinantly engineered to over-express the gene
encoding DHBG, a precursor thereof, and the receptor for DHBG.
Optionally, S. typhimurium also can be recombinantly engineered to
over-express ferritin-like compounds and/or remove transcriptional
iron-repression. Tumor cells can be specifically infected by
intravenously injected recombinantly engineered S. typhimurium. In the
tumor cell cytosol, DHBG would bind internalized iron and transport it to
the DHBG receptor. Increased iron binding in the form of iron-DHBG
complexes can result in, not only, increased contrast for visualization
and detection, but also iron depletion from tumor cells and/or the tumor
environment. Iron depletion from the tumor environment removes a vital
nutrient from the tumor cells, thereby dis-regulating iron hemostasis in
tumor cells and delaying tumor progression and/or killing the tumor.
Additionally, iron can be administered to a tumor-bearing subject, either
alone, or in a conjugated form. An iron conjugate can include, for
example, iron conjugated to an imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In
some cases, the imaging moiety and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g.,
a radionuclide. Alternatively, DHBG can be administered in a conjugated
form, where the conjugated moiety is an imaging moiety or a therapeutic
agent. In some cases, the imaging moiety and therapeutic agent are the
same, e.g., a radionuclide. This method can be combined with any of the
other methods provided herein.
[0360](2) Receptor and Transport Proteins
[0361]The receptor proteins that are anchored in the plasma membrane of
Gram-positive bacteria deliver siderophores to ATP-binding-cassette (ABC)
importers, which promote their translocation across the membrane. ABC
importers require energy from the hydrolysis of ATP to transport
translocation across the cell membrane in bacteria such as B. subtilis,
and C. diphtheria (Faraldo-Gomez and Sansom (2003) Mol. Cell. Biol.
4:1-5-116). In Staphylococcus epidermidis and Staphylococcus aureus, a
number of cell wall- and cytoplasmic membrane-associated lipoproteins are
induced in response to iron starvation. The S. epidermidis sitABC operon
has been sequenced as has been shown to encode an ABC transporter protein
that transports ferric-siderophores into the cell cytosol (Hill et al.
(1998) Infect Immun. 66(9):4123-4129).
[0362]Bacteria (intracellular or extracellular) can be recombinantly
engineered to over-express the sitABC operon encoding the ABC transporter
that transports ferric-siderophores into the cell cytosol. For example,
extracellular bacteria, such as B. subtilis, can be recombinantly
engineered to over-express the sitABC operon encoding the ABC
transporter. In one non-limiting example, tumor tissues can be
specifically infected by intravenously injecting such recombinantly
engineered B. subtilis, thereby facilitating intake of siderophores in
extracellular spaces and causing dis-regulation of iron hemostasis in the
tumor environment.
[0363]In another example, intracellular bacteria, such as S. typhimurium,
can be recombinantly engineered to over-express the sitABC operon
encoding the ABC transporter. In one non-limiting example, tumor cells
can be specifically infected by intravenously injecting such
recombinantly engineered S. typhimurium, thereby facilitating intake of
siderophores from the tumor cell cytosol and causing dis-regulation of
iron hemostasis in the tumor cells.
[0364]Increased iron acquisition by the bacteria can result in, not only,
increased contrast for visualization and detection, but also iron
depletion from tumor cells and/or the tumor environment. Iron depletion
from tumor cells and/or the tumor environment removes a vital nutrient
from the tumors, thereby dis-regulating iron hemostasis in tumor cells
and delaying tumor progression and/or killing the tumor. Additionally,
iron can be administered to a tumor-bearing subject, either alone, or in
a conjugated form. An iron conjugate can include, for example, iron
conjugated to an imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In some cases,
the imaging moiety and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g., a
radionuclide. Bacterial cell internalization of iron in the tumor
environment allows the internalization of iron alone, a supplemental
imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent (which in turn delivers
cytotoxicity specifically to the tumor cells). This method can be
combined with any of the other methods provided herein.
[0365](c) Viruses
[0366]Viruses (such as Vaccinia virus) also can be used to increase iron
accumulation by tumor cells. For example, the tumor tissues can be
specifically infected by intravenously injected engineered Vaccinia virus
carrying, for example, a siderophore receptor gene and/or genes encoding
siderophore biosynthetic enzymes (also encoding signal peptides for cell
surface expression and secretion). Expression of the siderophore receptor
on the tumor cell surface will mark these cells for targeting by
siderophores. Tumor cell binding and/or internalization of the
siderophore-metal (e.g., iron, gadolinium or gallium) pair increases iron
accumulation. In addition, internalization of the siderophore-metal
(e.g., iron, gadolinium or gallium) pair can result in accumulation of
iron to a toxic level, thereby causing tumor cell lysis, and/or
accumulation of iron to a level that can be detected using any of the
imaging methods provided herein. This method can be combined with any of
the other methods provided herein.
[0367]Tumor tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously injected
recombinant intracellular microorganism (e.g., virus), thereby increasing
iron-siderophore binding by the receptor expressed on the tumor cell
surface. In one non-limiting example, Vaccinia virus can be recombinantly
engineered to express FepA (via a signal peptide) on the tumor cell
surface. Increased iron binding in the form of iron-siderophore complexes
can result in, not only, increased contrast for visualization and
detection, but also depletion of tumor cells of iron in a usable form.
Iron depletion from the tumor environment removes a vital nutrient from
the tumors, thereby dis-regulating iron hemostasis in tumor cells and
delaying tumor progression and/or killing the tumor. Additionally, iron
can be administered to a tumor-bearing subject, either alone, or in a
conjugated form. An iron conjugate can include, for example, iron
conjugated to an imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In some cases,
the imaging moiety and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g., a
radionuclide. Alternatively, the siderophore that binds to the
recombinantly engineered receptor can be administered in a conjugated
form, where the conjugated moiety is an imaging moiety or a therapeutic
agent. In some cases, the imaging moiety and therapeutic agent are the
same, e.g., a radionuclide. This method can be combined with any of the
other methods provided herein.
[0368](d) Eukaryotic Cells
[0369]Eukaryotic cells also can be used to deplete iron from the tumor
cell environment. For example, the tumor tissues can be specifically
infected by intravenously injected engineered eukaryotic cells (e.g.,
human fibrosarcoma cells) carrying, for example, a siderophore receptor
gene and/or genes encoding siderophore biosynthetic enzymes (also
encoding signal peptides for cell surface expression and secretion).
Expression of the siderophore receptor on the eukaryotic cell surface
will mark these cells for targeting by siderophores. Internalization of
the siderophore-metal (e.g., iron, gadolinium or gallium) pair increases
iron accumulation. In addition, internalization of the siderophore-metal
(e.g., iron, gadolinium or gallium) pair can result depletion of iron
from the tumor environment, thereby killing tumor cells, and/or
accumulation of iron to a level that can be detected using any of the
imaging methods provided herein. This method can be combined with any of
the other methods provided herein.
[0370]One of skill in the art would recognize that any gene of the
transporter pathways described herein could be recombinantly engineered
such that the encoded protein is overexpressed, thereby facilitating
binding of siderophores to a eukaryotic cell surface. Increased
expression of the receptors increases binding of iron-siderophore
complexes to the receptor, and increased iron binding can increase
contract for use in any of the imaging methods provided herein.
Additionally, siderophores linked to a therapeutic agent can be used to
specifically target eukaryotic cells in the tumor environment, thereby
specifically delivering the therapeutic agent to the tumor(s).
[0371]In one non-limiting example, tumor tissues can be injected with
recombinant eukaryotic cells, thereby increasing iron-siderophore binding
and/or iron transport by the recombinant cells in the tumor environment.
A human fibrosarcoma cell line is recombinantly engineered, for example
to express FepA such that the cells binds enterochelin. Increased iron
binding in the form of iron-enterochelin complexes can result in, not
only, increased contrast for visualization and detection, but also iron
depletion from the tumor environment as described herein. Iron depletion
from the tumor environment removes a vital nutrient from the tumors,
thereby dis-regulating iron hemostasis in tumor cells and delaying tumor
progression and/or killing the tumor. Additionally, iron can be
administered to a tumor-bearing subject, either alone, or in a conjugated
form. An iron conjugate can include, for example, iron conjugated to an
imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In some cases, the imaging moiety
and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g., a radionuclide. Alternatively,
enterochelin can be administered in a conjugated form, where the
conjugated moiety is an imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In some
cases, the imaging moiety and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g., a
radionuclide. This method can be combined with any of the other methods
provided herein.
[0372](e) Multiple Siderophore and Uptake Systems
[0373]The majority of bacteria, especially gram negative bacteria, produce
more than one siderophore and have more than one transport and storage
systems to meet the basic demand for iron. For example, fluorescent
pseudomonads primarily produce complex peptidic siderophores called
pyoverdines or pseudobactins, but they also produce a variety of other
siderophores, such as, for example, pseudobactins, catecholate
siderophores, lipopeptidic siderophores, salicyclic acid, pseudomonine,
pyochelin, micacodicin, hydrogen cyanide, hydroxamate siderophores,
ferrorosamine, and derivatives thereof. Siderophores that are related to
pyoverdins include, for example, 5,6-dihydrophyoverdins, ferribactins and
Azotobacter and Azomonas siderophores.
[0374]Bacteria also compete with each other and the environment for iron.
In addition to making multiple siderophores, transport and storage
systems, most bacteria are capable of capturing heterologous siderophores
(also termed "xenosiderophores") from other bacterial species. For
example, P. aeruginosa can use enterobactin (enterochelin) produced by E.
coli as well as its biosynthetic precursors (e.g., 2,3-dihydrobenzoic
acid and N-(2,3-dihydroxybenzoyl)-L-serine), and desferri-ferrioxamine B
(desferal) from Streptomyces species (Budzikiewicz et al. (2004)
Fortschr. Chem. Org. Naturst. 87:81-237). Activation of the heterologous
transport systems is not only regulated by iron availability but also
requires the presence of their cognate ferric-siderophores. The ability
to use a variety of heterologous siderophores reflects both the
importance of iron for growth and survival and the need to compete with
other microorganisms in the environments that they inhabit (Venturi et
al. (1995) Mol. Microbiol. 17(4):603-610; Schalk et al. (2002) Biochem.
Soc. Trans. 30(4):702-705).
[0375]For the methods provided herein, bacteria can be recombinantly
engineered to over-express more than one endogenous siderophore, more
than endogenous transport receptor, more than one storage proteins or a
combination thereof. Alternatively, or in addition, bacteria also can be
recombinantly engineered to express one or more heterologous
siderophores, transport receptor, storage proteins or a combination
thereof. Bacteria used herein can be intracellular bacteria or
extracellular bacteria.
[0376]In one non-limiting embodiment, E. coli Nissle 1917 is recombinantly
engineered to over-express E. coli enterobactin and the TonB receptor. In
one example, E. coli Nissle 1917 is recombinantly engineered to
over-express E. coli enterobactin and P. aeruginosa pyoverdin. In yet
another example, E. coli Nissle 1917 is recombinantly engineered to
over-express P. aeruginosa pyoverdin and the ThpA-TbpB receptor of
Neisseria. Tumor tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously
injected E. coli Nissle 1917 recombinantly engineered as described above,
thereby increasing iron acquisition by the bacteria in the tumor
environment. Increased metal acquisition in the form of siderophore-metal
(e.g., iron, gadolinium or gallium) can result in, not only, increased
contrast for visualization and detection, but also iron depletion from
the tumor environment. Iron depletion from the tumor environment removes
a vital nutrient from the tumors, thereby dis-regulating iron hemostasis
in the tumor cells and delaying tumor progression and/or killing the
tumor. Additionally, iron can be administered to a tumor-bearing subject,
either alone, or in a conjugated form. An iron conjugate can include, for
example, iron conjugated to an imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In
some cases, the imaging moiety and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g.,
a radionuclide. Bacterial cell internalization of iron in the tumor
environment allows the internalization of iron alone, a supplemental
imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent (which in turn delivers
cytotoxicity specifically to the tumor cells). This method can be
combined with any of the other methods provided herein.
[0377]For the methods provided herein, eukaryotic cells can be
recombinantly engineered to express or over-express one or more
siderophore(s), one or more exogenous siderophore membrane receptor(s) or
a combination thereof. For example, human fibrosarcoma cells can be
recombinantly engineered to express or over-express the FepA receptor and
the siderophore, enterochelin. Alternatively, or in addition, eukaryotic
cells also can be recombinantly engineered to express one or more
heterologous storage protein(s), or a combination thereof as described
elsewhere herein. For example, the human fibrosarcoma cells can be
recombinantly engineered to express or over-express a bacterioferritin,
bacterial ferritin, dodecameric ferritin, an H chain, an L chain or a
combination thereof. Tumor tissues can be specifically infected by
intravenously injected human fibrosarcoma cells recombinantly engineered
as described above, thereby increasing iron binding/acquisition by the
human fibrosarcoma cells in the tumor environment. Increased metal
acquisition in the form of siderophore-metal (e.g., iron, gadolinium or
gallium) can result in, not only, increased contrast for visualization
and detection, but also iron depletion from the tumor environment. Iron
depletion from the tumor environment removes a vital nutrient from the
tumors, thereby dis-regulating iron hemostasis in the tumor cells and
delaying tumor progression and/or killing the tumor. Additionally, iron
can be administered to a tumor-bearing subject, either alone, or in a
conjugated form. An iron conjugate can include, for example, iron
conjugated to an imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In some cases,
the imaging moiety and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g., a
radionuclide. Eukaryotic cell internalization of iron in the tumor
environment allows the internalization of iron alone, a supplemental
imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent (which in turn delivers
cytotoxicity specifically to the tumor cells). This method can be
combined with any of the other methods provided herein.
[0378]For the methods provided herein, viruses can be recombinantly
engineered to express or express or over-express one or more
siderophore(s), one or more exogenous siderophore membrane receptor(s) or
a combination thereof on the surface of tumor cells using any of the
methods provided herein. For example, a vaccinia virus can be
recombinantly engineered to express or over-express the FepA receptor and
the siderophore, enterochelin using the appropriate signal peptides such
that, when infected, the tumor cell expresses the receptor on the tumor
cell surface and secretes the siderophore. Expression of the receptor on
the tumor cell surface marks the cells for siderophore-metal binding.
Alternatively, or in addition, viruses also can be recombinantly
engineered to express one or more heterologous storage protein(s), as
described elsewhere herein, which increase iron storage in the tumor
cells. For example, a vaccinia virus can be recombinantly engineered to
express or over-express a bacterioferritin, bacterial ferritin,
dodecameric ferritin, an H chain, an L chain or a combination thereof.
Tumor tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously injected
vaccinia virus recombinantly engineered as described above, thereby
increasing iron binding/acquisition by the tumor cells.
[0379]Increased metal binding/acquisition in the form of siderophore-metal
(e.g., iron, gadolinium or gallium) can result in, not only, increased
contrast for visualization and detection, but also depletion of tumor
cells of iron in a usable form. Iron depletion from the tumor environment
removes a vital nutrient from the tumors, thereby dis-regulating iron
hemostasis in the tumor cells and delaying tumor progression and/or
killing the tumor. Additionally, iron can be administered to a
tumor-bearing subject, either alone, or in a conjugated form. An iron
conjugate can include, for example, iron conjugated to an imaging moiety
or a therapeutic agent. In some cases, the imaging moiety and therapeutic
agent are the same, e.g., a radionuclide. Tumor cell binding and/or
internalization of iron in the tumor environment allows the
internalization of iron alone, a supplemental imaging moiety or a
therapeutic agent (which in turn delivers cytotoxicity specifically to
the tumor cells). This method can be combined with any of the other
methods provided herein.
[0380](f) Acquisition of Metals Other than Iron
[0381]In addition to binding iron, siderophores, such as pyoverdins, also
are able to form complexes with other metals, such as gallium, gadolinium
and chromium (Cornelis and Matthijs (2002) Environ. Microbiol.
4(12):787-798; Neilands J B (1984) Microbiol. Sci. 1(1):9-14; Cornelis
and Matthijs (2002) Environ. Microbiol. 4(12):787-798).
[0382]In addition to increased internal contrast agent via iron
acquisition, a subject can be systemically injected labeled gallium, such
as .sup.67Ga, which will be bound by the siderophore, resulting in
increased contrast agent at the site of the tumor. The tumors can then be
visualized by any of the methods provided herein. This method can be used
for any of the microorganisms and cells provided herein and combined with
any other method described herein.
[0383]In one non-limiting example, tumor tissues can be specifically
infected by intravenously injected bacteria (such as E. coli Nissle 1917)
recombinantly engineered to express or over-express pyoverdin, thereby
supplementing the bacteria's own iron uptake and storage and increasing
iron acquisition by the bacteria in the tumor environment. The subject
can be intravenously injected with labeled gallium, which will be bound
by pyoverdin, resulting in increased contrast agent at the site of the
tumor. Administration of labeled gallium can be concurrent with, prior
to, or subsequent to, administration of the recombinant bacteria. The
tumors can then be visualized by any of the methods provided herein. This
method can be combined with any other method described herein.
[0384]In one non-limiting example, tumor tissues can be specifically
infected by intravenously injected viruses (such as Vaccinia virus)
recombinantly engineered to express or over-express pyoverdin by the
tumor cells or the pyoverdin receptor (also encoding single peptides for
cell surface expression and secretion) on the surface of the tumor cells,
thereby increasing iron acquisition by the tumor cells. The subject can
be intravenously injected with labeled gallium, which will be bound by
pyoverdin, resulting in increased contrast agent at the site of the
tumor. Administration of labeled gallium can be concurrent with, prior
to, or subsequent to, administration of the recombinant Vaccinia virus.
The tumors can then be visualized by any of the methods provided herein.
This method can be combined with any other method described herein.
[0385]In one non-limiting example, tumor tissues can be specifically
infected by intravenously injected eukaryotic cells recombinantly
engineered to express or over-express pyoverdin and/or its receptor (also
encoding single peptides for cell surface expression and secretion),
thereby supplementing the cells own iron uptake and storage and
increasing iron acquisition by the eukaryotic cells in the tumor
environment. The subject can be intravenously injected with labeled
gallium, which will be bound by pyoverdin, resulting in increased
contrast agent at the site of the tumor. Administration of labeled
gallium can be concurrent with, prior to, or subsequent to,
administration of the recombinant eukaryotic cells. The tumors can then
be visualized by any of the methods provided herein.
[0386]These methods can be combined with any other method described
herein. Additionally, any of the microorganisms and cells provided herein
can be used using methods described herein and known in the art to
increase metal acquisition for visualization, therapy or a combination
thereof.
[0387]ii. Other
[0388](a) Prokaryotic Cells
[0389](1) Acquisition of Exogenous Siderophores
[0390]The success of human pathogens such as Neisseria species, which do
not express their own siderophores can be attributed in part to the
efficient usation of multiple host iron (Fe) sources, allowing
replication on mucosal surfaces, in the bloodstream, and intracellularly.
[0391]While pathogenic Neisseria species do not excrete any detectable
siderophores themselves, they do express receptors that recognize
siderophores made by other microbes. Neisseria species use outer membrane
receptors to acquire iron. For example, outer membrane receptors that can
transport exogenous siderophores in Neisseria include, for example, FrpB,
HmbR, FetA, TdfF, TdfG and TdfH. Several proteins in Neisseria are
involved in transporting iron into the cell cytosol, such as the energy
transducing components, TonB which transfers energy to the outer membrane
receptors, and ExbB and ExbD, which stabilize TonB. Intracellularly,
FbpA, FbpB, FbpC, FetB and HemO bind ferrous iron or siderophores,
whereas BfrA and BfrB store iron and protect the bacteria from oxidative
stress (Rohde and Dyer (2003) Front Biosci. 8:d1186-218; Cornelissen C N
(2003) Frontiers in Bioscience 8: d836-d847; Clarke et al. (2001) Curr.
Top. Med. Chem. 1 (1):7-30).
[0392]Bacteria, such as Neisseria, can be used to label the tumor with
contrast agent. For example, tumor tissues can be specifically infected
by intravenously injected N. meningitis which will acquire iron through a
variety of mechanisms as described herein, thereby producing a contrast
agent that can be visualized using the methods described herein.
Additionally, iron can be administered to a tumor-bearing subject, either
alone, or in a conjugated form. An iron conjugate can include, for
example, iron conjugated to an imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In
some cases, the imaging moiety and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g.,
a radionuclide. Bacterial cell internalization of iron in the tumor
environment allows the internalization of iron alone, a supplemental
imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent (which in turn delivers
cytotoxicity specifically to the tumor cells). This method can be
combined with any of the other methods provided herein.
[0393]Bacteria, such as Neisseria, can also be recombinantly engineered to
over-express iron-acquiring mechanisms. ThpA-TbpB outer membrane receptor
proteins are only one of many examples of ligand-receptor pairs that can
be used. In one non-limiting example, tumor tissues can be specifically
infected by intravenously injected N. meningitis recombinantly engineered
to over-express ThpA-TbpB outer membrane receptor proteins. Increased
iron acquisition can result in, not only, increased contrast for
visualization and detection, but also iron depletion from the tumor
environment. Iron depletion from the tumor environment removes a vital
nutrient from the tumors, thereby dis-regulating iron hemostasis and
delaying tumor progression and/or killing the tumor. This method can be
combined with any of the other methods provided herein.
[0394]Bacteria other than Neisseria (e.g., E. coli Nissle 1917) can be
recombinantly engineered to over-express Neisseria iron-acquiring
mechanisms to complement their own iron-acquiring systems. Increased iron
acquisition can result in, not only, increased contrast for visualization
and detection, but also iron depletion from the tumor environment as
described herein. Additionally, iron can be administered to a
tumor-bearing subject, either alone, or in a conjugated form. An iron
conjugate can include, for example, iron conjugated to an imaging moiety
or a therapeutic agent. In some cases, the imaging moiety and therapeutic
agent are the same, e.g., a radionuclide. Bacterial cell internalization
of iron in the tumor environment allows the internalization of iron
alone, a supplemental imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent (which in
turn delivers cytotoxicity specifically to the tumor cells). These
methods can be combined with any of the other methods provided herein.
[0395](2) Acquisition from Host Carriers
[0396]In the absence of siderophores, Neisseria spp. are capable of iron
acquisition from host carriers via expression of cell surface receptors.
In response to conditions of low iron, bacteria have developed
capabilities for scavenging iron from host carriers/sources such as
lactoferrin, transferrin, hemoglobin and heme from host environments
(Rohde and Dyer(2003) Front Biosci. 8:d1186-218; Cornelissen C N. (2003)
Frontiers in Bioscience 8: d836-d847).
[0397]Exemplary bacteria including, but not limited to, Haemophilus
influenzae, Yersinia enterocolitica, Actinobacillus pleuropneumoniae,
Helicobacter pylori, Yersinia pestis, N. memingitidis, N. gonorrhoeae, E.
coli 0157, Bacteroides species, Pasteurellaceae species, Moraxellaceae
species and Serratia marcescens have developed outer membrane receptors
and/or ABC transport systems for removing iron from lactoferrin,
transferrin, hemoglobin and heme from host environments (Clarke et al.
(2001) Curr. Top. Med. Chem. 1:7-30).
[0398]Bacteria, such as Neisseria species, for example, express
transferrin (Tf) and lactoferrin (Lf) receptors (TfR and LfR,
respectively). The transferrin and lactoferrin receptor proteins are
located in the outer membrane and are induced by iron starvation. Unlike
other TonB-dependent receptors where ferric-siderophores are wholly
internalized, the bacterial transferrin receptor must remove iron from
transferrin at the cell surface (Cornelissen C N. (2003) Front Biosci. 8:
d836-847). Iron is removed from host carrier at the bacterial cell
surface and transported across the cell membrane for storage in ferritin
molecules. The receptors are composed of two dissimilar proteins: Tbp1
and Thp2 (also designated ThpA and ThpA, respectively) for the
transferrin receptor and Lbp1 and Lbp2 (also designated LbpA and LbpA,
respectively) for lactoferrin. Thp2 and Lbp2 are homologous, but not
related to outer membrane siderophore receptors and Thp1 and Lbp1 have an
affinity for transferrin and lactoferrin, respectively. Uptake of
Fe.sup.+3 scavenged from transferrin and lactoferrin is TonB-ExB-ExbD-
and Pmf-dependent. Iron is then transported across the periplasm and
cytosolic membrane by a periplasmic binding protein ABC permease system.
Fbp has been shown to be the periplasmic binding protein for N.
gonorrhoeae and H. influenzae.
[0399]A representative sampling of receptors that acquire iron from host
environments is provided in Table 6.
TABLE-US-00006
TABLE 6
Receptor and transport proteins for acquisition of host iron
Iron Source Bacteria Protein Function
Transferrin, H. influenzae LbpAB Lf OM receptor
lactoferrin TbpAB Tf OM receptor
HitABC Fe.sup.+3 ABC transport system
Neisseria spp. LbpAB Lf OM receptor
TbpAB Tf OM receptor
FbpABC Fe.sup.+3 ABC transport system
Lactoferrin Y. enterocolitica Yfu Fe.sup.+3 ABC transport system
A. pleuropneumoniae Afu Fe.sup.+3 ABC transport system
H. pylori ABC transport system
Heme E. coli O157 ChuA Heme OM receptor
Neisseria spp. HmgR Heme/Hb OM receptor
HpuAB Heme/Hb OM receptor
S. marcescens SfuABC Fe.sup.+3 ABC transport system
S. dysenteriae ShuA Heme OM receptor
V. cholerae
Y. enterocolitica HemPRSTUV
Hemoglobin N. gonorrhoeae HpuAB Heme/Hb OM receptor
N. memingitidis HmbR Heme/Hb OM receptor
P. aeruginosa PhuR Heme/Hb OM receptor
PhuSTUVW Heme ABC transport system
HasRADEF Heme receptor, hemophore,
ABC transporter for HasA export
Reduced iron E. coli FeoAB Fe.sup.+2 transport
P. aeruginosa
Streptococcus spp.
Data from Clarke et al. (2001) Curr. Top. Med. Chem. 1: 7-30 and Andrews
et al. (2003) FEMS Microbiol. Rev. 27(2-3): 215-237. OM: outer membrane.
[0400]Some extracellular Gram-negative bacteria, including, but not
limited to Bacteroides fragilis, have an absolute requirement for
exogenous supply of heme, or its precursor, protoporphyrin IX. Bacteria
use hemolysins and proteases to release heme and hemoglobin from red
blood cells. The heme and hemoglobin can then directly transported by
bacteria. Gram-negative bacteria use outer membrane receptors to bind
heme, hemoglobin or heme complexes, and transport the heme group across
the outer membrane in a TonB-ExB-ExbD-dependent similar to iron acquired
from lactoferrin and transferrin. Transportation of heme across the
cytosolic membrane requires an ABC permease, but does not require a
periplasmic binding protein. Once in the cytoplasm, the heme is degraded
to release the iron, which is then stored in ferritin molecules (Andrews
et al. (2003) FEMS Microbiol. Rev. 27:215-237; Genco and Dixon (2001)
Mol. Microbiol. 39:1-11).
[0401]Bacteria, such as N. gonorrhoeae, for example, can be transformed
with one or more high copy plasmid(s) recombinantly engineered with the
genes encoding an outer membrane protein that can recognize iron bound to
a host carrier. In one embodiment, N. gonorrhoeae is transformed with one
or more high copy plasmid(s) having the genes encoding Thp1 and Thp1. In
another embodiment, a mixture of bacterial species from families such as,
for example, Neisseriaceae, Pasteurellaceae and Moraxellaceae, can be
transformed as described herein.
[0402]In a further embodiment, N. gonorrhoeae can be recombinantly
engineered to express or over-express one or more siderophores
(endogenous or exogenous) and/or one or more outer membrane proteins or
transport proteins as described elsewhere herein to increase iron
acquisition and transport of iron.
[0403]In a further embodiment, N. meningitidis can be transformed with one
or more high copy plasmids having genes encoding one or more
ferritin-like molecules that are endogenous and/or exogenous to the
bacteria. For example, N. meningitidis can be transformed with high copy
plasmids having genes encoding a bacterioferritin, a bacterial ferritin,
a dodecameric ferritin and/or high copy plasmids having genes encoding
the eukaryotic H chain, L chain, or H and L chains.
[0404]Tumor tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously injected
N. gonorrhoeae recombinantly engineered as described herein. Increased
iron uptake and/or storage can result in, not only, increased contrast
for visualization and detection, but also iron depletion from the tumor
environment. Iron depletion from the tumor environment removes a vital
nutrient from the tumors, thereby dis-regulating iron hemostasis and
delaying tumor progression and/or killing the tumor.
[0405]Alternatively, bacteria (other than Neisseria) can be recombinantly
engineered to over-express iron-acquiring mechanisms from other bacteria,
such as Neisseria, to complement their own iron-acquiring systems.
Increased iron acquisition can result in, not only, increased contrast
for visualization and detection, but also iron depletion from the tumor
environment as described herein.
[0406]For example, E. coli strains can be recombinantly engineered to
express one or more proteins that scavenge iron from host proteins. In
one non-limiting embodiment, tumor tissues can be specifically infected
by intravenously injected E. coli Nissle 1917 recombinantly engineered to
express or over-express ChuA heme outer membrane receptor (SEQ ID NO:71),
the LbpAB lactoferrin outer membrane receptor proteins, the Yfu Fe.sup.+3
ABC transport system, or a combination thereof. Increased iron
acquisition can result in, not only, increased contrast for visualization
and detection, but also iron depletion from the tumor environment.
Additionally, iron can be administered to a tumor-bearing subject, either
alone, or in a conjugated form. An iron conjugate can include, for
example, iron conjugated to an imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In
some cases, the imaging moiety and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g.,
a radionuclide. Bacterial cell internalization of iron in the tumor
environment allows the internalization of iron alone, a supplemental
imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent (which in turn delivers
cytotoxicity specifically to the tumor cells).
[0407]Alternatively, any of the bacteria provided herein can be
recombinantly engineered to express or over-express eukaryotic
iron-acquiring mechanisms as described below. For example, bacteria can
be recombinantly engineered to express or overexpress the gene(s)
encoding the lactoferrin receptor. Exemplary bacteria including, but not
limited to, E. coli Nissle 1917 recombinantly engineered to express or
overexpress the gene(s) encoding the lactoferrin receptor. Tumor tissues
can be specifically infected by intravenously injected such recombinant
E. coli Nissle 1917 bacteria. Increased iron acquisition can result in,
not only, increased contrast for visualization and detection, but also
iron depletion from tumor cells and/or the tumor environment.
Additionally, iron can be administered to a tumor-bearing subject, either
alone, or in a conjugated form. An iron conjugate can include, for
example, iron conjugated to an imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In
some cases, the imaging moiety and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g.,
a radionuclide. Bacterial cell internalization of iron in the tumor
environment allows the internalization of iron alone, a supplemental
imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent.
[0408]This method can be combined with any other method described herein,
such as systemically injecting labeled gallium, such as .sup.67Ga, for
tumors infected with bacteria expressing or over-expressing pyoverdin,
resulting in increased contrast agent at the site of the tumor. These
methods can be combined with any of the other methods provided herein.
[0409](b) Eukaryotic Cells
[0410]The processes of iron uptake and distribution are highly regulated
in mammalian cells. Expression of the transferrin and lactoferrin
receptors are increased when cells are iron-depleted, while expression of
the iron sequestration protein, ferritin, is increased in cells that are
iron-replete. Regulation of expression of proteins of iron uptake
(transferrin and lactoferrin receptors) and iron sequestration (ferritin)
ensures that levels of reactive free iron are not toxic in cells (Rouault
and Klausner (1996) EXS. 77:183-197).
[0411]Solubilization of ferric iron in mammalian cells occurs through
binding of iron to the iron carrier proteins transferrin and lactoferrin.
Each transferrin can bind two ferric ions and transport it through
circulation, where it eventually binds to a transferrin receptor.
Transferrin receptors are 90 kDa homodimers present on plasma membranes
of eukaryotic cells. When bound with ligand, the receptor-ligand complex
is internalized and iron released to the cell cytosol, where it is used
in cellular processes or stored in ferritins (Rouault and Klausner (1997)
Curr. Top. Cell. Reg. 35:1-19). 9 L gliosarcoma cells have been
transfected with engineered transferrin receptor that lacked the
iron-regulating region and mRNA destabilization motifs in the 3'
untranslated region resulting in high level expression of constitutive
transferrin receptor at the cell surface (Weissleder et al. (2000) Nature
Medicine 6(3):351-354).
[0412]Lactoferrin receptors (LfRs) have been identified on various types
of mammalian cells such as lymphocytes, hepatocytes and enterocytes. The
entire coding region of the human intestinal LfR (HLfR) has been cloned
by polymerase chain reaction (PCR), a recombinant HLfR (rHLfR) was
expressed in a baculovirus system, and retained the capacity to bind HLf
(Suzuki and Lonnerdal (2002) Biochem Cell Biol. 80(1):75-80).
[0413]Encompassed herein are diagnostic and therapeutic methods using
eukaryotic cells recombinantly engineered to over-express receptors for
host proteins that carry iron, such as transferrin, lactoferrin and heme.
Eukaryotic cells include cells from multicellular eukaryotes, including
mammals such as primates, where exemplary cells are human cells.
Typically the cells are isolated cells. For example, eukaryotic cells can
be fibrosarcoma cells or stem cells.
[0414]Eukaryotic cells can be recombinantly engineered to express or
over-express genes encoding the Thp1 and Thp2 proteins, the Lbp1 and Lbp2
proteins, or a combination thereof. Optionally, eukaryotic cells can be
further recombinantly engineered with any of the other receptors
described herein. Tumor tissues can be specifically infected by
intravenously injected eukaryotic cells recombinantly engineered as
described herein. Increased iron uptake and/or storage can result in, not
only, increased contrast for visualization and detection, but also iron
depletion from the tumor environment. Iron depletion from the tumor
environment removes a vital nutrient from the tumors, thereby
dis-regulating iron hemostasis and delaying tumor progression and/or
killing the tumor.
[0415]This method can be combined with any other method described herein,
such as systemically injecting labeled gallium, such as .sup.67Ga, for
tumors infected with bacteria expressing or over-expressing pyoverdin,
resulting in increased contrast agent at the site of the tumor. These
methods can be combined with any of the other methods provided herein.
[0416](c) Viruses
[0417]Viruses (such as Vaccinia virus) can also be used to label the tumor
cell surface with receptor proteins. For example, the tumor tissues can
be specifically infected by intravenously injected engineered Vaccinia
virus carrying, e.g., a transferrin receptor gene (also encoding a signal
peptide for cell surface expression). Expression of the transferrin
receptor on the tumor cell surface will mark these cells for targeting by
diagnostic or therapeutic-ligand fusion proteins. In this case, the
ligand is the transferrin protein, and the therapeutic protein could be a
Pseudomonas exotoxin (or any other cytotoxic therapeutic proteins) and
the diagnostic protein can be iron, gold, gadolinium or gallium. Tumor
cell internalization of the transferrin/transferrin receptor pair allows
the internalization of the therapeutic protein, which in turn delivers
the diagnostic or therapeutic protein specifically to the tumor cells.
The transferrin-transferrin receptor pair is only one of many examples of
ligand-receptor pairs that can be used. In addition, other
ligand-receptor pairs as described above can be used in any of methods
provided herein. These methods can be combined with any of the other
methods provided herein. Exemplary viruses provided herein that express a
transferrin receptor include GLV-1h22 and GLV-1h82.
[0418]In another embodiment, a virus (such as Vaccinia virus) can be
recombinantly engineered to express eukaryotic or prokaryotic
iron-acquiring mechanisms. For example, bacteria can be transformed with
high copy plasmids having genes encoding the Tbp1 and Thp2 proteins, the
Lbp1 and Lbp2 proteins, or a combination thereof. Tumor tissues can be
specifically infected by intravenously injected viruses recombinantly
engineered as described herein. Increased iron acquisition can result in,
not only, increased contrast for visualization and detection, but also
iron depletion from the tumor environment. Additionally, iron can be
administered to a tumor-bearing subject, either alone, or in a conjugated
form. An iron conjugate can include, for example, iron conjugated to an
imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In some cases, the imaging moiety
and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g., a radionuclide. Bacterial cell
internalization of iron in the tumor environment allows the
internalization of iron alone, a supplemental imaging moiety or a
therapeutic agent (which in turn delivers cytotoxicity specifically to
the tumor cells). These methods can be combined with any of the other
methods provided herein.
[0419]c. Iron Regulation
[0420]Nearly every microorganism or cell needs iron for growth and
metabolism. The ability of pathogens to obtain iron from transferring,
hemoglobin, etc., is important for survival. Iron bound to lactoferrin
and transferrin is much less accessible than soluble iron. Therefore,
pathogens use specific mechanisms for iron acquisition from their host.
Iron storage and use is tightly regulated in cells to ensure that iron
supplies are adequate and non-toxic.
[0421]i. Prokaryotic Cells
[0422]Iron homeostasis in prokaryotic cells is regulated at the level of
the genome by proteins that are sensitive to iron levels. Many
siderophores and ferritins are regulated by the repressor Fur (Rouault
and Klausner (1997) Curr. Top. Cell. Reg. 35:1-19; Braun (2003) Front
Biosci 1(8s): 1409-1421)
[0423](a) Gram-Negative Bacteria
[0424]Iron homeostasis in Gram-negative bacteria is essentially regulated
at the level of the genome by the Fur protein. When iron is in short
supply the uptake and assimilation pathways are de-repressed and
siderophores are synthesized together with the outer, inner (plasma)
membrane, periplasmic and cytosolic components necessary for the uptake
of ferri-siderophores. Siderophores bring iron to the cell to be
internalized and stored in ferritin-like molecules.
[0425]The product of the fur gene (i.e., Fur) exists as an intracellular
iron regulator. During states of high iron levels, Fur complexes with
ferrous irons and Fur-Fe.sup.+2 complexes transcriptionally repress
iron-regulated promoters of genes that act to code for siderophores or
membrane proteins that uptake iron-siderophore complexes. Fur-Fe.sup.+2
complexes also activate genes for bacterial ferritin and/or
bacterioferritin synthesis, thereby causing removal of excess ferrous
(Fe+3) ions from the cytosol. Thus, there is a feedback loop that is
dependent upon iron levels (J L Smith (2004) Crit. Rev. in Microbiol.
30:173-185, Wandersman and Delepelaire (2004) Annu. Rev. Microbiol.
58:611-647). When iron is not limiting, the Fe+2-Fur complex acts as a
transcriptional repressor, and shuts down the synthesis of all the
components of iron assimilation (Crichton and Ward (1995) Analyst.
120(3):693-697).
[0426]The DNA-binding regions of the Fur protein have been identified in
E. coli as a 19 base pair consensus sequence
(5'-TGATAATGATAATCATTATCA-3'; SEQ ID NO:46; Baichoo and Helmann (2002) J.
Bacteriol., 184(21):5826-32) that is found in the promoter region of
genes that are negatively and positively regulated by iron. Similar
sequences have been found in the promoter genes of iron-regulated genes
from organisms other than E. coli (Crichton and Ward (1995) Analyst
120:693-697).
[0427]Although fur mutants have been shown to have very low iron contents
(2.5-fold less iron than Fur+ strains) despite constitutive expression of
the iron acquisition systems (Abdul-Tehrani et al. (1999) J. Bacteriol.
181(5):1415-1428), it is possible to increase the iron storage-capacity
of bacteria, in the absence of Fur, by over-expressing ferritin-like
proteins. For example, provision of the H. pylori pfr gene on a
multi-copy plasmid resulted in reversal of the Fur-mediated repression of
the fhuF gene in E. coli (Bereswill et al. (1998) Microbiology. 144 (Pt
9):2505-2516).
[0428]Any of the Gram-negative bacteria provided herein can be
recombinantly engineered to remove transcriptional iron-repression using
methods known in the art. In one non-limiting example, the fur gene can
be inactivated by replacing all or some of the fur consensus sequence
with disrupted derivatives containing antibiotic resistance cassettes. In
another example, the fur gene can be inactivated by creating disrupted
derivatives containing antibiotic resistance cassettes in place of
internal segments of the corresponding coding regions. These methods can
be included with any of the other methods provided herein to
recombinantly engineer Gram-negative bacteria to express one or more of
siderophores, outer membrane proteins, transport proteins, ferritins, or
a combination thereof, thereby increasing the ability of the
Gram-negative bacteria to acquire iron.
[0429]For example, Gram-negative bacteria can be transformed with multiple
high copy plasmids having genes encoding one or more ferritin-like
molecules that are endogenous and/or exogenous to the bacteria. In one
aspect, E. coli Nissle 1917 can be transformed with high copy plasmids
having genes encoding bacterioferritin and/or high copy plasmids having
genes encoding the eukaryotic H chain.
[0430]In a further embodiment, bacteria can be recombinantly engineered to
express or over-express one or more siderophores (endogenous or
exogenous) and/or one or more outer membrane proteins or transport
proteins as described elsewhere to increase iron acquisition and
transport of iron. In addition, or alternatively, bacteria can be
recombinantly engineered such that one or more genes are inactivated or
deleted including, but not limited to, genes encoding siderophore
biosynthetic enzymes, iron-repression genes, or a combination thereof.
[0431]Tumor tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously injected
E. coli recombinantly engineered as described herein. Increased iron
uptake and/or storage can result in, not only, increased contrast for
visualization and detection, but also iron depletion from the tumor
environment. Iron depletion from the tumor environment removes a vital
nutrient from the tumors, thereby dis-regulating iron hemostasis in tumor
cells and delaying tumor progression and/or killing the tumor.
Additionally, iron can be administered to a tumor-bearing subject, either
alone, or in a conjugated form. An iron conjugate can include, for
example, iron conjugated to an imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In
some cases, the imaging moiety and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g.,
a radionuclide. Bacterial cell internalization of iron in the tumor
environment allows the internalization of iron alone, a supplemental
imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent (which in turn delivers
cytotoxicity specifically to the tumor cells).
[0432](b) Gram-Positive Bacteria
[0433]Gram positive bacteria also regulate iron metabolism using
repressors in an iron-dependent manner.
[0434]The protein that regulates iron metabolism in C. diphtheriae,
diphtheria toxin repressor (DtxR) protein, is a functional equivalent of
the Fur repressor of Gram-negative bacteria in that it uses Fe.sup.+2 as
a co-repressor; however, it is structurally different. DtxR does not bind
to operator sequences recognized by Fur. The active form is a dimer that
recognizes a palindromic DNA sequence about the operator for the tox
gene. DtxR-like proteins have been found in other Gram-positive bacteria,
such as Streptomyces spp., B. subtilis, B. lactofermentum, S. epidermidis
and M. smegmatis.
[0435]In Mycobacterium species, an iron-dependent regulator (IdeR) is a
DtxR homolog; inactivation of the ideR gene in M. smegmatis depresses
siderophore biosynthesis (Ratledge and Dover (2000) Annu. Rev. Microbiol.
54:881-941; U.S. Pat. No. 5,554,507).
[0436]In S. aureus and S. epidermidis, SirR is a metal dependent repressor
that is homologous to C. diphtheriae DtxR. The open reading frame (ORF)
of SirR sits upstream of the sitABC operon, and is divergently
transcribed (Hill et al. (1998) Infect Immun. 66(9):4123-4129).
[0437]Bacteria, such as C. diphtheriae, for example, can be recombinantly
engineered to inactivate expression of DtxR, such as by insertion of
non-sense sequences by homologous recombination. The bacteria also can be
transformed with a high copy plasmid with genes encoding ferritin-like
compounds. For example, C. diphtheriae can be transformed with high copy
plasmids having genes encoding bacterial ferritin. These methods can be
included with any of the other methods provided herein to recombinantly
engineer Gram-positive bacteria to express one or more of siderophores,
outer membrane proteins, transport proteins, ferritins, or a combination
thereof, thereby increasing the ability of the Gram-positive bacteria to
acquire iron.
[0438]For example, Gram-positive bacteria can be transformed with multiple
high copy plasmids having genes encoding one or more ferritin-like
molecules that are endogenous and/or exogenous to the bacteria. In one
aspect, C. diphtheriae can be transformed with high copy plasmids having
genes encoding bacterioferritin and/or high copy plasmids having genes
encoding the eukaryotic H chain.
[0439]In a further embodiment, bacteria can be recombinantly engineered to
express or over-express one or more siderophores (endogenous or
exogenous) and/or one or more outer membrane proteins or transport
proteins as described elsewhere to increase iron acquisition and
transport of iron.
[0440]Tumor tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously injected
C. diphtheriae recombinantly engineered as described herein. Increased
iron uptake and/or storage can result in, not only, increased contrast
for visualization and detection, but also iron depletion from the tumor
environment. Iron depletion from the tumor environment removes a vital
nutrient from the tumors, thereby dis-regulating iron hemostasis in tumor
cells and delaying tumor progression and/or killing the tumor.
Additionally, iron can be administered to a tumor-bearing subject, either
alone, or in a conjugated form. An iron conjugate can include, for
example, iron conjugated to an imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In
some cases, the imaging moiety and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g.,
a radionuclide. Bacterial cell internalization of iron in the tumor
environment allows the internalization of iron alone, a supplemental
imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent (which in turn delivers
cytotoxicity specifically to the tumor cells).
[0441]ii. Eukaryotic Cells
[0442]Iron metabolism in eukaryotic cells is regulated primarily by
post-transcriptional regulation of ferritin and the transferrin receptor
at the level of mRNA stability. Levels of intracellular iron are directly
sensed by two iron sensing proteins. Iron regulatory protein 1 (IRP1) is
a bi-functional protein; in cells that are iron-replete, IRP1 contains an
iron-sulfur cluster and functions as cytosolic aconitase. In cells that
are iron-depleted, IRP1 binds stem-loop structures in mRNA transcripts of
the ferritin heavy and light chains and the mammalian transferrin
receptor known as iron responsive elements (IREs). Iron regulatory
protein 2 (IRP2) binds similar stem-loop structures, but the mode of
regulation of IRP2 is different in that IRP2 is rapidly degraded in
iron-replete cells (Rouault and Klausner (1996) EXS. 77:183-197; Crichton
and Ward (1995) Analyst 120:693-697; Rouault and Klausner (1997) Curr.
Top. Cell. Regul. 35:1-19; M. Kozak (1992) Annu. Rev. Cell Biol.
8:197-225; Aziz and Munro (1987) PNAS USA 84:8478-8482).
[0443]Iron homeostasis is dependent upon the iron regulatory factor (IRF),
a cytoplasmic protein that can bind to specific stem loops, iron
responsive elements (IREs) on the messenger ribonucleic acid molecules
(mRNAs) of proteins involved in iron storage (ferritin), usation
(erythroid delta-aminolaevulinate synthase, AIS), and uptake (transferrin
receptor). During iron depletion, the IRE exists in a high affinity form,
which, by binding strongly to the corresponding mRNAs, down-regulates
iron storage and usation, while up-regulating transferrin receptor
expression. When the cells are iron replete, IRF-binding to IREs is weak,
allowing transferrin receptor mRNA to be degraded. Under physiological
conditions of iron overload and depletion, IRF functions in vivo in the
manner already described for in vitro models (Crichton and Ward (1995)
Analyst. 120(3):693-697).
[0444]Eukaryotic cells can be transformed with a plasmid/vector containing
a gene for a ferritin molecule. For example, eukaryotic cells can be
transduced with adenoviral vectors containing transgenes for the heavy
and light ferritin subunits, thereby causing the cells to internalize and
store iron. When injected into mice brains, the heavy and light chains of
ferritin encoded by the recombinant adenovirus efficiently loaded iron
and were visualized by MRI. Thus, the recombinant ferritin was an
intrinsic source of MRI contrast agent (Genove et al. (2005) Nature
Medicine 11(4):450-454). In another example, over-expression of ferritin
H-chain in C6 rat glioma cells increased cellular iron content in vitro
and significantly increased MRI relaxation rates, both in vitro and in
vivo without altering tumor growth. Over-expression of ferritin caused
re-distribution of intracellular ferritin iron and chelation of
intracellular free iron, thereby generating MRI contrast in vivo. In
response, transferrin receptor expression increased and increased iron
uptake, thereby increasing additional contrast (Cohen et al. (2005)
Neoplasia 7(2):109-117).
[0445]Eukaryotic cells can be recombinantly engineered to express or
over-express genes encoding H chains, L chains, transferrin receptor or a
combination thereof. Tumor tissues can be specifically infected by
intravenously injected eukaryotic cells recombinantly engineered as
described herein. Increased iron uptake and/or storage can result in, not
only, increased contrast for visualization and detection, but also iron
depletion from the tumor environment. Iron depletion from the tumor
environment removes a vital nutrient from the tumors, thereby
dis-regulating iron hemostasis in tumor cells and delaying tumor
progression and/or killing the tumor. Additionally, iron can be
administered to a tumor-bearing subject, either alone, or in a conjugated
form. An iron conjugate can include, for example, iron conjugated to an
imaging moiety or a therapeutic agent. In some cases, the imaging moiety
and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g., a radionuclide. Eukaryotic cell
internalization of iron in the tumor environment allows the
internalization of iron alone, a supplemental imaging moiety or a
therapeutic agent (which in turn delivers cytotoxicity specifically to
the tumor cells).
[0446]2. Ligand Binding
[0447]a. Therapeutic Agents
[0448]The microorganisms and cells provided herein can bind a ligand, such
as, a siderophore, a peptide, a protein, an antibody or a nanoparticle
that has been conjugated to a therapeutic agent or a detectable moiety.
The ligand can bind to an endogenous or exogenous protein or peptide
(e.g., a siderophore receptor), or a recombinant molecule (e.g., OmpA
with a peptide inserted in one of the outer loops). The ligand can be
conjugated to a detectable moiety or a therapeutic agent. A mixture of
ligands conjugated to one or more detectable moieties, one or more
therapeutic agents, or a combination thereof is provided herein.
[0449]Exemplary therapeutic agents include, for example, cytokines and
growth factors, photosensitizing agents, toxins, anti-cancer antibiotics,
chemotherapeutic compounds, radionuclides, angiogenesis inhibitors,
sugar-containing compounds, signaling modulators, anti-cancer antibodies,
or a combination thereof. Examples of therapeutic agents are provided
elsewhere herein.
[0450]Antibodies immunoreactive with tumor-associated antigens have been
shown to home specifically to tumorous tissue compared to non-tumorous
tissue. For example, a monoclonal antibody specific for the human
epidermal growth factor receptor type 2 (HER2), Trastuzumab (Herceptin)
is a standard therapeutic option for treatment of metastatic breast
cancers (Emens and Davidson (2004) Oncology 18(9):1117-28). The use of
such antibodies, either alone, or coupled with an anti-cancer agent, is
well-known in the art. In one instance, antibodies immunoreactive with
the her2 receptor blocked intracellular signaling and had anti-tumor
effects when administered alone, or with chemotherapy (Bianco A R (2004)
J. Chemother. 16 (Suppl 4):52-54).
[0451]b. Detectable Moieties
[0452]Detectable moieties and imaging moieties refer to moieties used to
image an microorganism or cell in any of the methods provided herein,
such as, for example, detectable labels, or bindable moieties such as
bindable compounds. Detectable moieties and imaging moieties include, for
example, bioluminescent moieties, fluorescent moieties, a
chemiluminescent moieties, radionuclides, magnetically detectable
isotopes or compounds, sonographic imaging agents, chromophores, latex
microspheres, quantum dots, chemiluminescent moieties, bioluminescent
moieties, and metals, such as a colloidal metal, silica-encapsulated
fluorescent dyes, gold nanoparticles (nanoshells) or any other moiety
that can be used for detection by methods provided herein. Exemplary
luminescent proteins, include, but are not limited to genes encoding
light-emitting proteins (or derivatives or analogs thereof) including
genes from bacterial luciferase from Vibrio harveyi or Vibrio fischerii,
Photorhabdus luminescens, firefly luciferase, click beetle luciferase
aequorin from Aequorea victoria, and Renilla luciferase from Renilla
renformis. Exemplary fluorescent proteins, include, but are not limited
to mutants or variants of green fluorescent protein (GFP) from Aequorea
victoria (Prasher et al. (1987) Gene 111:229-233) or Renilla sea pansy,
and other sea anemone and coral species, and variants thereof, including
yellow fluorescent protein (YFP), orange fluorescent protein (OFP), cyan
fluorescent protein (CFP), and blue fluorescent protein (BFP), red
fluorescent protein (RFP) and far-red fluorescent protein from the
corallimorph Discosoma (Matz et al. (1999) Nature Biotechnology
17:969-973), Heteractis reef coral and other sea anemone and coral
species, as well as variants thereof, including DsRed2 (Clontech, Palo
Alto, Calif.), DsRed-T1 (Bevis and Glick (2002) Nat. Biotechnol.
20:83-87), mPlum (Wang et al. (2004) PNAS USA. 101(48):16745-9), HcRed1
and t-HcRed (Clontech, Palo Alto, Calif.), and near-infrared fluorescent
proteins. Exemplary chemiluminescent moieties include, for example,
luminol, isoluminol, acridinium esters, thioesters and sulfonamides, and
phenanthridinium esters.
[0453]c. Targeting of Peptides
[0454]Peptides can be used as ligands to image or treat tumors using any
of the methods provided herein. Targeting of peptides to specific tumor
blood vessels, tissues and organs is well-known in the art. In one
instance, a short fusion peptide having a tumor blood vessel "homing"
motif and a programmed cell-death-inducing sequence guided the peptide to
the targeted cells and had anti-cancer activity in mice (Ellerby et al.
(1999) Nat. Med. 5(9): 1032-1038; Pasqualini and Ruoslahti (1996) Nature
380:364-366). Phages that display a surface peptide with a NGR sequence
motif coupled to a drug have been shown to home to tumor vasculature in
vivo and have anti-tumor effects (Arap et al. (1998) Science 279:377-380;
Pasqualini et al. (2000) Cancer Res. 60:722-727). Other phages carrying
lung-specific peptides, fragments of the HMGN2 protein, and peptides of
angiogenesis-related markers specific to blood vessels of tumors have
also been identified (Laakkonen et al. (2002) Nature Medicine
8(7):751-755; Porkka et al. (2002) PNAS 99(11):7444-7449; Rajotte and
Ruoslahti (1999) J. Biol. Chem. 274(17):11593-11598).
[0455]Generally, when bacterial outer membrane proteins are used for
display of heterologous peptides or proteins, it is achieved through
genetic insertion into permissive sites of the carrier proteins. A
streptavidin peptide ligand has been displayed in the E. coli strain
MC1061 outer membrane protein A (OmpA) using bacterial display
methodology as described above. Other peptides of 15-514 amino acids have
been displayed in the second, third, and fourth outer loops on the
surface of OmpA as described above. Thus, outer membrane proteins can
carry and display heterologous gene products on the outer surface of
bacteria.
[0456]Bacteria can be recombinantly engineered to express a peptide
ligand, such as, for example, on an outer membrane protein on the cell
surface. The bacteria can be transformed with a plasmid carrying genes
encoding recombinant cell surface molecules, such as, but not limited to,
an outer membrane protein with a peptide ligand inserted in a permissible
site. Such techniques are known to one of skill in the art.
[0457]For example, E. coli Nissle 1917 can be transformed with plasmids
carrying genes encoding OmpA with a streptavidin binding peptide
(SA-B/OmpA) or a S-peptide (SPep/OmpA) as described in the Examples.
[0458]In another embodiment, E. coli Nissle 1917 can be transformed with
plasmids carrying genes encoding the her2/neu receptor.
[0459]A mixture of E. coli Nissle 1917 carrying a combination of genes can
be prepared using methods known in the art and provided herein, such as
by transforming bacteria with plasmids. The plasmids can be, for example,
high copy plasmids which cause over-expression of the recombinant
polypeptide of interest.
[0460]Eukaryotic cells can be recombinantly engineered to express a
peptide ligand, such as, for example, on an outer membrane protein on the
cell surface. The eukaryotic cells can be transfected with genes encoding
recombinant cell surface molecules, such as, but not limited to, a
membrane protein with a peptide ligand inserted in a permissible site.
Such techniques are known to one of skill in the art.
[0461]Viruses can be recombinantly engineered to carry genes encoding a
membrane protein with a peptide ligand inserted in the sequence to be
expressed on the surface of infected tumor cells and/or part of the viral
envelope. Such techniques are known to one of skill in the art.
[0462]Tumor tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously injected
microorganisms and cells recombinantly engineered using any of the
methods provided herein. Concomitant with, or subsequent to, injection of
the recombinant microorganism, the corresponding ligand conjugated to a
detectable moiety, a therapeutic agent or a mixture thereof can be
injected. For example, concomitant with, or subsequent to, injection of
the recombinant microorganism or cell carrying genes for a streptavidin
binding peptide or a S-peptide, the ligand for each peptide can be
intravenously injected. In another example, concomitant with, or
subsequent to, injection of the recombinant microorganism or cell
carrying genes for the her2/neu receptor, Herceptin.RTM. can be
intravenously injected.
[0463]In some cases, the detectable moiety and therapeutic agent are the
same, e.g., a radionuclide. In one embodiment, imaging is conducted using
a radionuclide at a detectable concentration, a tumor is imaged, and
therapy is conducted by administering a radionuclide at a therapeutic
concentration. Homing of the ligand to the microorganism or tumor cell
surface allows for selective imaging and/or therapy of the tumors. The
diagnostic agent can be optimized for use in any of the imaging methods
provided herein. The therapeutic agent can prevent progression of tumor
development or kill the tumor cells. The method allows for combination
diagnosis and therapy of the tumor using the same recombinantly
engineered microorganism.
[0464]d. Targeting of Nanostructures
[0465]Nanostructures that interface with biological systems have attracted
widespread interest in biology and medicine. Nanoparticles are small
particles with a diameter of no more than 500 nm can be used for both
diagnostic and therapeutic purposes. Successful nanoparticle delivery
includes the ability to target specific tissues and cell types. The
nanoparticles can, for example, carry substances for MRI imaging and be
used as MRI contrast agents. Bimodal nanoparticles carrying a
near-infrared optically-detectable fluorochrome conjugated to an MRI
contrast agent have been used for imaging tumors. By coupling specific
ligands, nanoparticles can be made microorganism-, tissue- and/or
cancer-specific.
[0466]Tumor targeting/replicating bacteria and eukaryotic cells can be
used to display specific ligands on their surface to attract and bind
nanoparticles. Tumor targeting/replicating viruses can be used to display
specific ligands on the surface of tumor cells to attract and bind
nanoparticles. Nanoparticles can be coated with a multitude of ligands,
such as, but not limited to, peptides, proteins, antibodies, or fusion
products (i.e., conjugates) thereof. This binding can lead to enhanced
diagnostic signals and can be used for tumor therapy.
[0467]i. Nanoparticle-Peptide/Protein Conjugates
[0468]Nanoparticles are inorganic nanostructures that have therapeutic and
diagnostic purposes. One type of nanoparticle is semiconductor quantum
dots (qdots), which are small (<10 nm) inorganic nanocrystals
possessing fluorescent properties. Peptides that home to vascular markers
(e.g., tumor vasculature) have been coated onto qdots using a
thiol-exchange reaction, and the coupled qdots have been shown to target
tumor vasculature over non-tumor vasculature when injected intravenously
into mice. The qdots can be co-coupled with a substance, such as
polyethylene glycol (PEG), that reduces aggregation of the qdots, helps
maintain solubility in aqueous solvents and minimizes non-specific
binding ({acute over (.ANG.)}kerman et al. (2002) PNAS 99(20):
12617-12621).
[0469]Targeting of peptides to specific tumor blood vessels, tissues and
organs is well-known in the art as described above.
[0470]Bacteria and eukaryotic cells can be recombinantly engineered to
express a peptide ligand on the cell surface. The peptide ligand can be
recombinantly engineered as a fusion protein, wherein the peptide ligand
is fused to a protein that is expressed on the surface of the cell. The
bacteria can be transformed with a plasmid carrying genes that encode the
peptide ligand or peptide ligand fusion protein such that the genes
remain on the plasmid or are genomically integrated. An non-limiting
example of a cell surface molecule that can be used to engineer a
recombinant molecule is an outer membrane protein. The sequence encoding
the peptide ligand can be inserted at either end of the sequence encoding
the cell surface molecule or within the sequence encoding the cell
surface molecule. For example, E. coli Nissle 1917 can be transformed
with plasmids carrying genes encoding OmpA with a streptavidin binding
peptide (SEQ ID NOS.:5-7; SA-B/OmpA) or a S-peptide (SEQ ID NO:64;
SPep/OmpA) on one of the extracellular outer loops of the protein using
methods known in the art and as described in the Examples. A mixture of
bacteria expressing both peptides can be prepared. Exemplary Spep
sequences include, but are not limited to SEQ ID NOS:43 and 48.
[0471]The plasmids can be, for example, plasmids which cause
over-expression of the recombinant polypeptide of interest via strong
promoters. Genes that are integrated into the microbial chromosome can be
placed under the control of a strong promoter such that genes of interest
are over-expressed. One of skill in the art could select a promoter based
on the level of expression desired for a particular gene.
[0472]For example, eukaryotic cells can be transfected with genes a
encoding membrane protein with a streptavidin binding peptide or a
S-peptide inserted into a permissible site in the extracellular portion
of membrane protein using methods known in the art. A mixture of
eukaryotic cells expressing both peptides can be prepared or each
eukaryotic cell can express several peptides.
[0473]Viruses can be recombinantly engineered to carry genes encoding a
membrane protein with a peptide ligand inserted in the sequence to be
expressed on the surface of infected tumor cells and/or part of the viral
envelope.
[0474]Nanoparticles can be coated with a particular ligand and a
detectable moiety, a therapeutic agent or a combination thereof such that
the nanoparticles home to the recombinant peptide and bind, thus,
delivering the detectable moiety and/or therapeutic agent specifically to
the tumor.
[0475]Tumor tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously injected
microorganisms and cells recombinantly engineered as described herein.
Concomitant with, or subsequent to, injection of the recombinant
microorganism, nanoparticles coated with the corresponding ligand and a
detectable moiety, a therapeutic agent or a combination thereof can be
injected. The detectable moiety and/or therapeutic agent can be
conjugated to the ligand or can be coated on the nanoparticle itself. In
some cases, the detectable moiety and therapeutic agent are the same,
e.g., a radionuclide. The nanoparticles can be coated with a substance,
such as PEG, to reduce aggregation of the nanoparticles. Homing of the
nanoparticle to the microorganism or tumor cell allows for imaging and or
therapy of the tumors. The therapeutic agent can prevent progression of
tumor development or kill the tumor cells. The diagnostic agent can be
optimized for use in any of the imaging methods provided herein. The
method allows for combination diagnosis and therapy of tumors using the
same recombinantly engineered microorganism.
[0476]ii. Nanoparticle-Antibody Conjugates
[0477]Molecular imaging of tumor antigens using immunospecific magnetic
resonance (MR) contrast agents has been shown to aid in early disease
detection, monitoring of treatment efficacy and drug development.
Magnetite particles are superparamagnetic and have a significantly larger
magnetic moment than paramagnetic compounds. The detection limit for
magnetite particles in MRI is in the subnanomolar range, which is orders
of magnitudes better than the micromolar detection limit of gadolinium
(Weissleder et al. (1990) Radiology 175:489-493). Antibodies
immunoreactive with, or that specifically bind to, tumor surface antigens
(e.g., the her2/neu receptor and 9.2.27 proteoglycan sulfate), have been
covalently coupled to small iron oxide (magnetite) particles and were
effective in detecting melanoma cell lines as well as mammary carcinoma
cell lines in vivo (Funovics et al. (2004) Magnetic Resonance Imaging
22:843-850).
[0478]Bacterial cells can be recombinantly engineered to express a peptide
ligand on an outer membrane protein on the cell surface. Bacteria can be
transformed with a plasmid carrying genes encoding exogenous receptors or
recombinant cell surface molecules, such as, but not limited to, an outer
membrane protein with a peptide ligand inserted in the sequence. In one
embodiment, E. coli Nissle 1917 can be transformed with plasmids carrying
genes encoding OmpA with a streptavidin binding peptide (SA-B/OmpA) or a
S-peptide (SPep/OmpA) as described in the Examples. In another
embodiment, E. coli Nissle 1917 can be transformed with plasmids carrying
genes encoding the her2/neu receptor.
[0479]Eukaryotic cells can be recombinantly engineered to carry genes
encoding exogenous receptors or recombinant cell surface molecules, such
as, but not limited to, a membrane protein with a peptide ligand inserted
in the sequence.
[0480]Viruses can be recombinantly engineered to carry genes encoding
exogenous receptors or recombinant cell surface molecules, such as, but
not limited to, a membrane protein with a peptide ligand inserted in the
sequence (and a signal peptide for cell surface expression) for
expression of the recombinant molecule on the surface of infected tumor
cells and/or part of the viral envelope.
[0481]Tumor tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously injected
microorganisms and cells recombinantly engineered as described herein.
Concomitant with, or subsequent to, injection of the recombinant
microorganism, nanoparticles coated with antibodies that selectively bind
to the peptide or receptor can be intravenously injected.
[0482]The nanoparticle also can be coated with any of the detectable
moieties and/or therapeutic agents provided herein. Alternatively, the
antibodies provided herein can be conjugated to any of the detectable
moieties and/or therapeutic agents provided herein. In some cases, the
detectable moiety and therapeutic agent are the same, e.g., a
radionuclide. In a further embodiment, the nanoparticles can be coated
with a substance, such as PEG, to reduce aggregation or reduce uptake
into the reticuloendothelial system (RES). In addition, antibodies used
in the methods herein can be specific for a surface protein on the
microorganism.
[0483]Homing of the antibody to ligand presented on the microorganism or
tumor cell surface allows for imaging and or therapy of the tumors. The
therapeutic agent can prevent progression of tumor development or kill
the tumor cells. The diagnostic agent can be optimized for use in any of
the imaging methods provided herein. The method allows for combination
diagnosis and therapy of the tumor using the same recombinantly
engineered microorganism.
[0484]iii. Nanoparticle-Protein Conjugates
[0485]In vivo magnetic resonance imaging (MRI) of nanoparticle conjugates
has been assessed in a transgene expression system. Specifically,
transgenic mice were generated that expressed an engineered transferrin
receptor. Monocrystalline iron oxide nanoparticles (MION) were sterically
protected with a layer of dextran and covalently conjugated to human
holo-transferrin. Gliosarcoma cells were stably transfected with cells
expressing the engineered transferrin receptor or control cells. Tumors
were established in nude mice and administered transferrin-MION
conjugates. In vivo MRI analysis showed that the transferrin-MION
conjugates were localized to tumors with the engineered transferrin
receptor (Weissleder et al. (2000) Nat. Medicine 6(3):351-354).
[0486]Tat protein-derived peptide sequences have been used to internalize
a number of marker proteins into cells (Schwarze et al. (1999) Science
285:1569-1572). In another example, superparamagnetic nanoparticles have
been coated with dextran and Tat protein-derived peptide sequences; the
particles were efficiently incorporated into cells. Cells also could be
tagged with a triple label of (magnetic, fluorescent, isotope)
superparamagnetic nanoparticles conjugated to Tat protein-derived peptide
sequences and visualized with MRI. Such methods target Tat-nanoparticle
conjugates to CD34+ cells (Lewin et al. (2000) Nature Biotechnology
18:410-414).
[0487]Microorganisms and cells can be recombinantly engineered to express
an exogenous receptor. The microorganism or cell can carry genes encoding
such recombinant receptors. In one non-limiting example, a microorganism,
such as a bacteria, a virus or a eukaryotic cell can be recombinantly
engineered to carry genes encoding a transferrin receptor, a lactoferrin
receptor or a combination thereof. The plasmids can be, for example,
plasmids which cause over-expression of the recombinant polypeptide of
interest using a strong promoter. In one non-limiting embodiment, tumor
tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously injected bacteria,
virus or eukaryotic cell recombinantly engineered to over-express the
transferrin receptor.
[0488]By virtue of the ability of the microorganisms and cells to home to
tumor environments, transferrin receptor expression would be increased in
the tumor environment. Concomitant with, or subsequent to, injection of
the recombinant microorganism, nanoparticles coated with the
corresponding ligand (e.g., transferrin or lactoferrin) and a detectable
moiety, a therapeutic agent or a combination thereof can be injected. In
a further embodiment, the nanoparticles can be coated with a substance,
such as PEG, to reduce aggregation and reduce uptake into the
reticuloendothelial system (RES). The detectable moiety and/or
therapeutic agent can be conjugated to the ligand or can be coated on the
nanoparticle itself. In some cases, the detectable moiety and therapeutic
agent are the same, e.g., a radionuclide. Homing of the nanoparticle to
the microorganism or cell allows for imaging and/or therapy of the tumor
cells. The therapeutic agent can prevent progression of tumor development
or kill the tumor cells. The diagnostic agent can be optimized for use in
any of the imaging methods provided herein. The method allows for
combination diagnosis and therapy of the tumor using the same
recombinantly engineered microorganism.
[0489]e. Siderophores
[0490]Endogenous or exogenous siderophores can be conjugated to any of the
detectable moieties or therapeutic agents provided herein and used in any
of the methods provided herein. Recombinantly engineered microorganisms
and cells expressing or over-expressing siderophores and their receptors
have been described above. Alternatively, or in addition, recombinantly
engineered microorganisms and cells containing inactivated DNA such that
siderophores are not expressed have been described above.
[0491]In one non-limiting embodiment, a microorganism such as a bacteria
(e.g., E. coli Nissle 1917), a virus (e.g., Vaccinia virus), or a
eukaryotic cell can be recombinantly engineered with genes encoding a
receptor of interest. In one non-limiting embodiment, tumor tissues can
be specifically infected by intravenously injected microorganisms and
cells recombinantly engineered as described herein. For example, a
microorganism such as a bacteria (e.g., E. coli Nissle 1917), a virus
(e.g., Vaccinia virus), or a eukaryotic cell can be recombinantly
engineered with genes encoding the ferrichrome receptor, FhuA. By virtue
of the ability of microorganism to home to tumor environments, FhuA
expression would be localized to the bacterial, eukaryotic or tumor cell
surface. Concomitant with, or subsequent to, injection of the recombinant
microorganism, ferrichrome conjugated to any of the detectable moieties
provided herein can be intravenously injected. Following in vivo imaging
of the tumor using any of the methods provided herein, ferrichrome
conjugated to any of the therapeutic agents provided herein can be
intravenously injected for localized therapy of the imaged tumor. The
detectable moiety and the therapeutic agent can be the same molecule
(e.g., a radionuclide) or different molecules (e.g., a chemotherapeutic
agent and an anti-cancer antibody). The therapeutic agent can prevent
progression of tumor development or kill the tumor cells. The method
allows for combination diagnosis and therapy of the tumor using the same
recombinantly engineered microorganism.
D. METHODS OF MODIFYING MICROORGANISMS AND CELLS
[0492]The microorganisms and cells provided herein can be modified from
their wild-type form. Modifications can include any of a variety of
changes, and typically include changes to the genome or nucleic acid
molecules of the microorganisms and cells. The microorganisms and cells
provided herein can be formed by standard methodologies well known in the
art for modifying microorganisms and cells such as viruses, bacteria and
eukaryotic cells. Briefly, the methods include introducing into
microorganisms and cells one or more genetic modification(s), followed by
screening the microorganisms and cells for properties reflective of the
modification(s) or for other desired properties. Exemplary nucleic acid
molecular modifications include truncations, insertions, deletions and
mutations. In an exemplary modification, a microorganism or cell can be
modified by truncation, insertion, deletion or mutation of one or more
genes. In an exemplary insertion, an exogenous gene such as, for example,
streptavidin binding peptide, can be inserted into the genome of the
microorganism or cell or provided on a plasmid. In an exemplary
modification, an endogenous gene, an exogenous gene or a combination
thereof can be inserted into a plasmid which is inserted into the
microorganism or cell using any of the methods known in the art. In an
exemplary deletion/mutation, a gene, such as, for example, the fur
repressor consensus sequence, can be inactivated by homologous
recombination techniques in combination with any of the other methods
provided herein. Methods for optimizing expression genes are known in the
art and include, for example, modification of copy number, promoter
strength, deletion of genes that encode inhibitory proteins, or movement
of essential genes to a plasmid in order to maintain the plasmid in the
transformed bacteria.
[0493]The microorganisms and cells provided herein can be formed by
standard methodologies well known in the art for modifying microorganisms
and cells such as viruses, bacteria and eukaryotic cells. Briefly, the
methods include introducing into microorganisms and cells one or more
genetic modification, followed by screening the microorganisms and cells
for properties reflective of the modification or for other desired
properties. Modifications of the microorganisms and cells provided herein
can result in a modification of microorganismal characteristics,
including, but not limited to, those provided herein such as
pathogenicity, toxicity, ability to preferentially accumulate in tumor,
ability to lyse cells or cause cell death, replication competence,
increased capacity to capture iron or other metals, increased capacity to
transport iron, increased capacity to store iron, bind a ligand, or a
combination thereof.
[0494]Standard techniques in molecular biology can be used to generate the
modified microorganisms and cells provided herein. Such techniques
include various nucleic acid manipulation techniques, nucleic acid
transfer protocols, nucleic acid amplification protocols, and other
molecular biology techniques known in the art. For example, point
mutations can be introduced into a gene of interest through the use of
oligonucleotide mediated site-directed mutagenesis. Alternatively,
homologous recombination techniques can be used to introduce a mutation
or exogenous sequence into a target sequence of interest; or can be used
to inactivate a target sequence of interest. Nucleic acid transfer
protocols include calcium chloride transformation/transfection,
transduction, electroporation, liposome mediated nucleic acid transfer,
N-[1-(2,3-Dioloyloxy)propyl]-N,N,N-trimethylammonium methylsulfate
meditated transformation, and others. In an alternative mutagenesis
protocol, point mutations in a particular gene can also be selected for
using a positive selection pressure. See, e.g., Current Techniques in
Molecular Biology, (ed. Ausubel, et al.). Nucleic acid amplification
protocols include but are not limited to the polymerase chain reaction
(PCR). Use of nucleic acid tools such as plasmids, vectors, promoters and
other regulating sequences, are well known in the art for a large variety
of viruses and cellular organisms. Further a large variety of nucleic
acid tools are available from many different sources including the
American Type Culture Collection (ATCC), and various commercial sources.
One skilled in the art will be readily able to select the appropriate
tools and methods for genetic modifications of any particular virus or
cellular organism according to the knowledge in the art and design
choice.
[0495]Any of a variety of modifications can be readily accomplished using
standard molecular biological methods known in the art. The modifications
will typically be one or more truncations, deletions, mutations or
insertions of the microorganismal genome. In one embodiment, the
modification can be specifically directed to a particular sequence. The
modifications can be directed to any of a variety of regions of the
microorganismal genome or endogenous plasmids, including, but not limited
to, a regulatory sequence, to a gene-encoding sequence, or to a sequence
without a known role. Any of a variety of regions of microorganismal
genomes that are available for modification are readily known in the art
for many microorganisms and cells, including the microorganisms and cells
specifically listed herein.
[0496]1. Recombinant DNA Technology
[0497]Display of heterologous proteins in the cytosol of microorganisms
and cells, on the surface of microorganisms and cells or secreted by
microorganisms and cells, enabled by means of recombinant DNA technology,
has become an increasingly used strategy in various applications in
microbiology, biotechnology and vaccinology. Gram negative, Gram positive
bacteria, viruses, eukaryotic cells and phages are all being investigated
for such applications. Live bacterial vaccine delivery vehicles are being
developed through the surface display of foreign antigens on the
bacterial surfaces. Live bacteria delivery vehicles also can be developed
such that bacteria make recombinant gene products that are located in the
cytosol or that are secreted. The polypeptides encoded by the recombinant
genes can aid in diagnostic or therapeutic methods described herein.
Bacteria can be engineered with plasmids to produce one or more
polypeptides of interest. Homologous recombination can also be conducted
to inactivate regulatory or other such genes on a bacterial chromosome
and to insert recombinant genes on the bacterial chromosome. Thus,
bacteria can be used as new types of whole-cell diagnostic devices.
[0498]Variants can be obtained by general methods such as mutagenesis and
passage in bacterial, cell or tissue culture and selection of desired
properties, as is known in the art. Variants also can be obtained by
mutagenic methods in which nucleic acid residues of the microorganism or
cell are added, removed or modified relative to wild type. Any of a
variety of known mutagenic methods can be used, including
recombination-based methods, restriction endonuclease-based methods,
chemical mutagenesis and PCR-based methods. Mutagenic methods can be
directed against particular nucleotide sequences such as genes, or can be
random, where selection methods based on desired characteristics can be
used to select mutated microorganisms and cells. Any of a variety of
microorganismal modifications can be made, according to the selected
microorganism or cell and the particular known modifications of the
selected microorganism. Methods for introduction of genetic material into
bacteria are available and known in the art, including, but not limited
to, plasmid transformation and phage transduction, using vectors such as
P1 or lambda bacteriophage vectors (cosmids), which can contain
transposons.
[0499]a. Endogenous Gene Expression
[0500]Methods for recombinantly engineering microorganisms and cells are
well-known in the art. Methods include, but are not limited to,
oligonucleotide-directed in vitro mutagenesis to introduce genes into
plasmids are well known in the art.
[0501]Plasmids can be created to carry genes using methods known to one
skilled in the art. High copy plasmids can be used to cause
over-expression of endogenous proteins in microorganism. Plasmids for
expression of proteins include, but are not limited to ColE1, pBR322,
p15A, pEMBLex2, pMAL-p2, pUC18A2 (a pUC18-derived plasmid containing the
ftn gene), pUC118, pGS281, pMK4, pUNK1, pAM.beta.1 and pTA1060. Choice of
a plasmid for expression at desired levels is well-known in the art as
well as techniques to introduce genes into the plasmids (Sambrook et al.
Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual. 2.sup.nd ed. Cold Spring Harbor
Laboratory Press, New York, N.Y. 1989; Current Protocols in Molecular
Biology. Ed. Ausubel et al. John Wiley & Sons, Inc. Cambridge, Mass.,
1995).
[0502]b. Exogenous Gene Expression
[0503]In some embodiments, the microorganism or cell can be modified to
express an exogenous gene. Exemplary exogenous gene products include
proteins and RNA molecules. The modified microorganisms and cells can
express a detectable gene product, a therapeutic gene product, a protein
that serves as a binding site for a ligand. For example, bacteria can be
recombinantly engineered with a peptide inserted into a permissible site
of an endogenous protein (e.g., OmpA) or can be recombinantly engineered
with an exogenous receptor (e.g., the her2/neu receptor). The
characteristics of such gene products are described herein and elsewhere.
In some embodiments of modifying an organism to express an exogenous
gene, the modification can also contain one or more regulatory sequences
to regulate expression of the exogenous gene. As is known in the art,
regulatory sequences can permit constitutive expression of the exogenous
gene or can permit inducible expression of the exogenous gene. Further,
the regulatory sequence can permit control of the level of expression of
the exogenous gene. In some examples, inducible expression can be under
the control of cellular or other factors present in a tumor cell, present
in a microorganism-infected tumor cell, or present in/on an extracellular
microorganism or cell localized in a tumor environment. In other
examples, inducible expression can be under the control of an
administrable substance, including arabinose, IPTG, RU486 or other known
induction compounds. Any of a variety of regulatory sequences are
available to one skilled in the art according to known factors and design
preferences. In some embodiments, the regulatory sequence can result in
constitutive, high levels of gene expression. In tumor therapy
embodiments, a therapeutic protein can be under the control of an
internally inducible promoter or an externally inducible promoter. In
some examples, the inducible promoter is a sugar-inducible promoter, such
as an arabinose-inducible promoter. Recombinant microorganism or cells
that contain an sugar-inducible promoter for the expression of exogenous
genes can be modified to decrease or abolish the metabolic breakdown of
the inducing sugar. For example, bacteria, such as E. coli, can be
modified such that the breakdown and/or utilization of arabinose in the
bacteria is reduced or abolished, which allows for greater accumulation
of arabinose in the cells leading to higher gene induction of and longer
gene expression from arabinose-inducible promoters in the recombinant
bacteria.
[0504]The microorganisms and cells provided herein also can have the
ability to express one or more exogenous genes. Gene expression can
include expression of a protein encoded by a gene and/or expression of an
RNA molecule encoded by a gene. Expression of exogenous genes can be
controlled by a constitutive promoter, or by an inducible promoter.
Expression can also be influenced by one or more proteins or RNA
molecules expressed by the microorganism. Genes can be encoded in a
microorganismal chromosome or on a plasmid. Over-expression of a gene or
gene product can be achieved by insertion of a gene into the
microorganismal chromosome under the control of a strong promoter.
Plasmids can be created to carry genes using methods known to one skilled
in the art. A high copy plasmids can be used to cause over-expression of
exogenous proteins in microorganism. Plasmids for expression of proteins
include, but are not limited to ColE1, pBR322, p15A, pEMBLex2, pMAL-p2,
pUC18A2 (a pUC 18-derived plasmid containing the ftn gene), pUC118,
pGS281, pMK4, pUNK1, pAM.beta.1 and pTA1060. Choice of a plasmid for
expression at desired levels is well-known in the art as well as
techniques to introduce genes into the plasmids (Sambrook et al.
Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual. 2.sup.nd ed. Cold Spring Harbor
Laboratory Press, New York, N.Y. 1989; Current Protocols in Molecular
Biology. Ed. Ausubel et al. John Wiley & Sons, Inc. Cambridge, Mass.,
1995).
[0505]For example, bacteria have a number of different ways to secrete and
attach proteins to their surface. Gram positive (G+) bacteria mainly
secrete proteins using Sec-dependent protein secretion machinery or the
TAT-transporter to translocate proteins over the cell membrane. They use
different proteins (sortases) to attach some of the secreted proteins to
the cell wall. Signal peptides target the proteins for efficient
secretion and attachment, with the signal being cleaved from the mature
surface protein during the secretion process. In Gram negative (G-)
bacteria, at least 5 different types of protein secretion are known
(Types I-V). While the type I secretion system uses the C-terminal
protein sequence as a secretion signal, other systems use N-terminal
signal sequences. Attachment to the bacterial surface is not mediated by
linking it to the peptidoglycan, as is the case for Gram positive
bacteria. Rather, the proteins on the gram negative bacterial surface
have a transmembrane moiety that is embedded in the outer membrane of the
bacteria (Choi and Lee (2004) Appl. Microbiol. Biotechnol. 64:625-635;
Palmer et al. (2005) Trends in Microbiol. 13(4):175-180). In some
embodiments, bacteria can be engineered to express ligands on their
surface that attract therapeutic agents to the bacteria. In other
embodiments, siderophores or nanoparticles, which selectively move to
bacteria in the tumors can also be conjugated to therapeutic agents.
Siderophores or nanoparticles can also be conjugated to therapeutic
agents and to a receptor that recognizes a ligand expressed on the
surface of the bacteria, for example, as a fusion with an outer membrane
protein. Additional systems for cell surface expression include, but are
not limited to, lipoprotein, ice nucleation protein, Fimbrial, LamB PhoE,
TolC and FliC systems.
[0506]In other embodiments, siderophores or nanoparticles, can be
conjugated to a protein that binds to a ligand bound to the cell surface.
For example, a siderophore or nanoparticle conjugated to a streptavidin
protein can bind to a biotin-TMR or -diAcFAM ligand fusion protein that
is bound to a modified hydrolase protein expressed on the surface of a
bacterium (Halotag system, Promega).
[0507]i. Outer Membrane Proteins (Omp)
[0508]Generally, when outer membrane proteins are used for display of
heterologous peptides or proteins, it is achieved through genetic
insertion into permissive sites of the carrier proteins. Expression of a
heterologous peptide or protein is dependent on the structural properties
of the inserted protein domain, since the peptide or protein is more
constrained when inserted into a permissive site as compared to fusion at
the N- or C-terminus of a protein.
[0509]Peptides displayed on the surface of filamentous bacteriophages or
phage display provide a versatile and effective method for isolation of
peptide ligands binding to a diverse array of targets. Peptide libraries
have been constructed in E. coli as insertions in extracellular proteins
(e.g., pili and flagella subunits) or as insertions into outer membrane
proteins. A streptavidin peptide ligand has been displayed in the E. coli
strain MC1061 outer membrane protein A (OmpA) using bacterial display
methodology (Lee et al. (2003) Trends Biotechnol. 21:45-52; Lu et al.
(1995) Biotechnology (NY) 13:366-372; Camaj et al. (2001) Biol. Chem.
382:1669-1677; Bessette et al. (2004) Prot. Eng., Design & Sel.
17(10):731-739). Other peptides of 15-514 amino acids have been displayed
in the second, third, and fourth outer loops on the surface of OmpA
(Samuelson et al. (2002) J. Biotechnol. 96:129-154). Thus, outer membrane
proteins can carry and display heterologous gene products on the outer
surface of Gram negative bacteria.
[0510]Proteins in the outer membrane or periplasmic space are usually
synthesized in the cytoplasm as premature proteins, which are cleaved at
a signal sequence to produce the mature protein that is exported outside
the cytoplasm. Exemplary signal sequences used for secretory production
of recombinant proteins for E. coli have been identified. The N-terminal
amino acid sequence, without the Met extension, can be obtained after
cleavage by the signal peptidase when a gene of interest is correctly
fused to a signal sequence. Thus, a mature protein can be produced
without changing the amino acid sequence of the protein of interest (Choi
and Lee (2004) Appl. Microbiol. Biotechnol. 64:625-635). Thus, outer
membrane proteins can be used to express exogenous gene products, such as
a peptide on the surface of any of the modified microorganisms and cells
provided herein.
[0511]ii. Lpp'OmpA
[0512]LPP'OmpA proteins provide a system that efficiently displays outer
surface proteins and combines the benefits of efficient surface display
of outer membrane proteins and which allowed C-terminal fusions. E. coli
lipoprotein (LPP) differs from other outer membrane proteins because all
the information for targeting and insertion into the outer membrane is in
the signal sequence and the first nine N-terminal amino acids
(collectively denoted LPP'). Fusions to the short LPP' sequence become
fatty acylated, exported via the lipoprotein pathway and inserted into
the outer membrane but are not surface exposed. The LPP' system has been
successfully used to create a number of fusion proteins to display
proteins in a functional form on E. coli (Francisco et al. (1992) PNAS
USA 89:2713-2717; Georgiou et al. (1996) Protein Eng. 9:239-247). Thus,
LPP'OmpA proteins can be used to express exogenous gene products, such as
a peptide ligand, on the surface of modified microorganisms and cells
provided herein.
[0513]iii. Lipoproteins
[0514]Lipoproteins refer to a group of bacterial proteins that are
anchored to the outer membrane via a covalently attached lipid moiety. E.
coli peptidoglycan-associated lipoprotein (PAL) has been used as a
carrier of proteins for presentation at the surface of the cell.
Recombinant DNA technology was used to create a fusion of PAL and a
single chain antibody fragment Samuelson et al. (2002) J. Biotechnology
96:129-154). Thus, lipoproteins can be used to express exogenous gene
products, such as a peptide ligand, on the surface of modified
microorganisms and cells provided herein.
[0515]iv. Ice-Nucleation Protein (Inp)
[0516]Inp (or InaZ) is normally anchored to Pseudomonase syringae cells
via a glycosylphosphatidyl-inositol (GPI)-anchor sequence. Fusion
constructs of levansucrase to the C-terminus of Inp cause surface
expression of levansucrase in E. coli, resulting in surface localized
enzyme activity. Inp has also been used for displaying antigens, enzymes
and single-chain antibodies (Jung et al. (1998) Nat. Biotechnol.
16:576-580; Jung et al., Enzyme Microb. Technol. 22:348-354 (1998), Kim
et al. (2000) Appl. Environ. Microbiol. 66:788-793; Jeong et al. (2001)
Enzyme Microb. Technol. 28:155-160; Shimazu et al. (2001) Biotechnol.
Prog. 17:76-80; Bassi et al. (2000) Biotechnol. Prog. 16:557-563; Kim and
Yoo (1999) Lett. Appl. Microbiol. 29:292-297; and Lee et al. (1999)
Infect. Immunol. 67:1511-1516). Thus, Inp can be used to express
exogenous gene products, such as a peptide ligand, on the surface of
modified microorganisms and cells provided herein.
[0517]v. Detectable Gene Product
[0518]The microorganisms and cells provided herein can express one or more
genes whose products are detectable or whose products can provide a
detectable signal. A variety of detectable gene products, such as
detectable proteins are known in the art, and can be used with the
microorganisms and cells provided herein. Detectable proteins include
receptors or other proteins that can specifically bind a detectable
compound, proteins that can emit a detectable signal such as a
fluorescence signal, enzymes that can catalyze a detectable reaction or
catalyze formation of a detectable product.
[0519]In some embodiments, the microorganism or cell expresses a gene
encoding a protein that can emit a detectable signal or that can catalyze
a detectable reaction. Exogenous genes expressed can include genes
encoding a therapeutic gene product or genes encoding a detectable gene
product such as a gene product that can be used for imaging. The
microorganisms and cells provided herein can be used for expressing genes
in vivo and in vitro. Exemplary proteins include reporter proteins (E.
coli galactosidase, glucuronidase, xanthineguanine
phosphoribosyl-transferase), proteins facilitating detection, i.e., a
detectable protein or a protein capable of inducing a detectable signal,
(e.g., luciferase, luminescent proteins, fluorescent proteins, ferritin,
siderophore, transferrin receptor), proteins useful for tumor therapy
(Pseudomonas A endotoxin, diphtheria toxin, p53, Arf, Bax, tumor necrosis
factor alfa, HSV TK, E. coli purine nucleoside phosphorylase and
derivatives thereof, cytosine deaminases, uracil,
phosphoribosyltranspherase and fusions thereof (e.g., FCU1), angiostatin,
endostatin, different cytokines) and many other proteins.
[0520]A variety of DNA sequences encoding proteins that can emit a
detectable signal or that can catalyze a detectable reaction, such as
luminescent or fluorescent proteins, are known and can be used in the
microorganisms and cells and methods provided herein. An exemplary
inducible promoter system can include arabinose induction of exogenous
luciferase genes. Exemplary genes encoding light-emitting proteins
include genes from bacterial luciferase from Vibrio harveyi (Belas et al.
(1982) Science 218:791-793) or Vibrio fischerii (Foran and Brown (1988)
Nucleic acids Res. 16:177), click beetle luciferase (Wood et al. (1989)
J. Biolumin. Chemilumin. 4(1):289-301), firefly luciferase (de Wet et al.
(1987) Mol. Cell. Biol. 7:725-737), aequorin from Aequorea victoria
(Prasher et al. (1987) Biochem. 26:1326-1332), Renilla luciferase from
Renilla renformis (Lorenz et al. (1991) PNAS USA 88:4438-4442), green
fluorescent protein (GFP) from Aequorea victoria (Prasher et al. (1987)
Gene 111:229-233) or Renilla sea pansy, and other sea anemone and coral
species, and variants thereof, including yellow fluorescent protein
(YFP), orange fluorescent protein (OFP), cyan fluorescent protein (CFP),
and blue fluorescent protein (BFP), red fluorescent protein (RFP) and
far-red fluorescent protein from the corallimorph Discosoma (Matz et al.
(1999) Nature Biotechnology 17:969-973), Heteractis reef coral and other
sea anemone and coral species, as well as variants thereof including
DsRed2 (Clontech, Palo Alto, Calif.), DsRed-T1 (Bevis and Glick (2002)
Nat. Biotechnol. 20:83-87), mPlum (Wang et al. (2004) PNAS US A.
101(48):16745-9), HcRed1 and t-HcRed (Clontech, Palo Alto, Calif.), and
near-infrared fluorescent proteins. Transformation and expression of
these genes in microorganisms and cells can permit detection of
microorganismal colonies, for example, using a low light imaging camera,
such as an Argus-100 (Hamamatsu Photonics, Hamamatsu, Japan), Xenogen
Imaging System (Alameda, Calif.), Berthold Night Owl (Berthold
Technologies, Oak Ridge, Tenn.) or other low light imaging camera or
fluorescence detector.
[0521]Fusion of the luxA and luxB genes can result in a fully functional
luciferase protein (Escher et al. (1989) PNAS 86:6528-6532). This fusion
gene (Fab.sup.2) has introduced into a variety of microorganisms and
cells followed by microorganismal infection and imaging based on
luciferase expression. Fab.sup.2 can be used in the microorganisms and
cells and methods provided herein.
[0522]In some embodiments, luciferases expressed in bacteria can require
exogenously added substrates such as decanal or coelenterazine for light
emission. In other embodiments, microorganisms and cells can express a
complete lux operon, which can include proteins that can provide
luciferase substrates such as tetradecanal. For example, bacteria
containing the complete lux operon sequence, when injected
intraperitoneally, intramuscularly, or intravenously, allowed the
visualization and localization of bacteria in live mice indicating that
the luciferase light emission can penetrate the tissues and can be
detected externally (Contag et al. (1995) Mol. Microbiol. 18:593-603).
[0523]In other embodiments, the microorganism or cell can express a gene
that can bind a detectable compound or that can form a product that can
bind a detectable compound. A variety of gene products, such as peptides
and proteins, that can specifically bind a detectable compound are known
in the art, including receptors, metal binding proteins, ligand binding
proteins, peptides, enzymes and antibodies. Any of a variety of
detectable compounds can be used, and can be imaged by any of a variety
of known imaging methods. Exemplary compounds include ligands for
receptors and antigens for antibodies. The detectable compounds
(diagnostic moiety) can be labeled according to the imaging method to be
used. Exemplary imaging methods include any of a variety magnetic
resonance methods such as magnetic resonance imaging (MRI) and magnetic
resonance spectroscopy (MRS), and also include any of a variety of
tomographic methods including computed tomography (CT), computed axial
tomography (CAT), electron beam computed tomography (EBCT), high
resolution computed tomography (HRCT), hypocycloidal tomography, positron
emission tomography (PET), single-photon emission computed tomography
(SPECT), spiral computed tomography and ultrasonic tomography.
[0524]Labels appropriate for magnetic resonance imaging are known in the
art, and include, for example, gadolinium chelates and iron oxides. Use
of chelates in contrast agents is known in the art. Labels appropriate
for tomographic imaging methods are known in the art, and include, for
example, .crclbar.-emitters such as .sup.11C, .sup.13N, .sup.150 or
.sup.64Cu or (b) .gamma.-emitters such as .sup.123 I. Other exemplary
radionuclides that can, be used, for example, as tracers for PET include
.sup.55Co, .sup.67Ga, .sup.68Ga, .sup.60Cu(II), .sup.67Cu(II), .sup.57Ni,
.sup.52Fe and .sup.18F. Examples of useful radionuclide-labeled agents
are .sup.64Cu-labeled engineered antibody fragment (Wu et al. (2002) PNAS
USA 97:8495-8500), .sup.64Cu-labeled somatostatin (Lewis et al. (1999) J.
Med. Chem. 42:1341-1347),
.sup.64Cu-pyruvaldehyde-bis(N4-methylthiosemicarbazone)(.sup.64Cu-PTSM)
(Adonai et al. (2002) PNAS USA 99:3030-3035), .sup.52Fe-citrate (Leenders
et al. (1994) J. Neural. Transm. Suppl. 43:123-132),
.sup.52Fe/.sup.52mMn-citrate (Calonder et al. (1999) J. Neurochem.
73:2047-2055) and .sup.52Fe-labeled iron (III) hydroxide-sucrose complex
(Beshara et al. (1999) Br. J. Haematol. 104:288-295, 296-302).
[0525]vi. More than One Gene Product
[0526]In some embodiments, microorganisms and cells can be modified to
express two or more proteins using any of the methods provided herein.
For example, a microorganism or cell can be modified to express a
heterologous siderophore biosynthetic enzyme and a heterologous outer
membrane protein. In another example, a microorganism or cell can be
modified to express a heterologous receptor and over-express an exogenous
ferritin-like compound. In yet another example, a microorganism or cell
can be modified to express a recombinant outer membrane protein with a
peptide insertion and a siderophore biosynthetic enzyme. In one example,
a microorganism or cell can be modified to express a detectable protein
and a therapeutic protein. In another embodiment, a microorganism or cell
can be modified to express two or more gene products for detection or two
or more therapeutic gene products.
[0527]When two or more exogenous genes are introduced, the genes can be
regulated under the same or different regulatory sequences, and the genes
can be inserted in the same or different regions of the microorganismal
genome, in a single or a plurality of genetic manipulation steps. In
another embodiment, the genes can be inserted in the same or different
regions of one or more plasmids while others can be encoded on the
microorganismal genome. In a different aspect, when two or more exogenous
genes are introduced, the genes can be regulated under the same or
different regulatory sequences, and the genes can be inserted in the same
or different plasmid, in a single or a plurality of genetic manipulation
steps. In some embodiments, one gene, such as a gene encoding a
detectable gene product, can be under the control of a constitutive
promoter, while a second gene, such as a gene encoding a therapeutic gene
product, can be under the control of an inducible promoter. In yet
another embodiment, a regulatory gene can be placed under the control of
one promoter and another gene under control of a promoter that is
controlled by the regulatory gene. For example, a T7 polymerase gene can
be placed under the control of the arabinose inducible P.sub.BAD promoter
and a gene of interest can be placed under the control of the T7 promoter
resulting in a strong amplification of the arabinose induced signal.
Methods for inserting two or genes into a microorganism or cell are known
in the art and can be readily performed for a wide variety of
microorganisms and cells using a wide variety of exogenous genes,
regulatory sequences, and/or other nucleic acid sequences.
[0528]c. Inactivation of Genes
[0529]Methods to inactivate genes on a microorganismal chromosome are
known to one skilled in the art. Microorganismal genes can be inactivated
by replacing the chromosomal genes with disrupted derivatives containing
antibiotic resistance cassettes or non-sense sequences in place of some
or all of the corresponding coding regions. More than one gene can be
inactivated (e.g., "knocked out") by these methods (Abdul-Tehrani et al.
(1999) J. Bacteriol. 181(5): 1415-1428; Chen and Morse (1999)
Microbiology 145:2967-2975; Waidner et al. (2002) Infec. Immun.
70(7):3923-3929). PCR analysis can be used to detect the resistance
marker and confirm the mutagenesis (Bereswill et al. (1998) Microbiology
144 (Pt 9):2505-2516). Conditional inactivation of bacterial genes using
phage-based E. coli homologous recombination systems has been developed
making it possible to subclone or modify DNA cloned into plasmids, BACs,
or PACs without using restriction enzymes or DNA ligases (Liu et al.
(2003) Genome Res. 13(3):476-484). Exemplary modifications to bacteria
include, but are not limited to, inactivation of consensus sequences such
as the 19-base pair DNA consensus sequence binding region of the Fur
protein (5'-GATAATGATAATCATTATC-3'; SEQ ID NO:46) that is found in the
promoter region of many genes that are negatively regulated by iron, or
inactivation of the msbB gene, which encodes a lipid acyl A transferase,
that results in decreased virulence of the bacteria due to the synthesis
of lipopolysaccharide (LPS) that lacks the myristic acid moiety of lipid
A (Jung et al. (1998) Enzyme Microb. Technol. 22(5):348-54 and U.S.
Patent Application Publication No. 2005-0255088; see Example 8).
[0530]d. Insertion of Genes
[0531]Bacterial, viruses and eukaryotic cells can be modified such that a
gene, or a portion thereof, is inserted into a chromosome.
[0532]Prokaryotic cells contain several classes of DNA insertion elements
which move from place to place in the genome and mediate chromosome
rearrangements. Similar elements exist in a wide variety of eukaryotic
organisms (yeasts, insects, plants and vertebrates). At least five
recombination mechanisms are known to cause chromosome changes: 1)
general homologous, 2) site-specific reciprocal, 3) illegitimate, 4) DNA
splicing, and 5) replicative; and the activities of DNA insertion
elements and somatic rearrangement systems are subject to controls at
several levels by specific regulatory systems, natural selection and
connection to cell lineage (Shapiro J A. (1982) Natl. Cancer Inst.
Monogr. 60:87-110).
[0533]In one example, a cassette containing a gene of interest, antibiotic
resistance genes and two short direct repeat DNA sequences, one at each
extremity of the cassette can be constructed. The bacteria containing the
inserted gene of interest can be selected by antibiotic resistance. This
methodology can be used to inactivate a gene and/or to introduce a gene
of interest in a bacterial chromosome (Brans et al. (2004) Appl. Environ.
Microbiol. 70(12):7241-7250).
[0534]DNA replacement systems have been established for engineering large
fragment insertions into the chromosome of E. coli. A DNA replacement
plasmid, such as pHybrid I, can be constructed based on a bacterial
artificial chromosome (BAC) vector. Fragments of the E. coli genome can
be introduced into the vector for homologous recombination. Additional
markers can be introduced for double marker screening for recombinant
clones (Rong et al. (2004) Gene. 336(1):73-80).
[0535]In one embodiment, bacteria can be transformed with a vehicle
including, but not limited to, plasmids, phages, cosmids, phagemids,
etc., carrying one or more genes, or portions thereof, that remain on the
plasmids and are expressed. Selection of delivery vehicles, modification
of vehicles to insert genes and methods of introducing vehicles into
various microorganisms and cells are well known in the art, such as
described by Sambrook et al. (Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual.
2.sup.nd ed. Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, New York, N.Y. 1989;
Current Protocols in Molecular Biology. Ed. Ausubel et al. John Wiley &
Sons, Inc. Cambridge, Mass., 1995).
[0536]Viral genomes can be cloned into a bacterial artificial chromosome
(BAC) vector. The BAC clone has been used for rapidly and precisely
modifying E. coli by efficient homologous recombination. This method can
be further modified so that any kind of cDNA can be rapidly inserted into
a site that has been artificially introduced into BAC (Kanda et al.
(2004) J. Virol. 78(13):7004-7015).
[0537]The large capacity of vaccinia virus (VAC) for added DNA,
cytoplasmic expression and broad host range makes it a popular choice for
gene delivery. A bacterial artificial chromosome (BAC) containing the
entire VAC genome can be engineered in E. coli by homologous
recombination using bacteriophage lambda-encoded enzymes; and the
engineered VAC genomes can then be used to produce clonally pure
recombinant viruses in mammalian cells without the need for plaque
purification (Domi and Moss (2005) Nat. Methods. 2(2):95-97).
[0538]e. Screening for Above Characteristics
[0539]Modified microorganisms and cells can be screened for any desired
characteristics, including the characteristics described herein such as
attenuated pathogenicity, reduced toxicity, preferential accumulation in
tumor, increased ability to capture iron, increased ability to transport
iron, increased ability to store iron, increased or decreased replication
competence, ability to express or over-express exogenous proteins,
ability to over-express endogenous proteins, inactivation of genes and
combinations thereof. For example, the microorganisms and cells can be
screened for expression of one or more detectable genes, including genes
that can be used for imaging, or for expression of one or more genes that
bind peptides, proteins, antibodies and/or nanostructures, which are
conjugated to detectable moieties and/or therapeutic agents using any of
the methods provided herein.
[0540]Any of a variety of known methods for screening for such
characteristics can be performed, as demonstrated in the Examples
provided herein. One exemplary method for screening for desired
characteristics includes, but is not limited to, monitoring growth,
replication and/or gene expression (including expression of an exogenous
gene) in cell culture or other in vitro medium. The cell culture can be
from any organism, and from any tissue source, and can include tumorous
tissues.
[0541]Other exemplary methods for screening for desired characteristics
include, but are not limited to, administering a microorganism or cell to
an animal, including non-human animals such as a rat, a mouse, monkey or
ape and, optionally, also including humans, and monitoring the
microorganism, the tumor and/or the animal; monitoring can be performed
by in vivo imaging of the and/or the tumor (e.g., low light imaging,
fluorescence imaging, magnetic resonance imaging, ultrasonic tumor
imaging, PET, CT, SPECT, etc.), external monitoring of the tumor (e.g.,
external measurement of tumor size), monitoring the animal (e.g.,
monitoring animal weight, blood panel, spleen size, or liver size), or
combination thereof. Other exemplary methods for screening for desired
characteristics include, but are not limited to, harvesting a non-human
animal for the effects and location of the microorganism or cell and
expression by the microorganism or cell including, but not limited to,
methods such as harvesting a variety of organs including a tumor to
determine presence of the microorganism or cell and/or gene expression by
the microorganism or cell in the organs or tumor, harvesting of organs
associated with microorganismal clearance such as the spleen or liver,
harvesting the tumor to determine tumor size and viability of tumor
cells, or a combination thereof. Such screening and monitoring methods
can be used in any of a variety of combinations, as is known in art. In
one embodiment, a microorganism or cell can be screened by administering
the microorganism or cell to an animal such as a non-human animal or a
human, followed by monitoring by in vivo imaging. In another embodiment,
a microorganism or cell can be screened by administering the
microorganism or cell to an animal, such as, for example, a non-human
animal, monitoring by in vivo imaging, and then harvesting the animal.
Thus, provided herein are methods for screening a microorganism or cell
for desired characteristics by administering the microorganism or cell to
an animal such as an animal with a tumor, and monitoring the animal,
tumor (if present), and/or microorganism or cell in the animal for one or
more characteristics. Also provided herein are methods for screening a
microorganism or cell for desired characteristics by administering the
microorganism or cell to a non-human animal such as a non-human animal
with a tumor, harvesting the animal, and assaying the animal's organs
and/or tumor (if present) for one or more characteristics.
[0542]Provided herein are methods for screening a microorganism or cell
for attenuated pathogenicity or reduced toxicity, where the pathogenicity
or toxicity can be determined by a variety of techniques, including, but
not limited to, assessing the health state of the subject, measuring the
body weight of a subject, blood or urine analysis of a subject, and
monitoring tissue distribution of the microorganism or cell within the
subject; such techniques can be performed on a living subject in vivo
(e.g., via surgery), or can be performed post mortem. Methods also can
include the ability of the microorganisms to lyse cells or cause cell
death, which can be determined in vivo or in vitro.
[0543]When a subject drops below a threshold body weight, the
microorganism or cell can be considered pathogenic to the subject.
Exemplary thresholds can be a drop of about 5% or more, a drop of about
10% or more, or a drop of about 15% or more in body weight relative to a
reference. A body weight reference can be selected from any of a variety
of references used in the art; for example, a body weight reference can
be the weight of the subject prior to administration of the
microorganism, the body weight reference can be a control subject having
the same condition as the test subject (e.g., normal or tumor-injected),
where the change in weight of the control is compared to the change in
weight of the test subject for the time period after administration of
the microorganism.
[0544]Blood or urine analysis of the subject can indicate level of immune
response, level of toxins in the subject, or other levels of stress to
cells, tissues or organs of the subject such as kidneys, pancreas, liver
and spleen. Levels increased above established threshold levels can
indicate pathogenicity of the microorganism or cell to the subject.
Threshold levels of components of blood or urine for indicating
microorganismal pathogenicity are well known in the art, and any such
thresholds can be selected herein according to the desired tolerance of
pathogenicity or toxicity of the microorganism.
[0545]Tissue distribution of a microorganism or cell in a subject can
indicate pathogenicity or toxicity of the microorganism. In one
embodiment, tissue distribution of a microorganism or cell that is not
pathogenic or toxic can be mostly in tumors or metastasis relative to
other tissues or organs. Microorganisms and cells located mostly in tumor
can accumulate, for example, at least about 2-fold greater, at least
about 5-fold greater, at least about 10-fold greater, at least about
100-fold greater, at least about 1,000-fold greater, at least about
10,000-fold greater, at least about 100,000-fold greater, or at least
about 1,000,000-fold greater, than accumulation of the microorganism or
cell in a non-tumorigenic organ or tissue.
[0546]Provided herein are methods for screening a microorganism or cell
for tissue distribution or accumulation, where the tissue distribution
can be determined by a variety of techniques, including, but not limited
to, harvesting a non-human subject, in vivo imaging a detectable moiety
in the subject. Harvesting can be accomplished by euthanizing the
non-human subject, and determining the accumulation of microorganisms and
cells in tumor and, optionally, the accumulation in one or more
additional tissues or organs. The accumulation can be determined by any
of a variety of methods, including, but not limited to, detecting gene
products such as detectable gene products (e.g., GFP or beta
galactosidase), detecting contrast agents (e.g., iron, gadolinium, gold
or gallium), histological or microscopic evaluation of tissue, organ or
tumor samples, or measuring the number of plaque or colony forming units
present in a tissue, organ or tumor sample. In one embodiment, the
desired amount of tissue distribution of a microorganism or cell can be
mostly in tumor relative to other tissues or organs. Microorganisms and
cells located mostly in tumor can accumulate, for example, at least about
2-fold greater, at least about 5-fold greater, at least about 10-fold
greater, at least about 100-fold greater, at least about 1,000-fold
greater, at least about 10,000-fold greater, at least about 100,000-fold
greater, or at least about 1,000,000-fold greater, than accumulation of
the microorganism or cell in a non-tumorigenic organ or tissue.
[0547]Also provided herein are methods of screening for the ability of the
microorganisms to lyse cells or cause cell death, which can be determined
in vivo or in vitro.
[0548]Also provided herein are methods for determining increased or
decreased replication competence, by monitoring the speed of replication
of the microorganisms and cells. Such measurements can be performed in
vivo or in vitro. For example, the speed of replication in a cell or
bacterial culture can be used to determine replication competence of a
microorganism. In another example, the speed of replication in a tissue,
organ or tumor in a subject can be used to measure replication
competence. In some embodiments, decreased replication competence in
non-tumor tissues and organs can be the characteristic to be selected in
a screen. In other embodiments, increased replication competence in
tumors can be the characteristic to be selected in a screen.
[0549]Also provided herein are methods for determining the ability of a
microorganism or cell to express genes, such as an endogenous gene or an
exogenous gene. Such methods can be performed in vivo or in vitro. For
example, the microorganisms can be screened on selective plates for the
ability to express a gene that permits survival of the microorganism,
increased capacity to capture, transport and/or store iron, or permits
the microorganism or cell to provide a detectable signal, such as
luciferase. Such methods also can be performed in vitro, where expression
can be determined, for example, following harvesting tissues, organs or
tumors a non-human subject or by in vivo imaging of a subject.
[0550]Also provided herein are methods for screening a microorganism or
cell that has two or more characteristics provided herein, including
screening for attenuated pathogenicity, reduced toxicity, preferential
accumulation in tumor, increased ability to capture iron, increased
ability to transport iron, increased ability to store iron, increased
immunogenicity, increased or decreased replication competence,
inactivation of genes, ability to express or over-express endogenous or
exogenous proteins, or a combination thereof. A single monitoring
technique, such as in vivo imaging, can be used to verify two or more
characteristics, or a variety of different monitoring techniques can be
used, as can be determined by one skilled in the art according to the
selected characteristics and according to the monitoring techniques used.
E. MICROORGANISM AND CELL CHARACTERISTICS AND STRAINS
[0551]The microorganisms and cells provided herein and used in the methods
herein can be, for example, non-pathogenic or attenuated and replication
competent. In one embodiment, the microorganism or cell can be lytic
and/or immunogenic. Modifications of the microorganisms and cells
provided herein can result in a modification of microorganismal
characteristics, including those provided herein such as pathogenicity,
toxicity, ability to preferentially accumulate in tumor, ability to lyse
cells or cause cell death, ability to express or over-express and,
optionally, secrete an exogenous polypeptide, ability to over-express
and, optionally, secrete an endogenous polypeptide, increased ability to
capture iron, increased ability to transport iron, increased ability to
store iron, and replication competence.
[0552]1. General Characteristics
[0553]a. Attenuated
[0554]The microbes used in the methods provided herein are typically
attenuated. Attenuated microbes have a decreased capacity to cause
disease, such as septic shock, in a host. The decreased capacity can
result from any of a variety of different modifications to the ability of
a microbe to be pathogenic. For example, a microbe can have reduced
toxicity, reduced ability to accumulate in non-tumorous organs or tissue,
or reduced ability to replicate compared to the non-attenuated form
thereof. The attenuated microbes provided herein, however, retain at
least some capacity to replicate and to accumulate iron or other
compounds based on the recombinant genes introduced into the genome or
carried on a plasmid, thereby imaging the tumor or causing cell death to
tumor cells.
[0555]i. Reduced Toxicity
[0556]Microbes can be toxic to their hosts by manufacturing one or more
compounds, or scavenging essential nutrients from the host environment,
that worsen the health condition of the host. Toxicity to the host can be
manifested in any of a variety of manners, including, for example, septic
shock. The microbes provided herein can have a reduced toxicity to the
host compared to the wild-type strain of microorganism. The reduced
toxicity of a microbe of the present methods and compositions can range
from a toxicity in which the host experiences no toxic effects, to a
toxicity in which the host does not typically die from the toxic effects
of the microbes. In some embodiments, the microbes are of a reduced
toxicity such that a host typically experiences no significant long-term
effects from the presence of the microbes in the host, beyond any affect
on tumorous, metastatic or necrotic organs or tissues. For example, the
reduced toxicity can be measured as an unintentional decline in body
weight of about 5% or less for the host after administration of the
microbes. In other examples, the microbe has 5%, 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%,
35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95% less
toxicity than wild-type microbe, or no toxicity to the host.
[0557]ii. Accumulate in immunoprivileged cells and tissues, Such as Tumor,
not Substantially in Other Organs
[0558]Microbes can accumulate in any of a variety of tissues and organs of
the host. Accumulation can be evenly distributed over the entire host
organism, or can be concentrated in one or a few organs or tissues. The
microbes provided herein can accumulate in targeted tissues, such as
immunoprivileged cells and tissues, such as tumors and also metastases.
In other embodiments the microbes provided herein exhibit accumulation in
immunoprivileged cells and tissues (such as tumor cells) that is equal to
or greater than the accumulation in any other particular organ or tissue.
For example, the microbes provided herein can demonstrate an accumulation
in immunoprivileged cells and tissues, such as tumor cells that is at
least about 2-fold greater, at least about 5-fold greater, at least about
10-fold greater, at least about 100-fold greater, at least about
1,000-fold greater, at least about 10,000-fold greater, at least about
100,000-fold greater, or at least about 1,000,000-fold greater, than the
accumulation in any other particular organ or tissue.
[0559]In some embodiments, a microbe can accumulate in targeted tissues
and cells, such as immunoprivileged cells and tissues, such as tumor
cells, without accumulating in one or more selected tissues or organs.
For example, a microbe can accumulate in tumors without accumulating in
the brain. In another example, a microbe can accumulate in tumors without
accumulating in neural cells. In another example, a microbe can
accumulate in tumors without accumulating in ovaries. In another example,
a microbe can accumulate in tumors without accumulating in the blood. In
another example, a microbe can accumulate in tumors without accumulating
in the heart. In another example, a microbe can accumulate in tumors
without accumulating in the bladder. In another example, a microbe can
accumulate in tumors without accumulating in testes. In another example,
a microbe can accumulate in tumors without accumulating in the spleen. In
another example, a microbe can accumulate in tumors without accumulating
in the lungs. In another example, a microbe can accumulate in tumors
without accumulating in the pancreas.
[0560]One skilled in the art can determine the desired capability for the
microbes to selectively accumulate in targeted tissue or cells, such as
in a immunoprivileged cells and tissues, such as tumor, rather than
non-target organs or tissues, according to a variety of factors known in
the art, including, but not limited to, toxicity of the microbes, dosage,
tumor to be treated, immunocompetence of host, and disease state of the
host.
[0561]b. Replication Competent
[0562]The microorganisms and cells provided herein can be replication
competent. In a variety of bacterial systems, the administered
microorganism or cell is rendered replication incompetent to limit
pathogenicity risk to the host. While replication incompetence can
protect the host from the microorganism, that also is limits the ability
of the microorganism or cell to infect and kill tumors, and typically
results in only a short-lived effect. In contrast, the microorganisms and
cells provided herein can be attenuated but replication competent,
resulting in low toxicity to the host and accumulation mainly, or solely,
in tumors. Thus, the microorganisms and cells provided herein can be
replication competent without creating a pathogenicity risk to the host.
[0563]Attenuation of the microorganisms and cells provided herein can
include, but not be limited to, reducing the replication competence of
the microorganism. For example, a microorganism or cell can be modified
to decrease or eliminate an activity related to replication, such as a
transcriptional activator or a repressor that regulates replication in
the microorganism. In an example, a microorganism or cell (such as a
bacterium), can carry plasmids, such as pBR322 and ColE1, that are
modified to affect replication and maintenance of the vector in bacteria
based on the early characterization of the molecule, including its
nucleotide sequence, replication and maintenance mechanisms, and
determination of its coding regions (Balbas and Bolivar (2004) Methods
Mol. Biol. 267:77-90; Grabherr and Bayer (2002) Trends Biotechnol.
20(6):257-260; Jung and Lee (1995) Mol. Biol. Rep. 22(2-3):195-200).
[0564]2. Bacteria
[0565]Bacteria can also be used in the methods provided herein. Any of a
variety of bacteria possessing the desired characteristics can be used.
In one embodiment, aerobic bacteria can be used. In another embodiment,
anaerobic bacteria can be used. Exemplary bacteria provided herein
include, for example, Abiotrophia, Acetanaerobacterium, Acetitomaculum,
Acetivibrio, Acetoanaerobium, Acetobacter, Acetobacterium,
Acetofilamentum, Acetogenium, Acetohalobium, Acetomicrobium, Acetonema,
Acetothermus, Acholeplasma, Achromatium, Achromobacter, Acidaminobacter,
Acidaminococcus, Acidimicrobium, Acidiphilium, Acidisphaera,
Acidithiobacillus, Acidobacterium, Acidocella, Acidomonas, Acidothermus,
Acidovorax, Acinetobacter, Acrocarpospora, Actinoalloteichus,
Actinobacillus, Actinobaculum, Actinobispora, Actinocorallia,
Actinokineospora, Actinomadura, Actinomyces, Actinoplanes,
Actinopolymorpha, Actinopolyspora, Actinopycnidium, Actinosporangium,
Actinosynnema, Adhaeribacter, Advenella, Aegyptianella, Aequorivita,
Aeriscardovia, Aerococcus, Aeromicrobium, Aeromonas, Aestuariibacter,
Afipia, Agarivorans, Agitococcus, Agreia, Agrobacterium, Agrococcus,
Agromonas, Agromyces, Ahrensia, Akkermansia, Albibacter, Albidovulum,
Alcaligenes, Alcanivorax, Algibacter, Algicola, Algoriphagus,
Alicycliphilus, Alicyclobacillus, Alishewanella, Alistipes,
Alkalibacillus, Alkalibacter, Alkalibacterium, Alkaliflexus,
Alkalilimnicola, Alkaliphilus, Alkalispirillum, Alkanindiges,
Allisonella, Allochromatium, Allofustis, Alloiococcus, Allomonas,
Allorhizobium, Alterococcus, Alteromonas, Alysiella, Amaricoccus,
Aminobacter, Aminobacterium, Aminomonas, Ammonifex, Ammoniphilus,
Amoebobacter, Amorphosphorangium, Amphibacillus, Ampullariella,
Amycolata, Amycolatopsis, Anaeroarcus, Anaerobacter, Anaerobaculum,
Anaerobiospirillum, Anaerobranca, Anaerococcus, Anaerofilum,
Anaerofustis, Anaeroglobus, Anaerolinea, Anaeromusa, Anaeromyxobacter,
Anaerophaga, Anaeroplasma, Anaerorhabdus, Anaerosinus, Anaerostipes,
Anaerotruncus, Anaerovibrio, Anaerovorax, Anaplasma, Ancalochloris,
Ancalomicrobium, Ancylobacter, Aneurinibacillus, Angiococcus,
Angulomicrobium, Anoxybacillus, Anoxynatronum, Antarctobacter,
Aquabacter, Aquabacterium, Aquamicrobium, Aquaspirillum, Aquicella,
Aquifex, Aquiflexum, Aquimarina, Aquimonas, Arachnia, Arcanobacterium,
Archangium, Arcicella, Arcobacter, Arenibacter, Arhodomonas,
Arsenicicoccus, Arsenophonus, Arthrobacter, Asaia, Asanoa,
Asteroleplasma, Asticcacaulis, Atopobacter, Atopobium, Atopococcus,
Atopostipes, Aurantimonas, Aureobacterium, Avibacterium, Azoarcus,
Azomonas, Azomonotrichon, Azonexus, Azorhizobium, Azorhizophilus,
Azospira, Azospirillum, Azotobacter, Azovibrio, Bacillus, Bacterionema,
Bacteriovorax, Bacteroides, Bactoderma, Balnearium, Balneatrix,
Balneimonas, Bartonella, Bdellovibrio, Beggiatoa, Beijerinckia,
Belliella, Beneckea, Bergeriella, Bergeyella, Beutenbergia,
Bifidobacterium, Bilophila, Bizionia, Blastobacter, Blastochloris,
Blastococcus, Blastomonas, Blastopirellula, Blattabacterium, Bogoriella,
Bordetella, Borrelia, Bosea, Brachybacterium, Brachymonas, Brachyspira,
Brackiella, Bradyrhizobium, Branhamella, Brenneria, Brevibacillus,
Brevibacterium, Brevinema, Brevundimonas, Brochothrix, Brucella,
Brumimicrobium, Bryantella, Buchnera, Budvicia, Bulleidia, Burkholderia,
Buttiauxella, Butyrivibrio, Caedibacter, Caenibacterium,
Caldanaerobacter, Calderobacterium, Caldicellulosiruptor, Caldilinea,
Caldimonas, Caldithrix, Caloramator, Caloranaerobacter,
Calymmatobacterium, Caminibacter, Caminicella, Campylobacter,
Capnocytophaga, Capsularis, Carbophilus, Carboxydibrachium,
Carboxydocella, Carboxydothermus, Cardiobacterium, Carnimonas,
Carnobacterium, Caryophanon, Caseobacter, Catellatospora,
Catellibacterium, Catenibacterium, Catenococcus, Catenuloplanes,
Catonella, Caulobacter, Cedecea, Cellulomonas, Cellulophaga,
Cellulosimicrobium, Cellvibrio, Centipeda, Cerasibacillus, Cetobacterium,
Chainia, Chelatobacter, Chelatococcus, Chitinibacter, Chitinimonas,
Chitinophaga, Chlamydia, Chlamydophila, Chlorobaculum, Chlorobium,
Chloroflexus, Chloroherpeton, Chloronema, Chondromyces, Chromatium,
Chromobacterium, Chromohalobacter, Chryseobacterium, Chryseomonas,
Chrysiogenes, Citricoccus, Citrobacter, Clavibacter, Clevelandina,
Clostridium, Cobetia, Coenonia, Collimonas, Collinsella, Colwellia,
Comamonas, Conchiformibius, Conexibacter, Conglomeromonas, Coprobacillus,
Coprococcus, Coprothermobacter, Coriobacterium, Corynebacterium,
Couchioplanes, Cowdria, Coxiella, Craurococcus, Crenothrix, Cristispira,
Croceibacter, Crocinitomix, Crossiella, Cryobacterium, Cryomorpha,
Cryptanaerobacter, Cryptobacterium, Cryptosporangium, Cupriavidus,
Curtobacterium, Curvibacter, Cyclobacterium, Cycloclasticus, Cystobacter,
Cytophaga, Dactylosporangium, Dechloromonas, Dechlorosoma, Deferribacter,
Defluvibacter, Defluvicoccus, Dehalobacter, Dehalospirillum, Deinobacter,
Deinococcus, Deleya, Delftia, Demetria, Dendrosporobacter,
Denitrobacterium, Denitrovibrio, Dermabacter, Dermacoccus, Dermatophilus,
Derxia, Desemzia, Desulfacinum, Desulfatibacillum, Desulfitobacterium,
Desulfobacca, Desulfobacter, Desulfobacterium, Desulfobacula,
Desulfobulbus, Desulfocapsa, Desulfocella, Desulfococcus, Desulfofaba,
Desulfofrigus, Desulfofustis, Desulfohalobium, Desulfomicrobium,
Desulfomonas, Desulfomonile, Desulfomusa, Desulfonatronovibrio,
Desulfonatronum, Desulfonauticus, Desulfonema, Desulfonispora,
Desulforegula, Desulforhabdus, Desulforhopalus, Desulfosarcina,
Desulfospira, Desulfosporosinus, Desulfotalea, Desulfotignum,
Desulfotomaculum, Desulfovibrio, Desulfovirga, Desulfurella,
Desulfurobacterium, Desulfuromonas, Desulfuromusa, Dethiosulfovibrio,
Devosia, Dialister, Diaphorobacter, Dichelobacter, Dichotomicrobium,
Dickeya, Dictyoglomus, Dietzia, Dinoroseobacter, Diplocalyx,
Dolosicoccus, Dolosigranulum, Dorea, Duganella, Dyadobacter, Dyella,
Dysgonomonas, Ectothiorhodospira, Edwardsiella, Eggerthella, Ehrlichia,
Eikenella, Elizabethkingia, Elytrosporangium, Empedobacter,
Enhydrobacter, Enhygromyxa, Ensifer, Enterobacter, Enterococcus,
Enterovibrio, Entomoplasma, Eperythrozoon, Eremococcus, Erwinia,
Erysipelothrix, Erythrobacter, Erythromicrobium, Erythromonas,
Escherichia, Eubacterium, Ewingella, Excellospora, Exiguobacterium,
Facklamia, Faecalibacterium, Faenia, Falcivibrio, Fastidiosipila,
Ferribacterium, Ferrimonas, Fervidobacterium, Fibrobacter, Filibacter,
Filifactor, Filobacillus, Filomicrobium, Finegoldia, Flammeovirga,
Flavimonas, Flavobacterium, Flectobacillus, Flexibacter, Flexistipes,
Flexithrix, Fluoribacter, Fluviicola, Formivibrio, Formosa, Francisella,
Frankia, Frateuria, Friedmanniella, Frigoribacterium, Fulvimarina,
Fulvimonas, Fundibacter, Fusibacter, Fusobacterium, Gaetbulibacter,
Gallibacterium, Gallicola, Gallionella, Garciella, Gardnerella,
Gelidibacter, Gelria, Gemella, Gemmata, Gemmatimonas, Gemmiger,
Gemmobacter, Geobacillus, Geobacter, Geodermatophilus, Geopsychrobacter,
Georgenia, Geothermobacter, Geothrix, Geotoga, Geovibrio, Gillisia,
Glaciecola, Globicatella, Gluconacetobacter, Gluconobacter, Glycomyces,
Gordonia, Gracilibacillus, Grahamella, Gramella, Granulicatella,
Grimontia, Guggenheimella, Gulosibacter, Haemobartonella, Haemophilus,
Hafnia, Hahella, Halanaerobacter, Halanaerobium, Haliangium,
Haliscomenobacter, Hallella, Halobacillus, Halobacteroides, Halocella,
Halochromatium, Haloincola, Halomonas, Halonatronum, Halorhodospira,
Halospirulina, Halothermothrix, Halothiobacillus, Halovibrio,
Helcococcus, Heliobacillus, Helicobacter, Heliobacterium, Heliophilum,
Heliorestis, Heliothrix, Herbaspirillum, Herbidospora, Herpetosiphon,
Hespellia, Hippea, Hirschia, Histophilus, Hoeflea, Holdemania,
Hollandina, Holophaga, Holospora, Hongia, Hongiella, Hydrocarboniphaga,
Hydrogenimonas, Hydrogenivirga, Hydrogenobacter, Hydrogenobaculum,
Hydrogenophaga, Hydrogenophilus, Hydrogenothermus, Hydrogenovibrio,
Hylemonella, Hymenobacter, Hyphomicrobium, Hyphomonas, Ideonella,
Idiomarina, Ignavigranum, flyobacter, Inquilinus, Intrasporangium,
Iodobacter, Isobaculum, Isochromatium, Isoptericola, Isosphaera,
Janibacter, Jannaschia, Janthinobacterium, Jeotgalibacillus,
Jeotgalicoccus, Jiangella, Johnsonella, Jonesia, Kaistella, Kaistia,
Kangiella, Kerstersia, Ketogulonicigenium, Kibdelosporangium,
Kineococcus, Kineosphaera, Kineosporia, Kingella, Kitasatoa,
Kitasatospora, Klebsiella, Kluyvera, Knoellia, Kocuria, Kordia,
Kordiimonas, Koserella, Kozakia, Kribbella, Kurthia, Kutzneria,
Kytococcus, Labrys, Laceyella, Lachnobacterium, Lachnospira, Lacinutrix,
Lactobacillus, Lactococcus, Lactosphaera, Lactovum, Lamprobacter,
Lamprocystis, Lampropedia, Laribacter, Lautropia, Lawsonia, Lebetimonas,
Lechevalieria, Leclercia, Leeuwenhoekiella, Legionella, Leifsonia,
Leisingera, Leminorella, Lentibacillus, Lentisphaera, Lentzea, Leptonema,
Leptospira, Leptospirillum, Leptothrix, Leptotrichia, Leucobacter,
Leuconostoc, Leucothrix, Levinea, Lewinella, Limnobacter, Listeria,
Listonella, Loktanella, Lonepinella, Longispora, Lucibacterium,
Luteimonas, Luteococcus, Lysobacter, Lyticum, Macrococcus, Macromonas,
Magnetospirillum, Mahella, Malikia, Malonomonas, Mannheimia, Maribacter,
Maricaulis, Marichromatium, Marinibacillus, Marinicola, Marinilabilia,
Marinilactibacillus, Marinithernus, Marinitoga, Marinobacter,
Marinobacterium, Marinococcus, Marinomonas, Marinospirillum, Marmoricola,
Martelella, Massilia, Megamonas, Megasphaera, Meiothermus, Melissococcus,
Melittangium, Meniscus, Mesonia, Mesophilobacter, Mesoplasma,
Mesorhizobium, Methylarcula, Methylobacillus, Methylobacter,
Methylobacterium, Methylocaldum, Methylocapsa, Methylocella,
Methylococcus, Methylocystis, Methylohalobius, Methylomicrobium,
Methylomonas, Methylophaga, Methylophilus, Methylopila, Methylorhabdus,
Methylosarcina, Methylosinus, Methylosphaera, Methylothermus,
Methylovorus, Micavibrio, Microbacterium, Microbispora, Microbulbifer,
Microcella, Micrococcus, Microcyclus, Microellobosporia, Microlunatus,
Micromonas, Micromonospora, Micropolyspora, Micropruina, Microscilla,
Microsphaera, Microtetraspora, Microvirga, Microvirgula, Mitsuaria,
Mitsuokella, Mobiluncus, Modestobacter, Moellerella, Mogibacterium,
Moorella, Moraxella, Morganella, Moritella, Morococcus, Mucispirillum,
Muricauda, Muricoccus, Myceligenerans, Mycetocola, Mycobacterium,
Mycoplana, Mycoplasma, Myroides, Myxococcus, Nakamurella, Nannocystis,
Natroniella, Natronincola, Nautilia, Naxibacter, Neisseria, Neochlamydia,
Neorickettsia, Neptunomonas, Nereida, Nesterenkonia, Nevskia,
Nicoletella, Nitratifractor, Nitratireductor, Nitratiruptor, Nitrobacter,
Nitrococcus, Nitrosococcus, Nitrosolobus, Nitrosomonas, Nitrosospira,
Nitrospina, Nitrospira, Nocardia, Nocardioides, Nocardiopsis, Nonomuraea,
Novosphingobium, Obesumbacterium, Oceanibulbus, Oceanicaulis, Oceanicola,
Oceanimonas, Oceanisphaera, Oceanithemmus, Oceanobacillus, Oceanobacter,
Oceanospirillum, Ochrobactrum, Octadecabacter, Oenococcus, Oerskovia,
Okibacterium, Oleiphilus, Oleispira, Oligella, Oligotropha, Olleya,
Olsenella, Opitutus, Orenia, Oribacterium, Oribaculum, Orientia,
Ornithinicoccus, Ornithinimicrobium, Ornithobacterium, Oscillochloris,
Oscillospira, Ottowia, Owenweeksia, Oxalicibacterium, Oxalobacter,
Oxalophagus, Oxobacter, Paenibacillus, Pandoraea, Pannonibacter, Pantoea,
Papillibacter, Parachlamydia, Paracoccus, Paracraurococcus,
Paralactobacillus, Paraliobacillus, Parascardovia, Parasporobacterium,
Parvibaculum, Parvularcula, Pasteurella, Pasteuria, Paucibacter,
Paucimonas, Pectinatus, Pectobacterium, Pediococcus, Pedobacter,
Pedomicrobium, Pelczaria, Pelistega, Pelobacter, Pelodictyon, Pelospora,
Pelotomaculum, Peptococcus, Peptoniphilus, Peptostreptococcus,
Peredibacter, Persephonella, Persicobacter, Petrimonas, Petrobacter,
Petrotoga, Pfennigia, Phaeospirillum, Phascolarctobacterium,
Phenylobacterium, Phocoenobacter, Photobacterium, Photorhabdus,
Phyllobacterium, Pibocella, Pigmentiphaga, Pilimelia, Pillotina,
Pimelobacter, Pirella, Pirellula, Piscirickettsia, Planctomyces,
Planifilum, Planktothricoides, Planobispora, Planococcus, Planomicrobium,
Planomonospora, Planopolyspora, Planotetraspora, Plantibacter,
Pleomorphomonas, Plesiocystis, Plesiomonas, Polaribacter, Polaromonas,
Polyangium, Polynucleobacter, Pontibacillus, Porphyrobacter,
Porphyromonas, Pragia, Prauserella, Prevotella, Prochlorococcus,
Prochloron, Prochlorothrix, Prolinoborus, Promicromonospora,
Propionibacter, Propionibacterium, Propionicimonas, Propioniferax,
Propionigenium, Propionimicrobium, Propionispira, Propionispora,
Propionivibrio, Prosthecobacter, Prosthecochloris, Prosthecomicrobium,
Proteus, Protomonas, Providencia, Pseudaminobacter, Pseudoalteromonas,
Pseudoamycolata, Pseudobutyrivibrio, Pseudocaedibacter,
Pseudoclavibacter, Pseudomonas, Pseudonocardia, Pseudoramibacter,
Pseudorhodobacter, Pseudospirillum, Pseudovibrio, Pseudoxanthomonas,
Psychrobacter, Psychroflexus, Psychromonas, Psychroserpens, Pusillimonas,
Quadricoccus, Quadrisphaera, Quinella, Rahnella, Ralstonia, Ramlibacter,
Raoultella, Rarobacter, Rathayibacter, Reichenbachia, Reinekea,
Renibacterium, Rhabdochromatium, Rheinheimera, Rhizobacter, Rhizobium,
Rhizomonas, Rhodanobacter, Rhodobaca, Rhodobacter, Rhodobium,
Rhodoblastus, Rhodocista, Rhodococcus, Rhodocyclus, Rhodoferax,
Rhodoglobus, Rhodomicrobium, Rhodopila, Rhodopirellula, Rhodoplanes,
Rhodopseudomonas, Rhodospira, Rhodospirillum, Rhodothalassium,
Rhodothermus, Rhodovarius, Rhodovibrio, Rhodovulum, Rickettsia,
Rickettsiella, Riemerella, Rikenella, Robiginitalea, Rochalimaea,
Roseateles, Roseburia, Roseibium, Roseicyclus, Roseiflexus,
Roseinatronobacter, Roseisalinus, Roseivirga, Roseivivax, Roseobacter,
Roseococcus, Roseomonas, Roseospira, Roseospirillum, Roseovarius, Rothia,
Rubrimonas, Rubritepida, Rubrivivax, Rubrobacter, Ruegeria, Rugamonas,
Ruminobacter, Ruminococcus, Runella, Saccharibacter, Saccharobacter,
Saccharococcus, Saccharomonospora, Saccharophagus, Saccharopolyspora,
Saccharospirillum, Saccharothrix, Sagittula, Salana, Salegentibacter,
Salibacillus, Salinibacillus, Salinibacter, Salinibacterium,
Salinicoccus, Salinimonas, Salinisphaera, Salinispora, Salinivibrio,
Salipiger, Salmonella, Samsonia, Sandaracinobacter, Sanguibacter,
Saprospira, Sarcina, Sarcobium, Scardovia, Schineria, Schlegelella,
Schwartzia, Sebaldella, Sedimentibacter, Segniliparus, Seinonella,
Sejongia, Selenihalanaerobacter, Selenomonas, Seliberia, Serinicoccus,
Serpens, Serpula, Serpulina, Serratia, Shewanella, Shigella,
Shuttleworthia, Silanimonas, Silicibacter, Simkania, Simonsiella,
Sinorhizobium, Skermanella, Skermania, Slackia, Smithella, Sneathia,
Sodalis, Soehngenia, Solirubrobacter, Solobacterium, Sphaerobacter,
Sphaerotilus, Sphingobacterium, Sphingobium, Sphingomonas, Sphingopyxis,
Spirilliplanes, Spirillospora, Spirillum, Spirochaeta, Spiroplasma,
Spirosoma, Sporanaerobacter, Sporichthya, Sporobacter, Sporobacterium,
Sporocytophaga, Sporohalobacter, Sporolactobacillus, Sporomusa,
Sporosarcina, Sporotomaculum, Stackebrandtia, Staleya, Stanierella,
Staphylococcus, Stappia, Starkeya, Stella, Stenotrophomonas,
Sterolibacterium, Stibiobacter, Stigmatella, Stomatococcus,
Streptacidiphilus, Streptoalloteichus, Streptobacillus, Streptococcus,
Streptomonospora, Streptomyces, Streptosporangium, Streptoverticillium,
Subdoligranulum, Subsaxibacter, Subsaximicrobium, Subtercola,
Succiniclasticum, Succinimonas, Succinispira, Succinivibrio,
Sulfitobacter, Sulfobacillus, Sulfuricurvum, Sulfurihydrogenibium,
Sulfurimonas, Sulfurospirillum, Sulfurovum, Sutterella, Suttonella,
Swaminathania, Symbiobacterium, Symbiotes, Synergistes, Syntrophobacter,
Syntrophobotulus, Syntrophococcus, Syntrophomonas, Syntrophosphora,
Syntrophothermus, Syntrophus, Tannerella, Tatlockia, Tatumella,
Taylorella, Tectibacter, Teichococcus, Telluria, Tenacibaculum,
Tenuibacillus, Tepidibacter, Tepidimonas, Tepidiphilus, Terasakiella,
Teredinibacter, Terrabacter, Terracoccus, Tessaracoccus, Tetragenococcus,
Tetrasphaera, Tetrathiobacter, Thalassobacillus, Thalassobacter,
Thalassolituus, Thalassomonas, Thalassospira, Thauera, Thermacetogenium,
Thermaerobacter, Thermanaeromonas, Thermanaerovibrio, Thermicanus,
Thermincola, Thermithiobacillus, Thermoactinomyces, Thermoanaerobacter,
Thermoanaerobacterium, Thermoanaerobium, Thermobacillus,
Thermobacteroides, Thermobifida, Thermobispora, Thermobrachium,
Thermochromatium, Thermocrinis, Thermocrispum, Thermodesulfatator,
Thermodesulfobacterium, Thermodesulfobium, Thermodesulforhabdus,
Thermodesulfovibrio, Thermoflavimicrobium, Thermohalobacter,
Thermohydrogenium, Thermoleophilum, Thermomicrobium, Thermomonas,
Thermomonospora, Thermonema, Thermopolyspora, Thermosinus, Thermosipho,
Thermosyntropha, Thermoterrabacterium, Thermothrix, Thermotoga,
Thermovenabulum, Thermovibrio, Thermus, Thioalkalicoccus,
Thioalkalimicrobium, Thioalkalispira, Thioalkalivibrio, Thiobaca,
Thiobacillus, Thiobacter, Thiobacterium, Thiocapsa, Thioclava,
Thiococcus, Thiocystis, Thiodictyon, Thioflavicoccus, Thiohalocapsa,
Thiolamprovum, Thiomargarita, Thiomicrospira, Thiomonas, Thiopedia,
Thioploca, Thioreductor, Thiorhodococcus, Thiorhodospira,
Thiorhodovibrio, Thiosphaera, Thiospira, Thiospirillum, Thiothrix,
Thiovirga, Thiovulum, Tindallia, Tissierella, Tistrella, Tolumonas,
Toxothrix, Trabulsiella, Treponema, Trichlorobacter, Trichococcus,
Tropheryma, Truepera, Tsukamurella, Turicella, Turicibacter, Turneriella,
Ulvibacter, Ureaplasma, Ureibacillus, Uruburuella, Vagococcus,
Vampirovibrio, Varibaculum, Variovorax, Veillonella, Verrucomicrobium,
Verrucosispora, Vibrio, Victivallis, Virgibacillus, Virgisporangium,
Virgosporangium, Vitellibacter, Vitreoscilla, Vogesella, Volcaniella,
Volucribacter, Vulcanithermus, Waddlia, Wautersia, Weeksella, Weissella,
Wigglesworthia, Williamsia, Winogradskyella, Wolbachia, Wolinella,
Woodsholea, Xanthobacter, Xanthomonas, Xenophilus, Xenorhabdus,
Xylanibacterium, Xylanimicrobium, Xylanimonas, Xylella, Xylophilus,
Yania, Yersinia, Yokenella, Zavarzinia, Zimmermannella, Zobellia,
Zoogloea, Zooshikella, Zymobacter, Zymomonas
, and Zymophilus.
[0566]An exemplary Escherichia coli strain provided herein includes Nissle
1917 strain.
[0567]Exemplary Bacteroides species include strains of Bacteroides ovatus,
Bacteroides thetaiotaomicron, Bacteroides fragilis, Bacteroides vulgatus,
or Bacteroides gracilis. Exemplary Eubacterium species include strains of
Eubacterium limosum, Eubacterium aerofaciens (aka Collinsella
aerofaciens), Eubacterium rectale or Eubacterium cylindroids. Exemplary
Streptococcus species include strains of Streptococcus mitis,
Streptococcus gordonii, Streptococcus bralis, Streptococcus salivarius,
Streptococcus sanguis or Streptococcus mutans. Exemplary of Actinomyces
species include strains of Actinomyces naeslundii, Actinomyces viscosus
or Actinomyces odontolyticus. Exemplary Veillonella species include
strains of Veillonella parvula, Veillonella dispar or Veillonella
atypical. Exemplary of Nesseria species include strains of Nesseria
cinerea, Nesseria mucosa, Nesseria elongate, Nesseriaflava, Nesseria
subflava, Nesseria flavescens, Nesseria sicca, Nesseria lactamica,
Nesseria polysacchareae or Nesseria kochii. Exemplary of Prevotella
species include strains of Prevotella denticola, Prevotella dentalis,
Prevotella buccalis, or Prevotella loeschii. Exemplary of Campylobacter
species include strains of Campylobacter concisus, Campylobacter curvus
or Campylobacter showae. Exemplary of Fusobacterium species include
strains of Fusobacterium nucleatum or Fusobacterium periodonticum.
Exemplary of Eikenella species include strains of Eikenella corrodens.
Exemplary of Porphyromonas species include strains of Porphyromonas
gingivalis. Exemplary of Propionibacteria species include strains of
Propionibacteria acnes, Propionibacteria freudenreichii.
[0568]In some embodiments, the bacteria provided herein can be
extracellular bacteria. A variety of extracellular bacteria are known in
the art and include Vibrio species, Lactobacillus species, Streptococcus
species and a variety of Escherichia species. Exemplary bacteria include
Vibrio cholerae, Streptococcus pyrogenes and a variety of Escherichia
coli strains.
[0569]In other embodiments, the bacteria provided herein can be
intracellular bacteria. A variety of facultative intracellular bacteria
are known in the art and include Listeria species, Salmonella species,
Shigella species, Rickettsiae species, Chlamydia species, Coxiella
species, Mycobacterium species, Mycoplasma species, Yersinia pestis,
Neisseria species, Bordetella species, Legionella species, Brucella
species and enteroinvasive Escherichia coli strains. Exemplary
intracellular bacteria include, but are not limited to, Listeria
monocytogenes, Salmonella typhimurium, Shigella flexneri, Rickettsia
conorii, Rickettsia prowazekii, Clostridium piliform, Chlamydia
trachomatis, Chlamydia muridaru, Coxiella burnetii, Mycobacterium leprae,
Mycoplasma penetrans, Yersinia pestis, Neisseria gonorrhoeae, Bordetella
pertussis, Legionella pneumophila, Brucella melitensis, and Escherichia
coli 0157.
[0570]Additional bacteria include plant bacteria such as Clavibacter
michiganensis subsp. michiganensis, Agrobacterium tumefaciens, Erwinia
herbicola, Azorhizobium caulinodans, Xanthomonas campestris pv.
vesicatoria, and Xanthomonas campestris pv. campestris.
[0571]Also provided herein are modifications of bacteria to enhance one or
more characteristics relative to the wild-type bacteria. Such
characteristics can include, but are not limited to, attenuated
pathogenicity, reduced toxicity, preferential accumulation in tumor,
increased ability to activate an immune response against tumor cells,
increased immunogenicity, increased or decreased replication competence,
and the ability to express exogenous proteins, and combinations thereof.
In other embodiments, the bacteria can be modified to express one or more
detectable genes, including genes that can be used for imaging. In some
embodiments, the modified bacteria have an ability to activate an immune
response against tumor cells without aggressively killing the tumor
cells. In other embodiments, the bacteria can be modified to express one
or more genes for harvesting the gene products and/or for harvesting
antibodies against the gene products. The tumor-colonizing capability of
a variety of bacteria can be directly measured by injecting bacteria into
appropriate tumor-bearing animal models and the tumors assessed for
colonization. Additionally, specificity of the bacteria to localize to
the tumors compared to non-tumorous tissues can be measured.
[0572]a. Aerobic Bacteria
[0573]Previous studies have postulated that anaerobic bacteria are
preferred for administration to tumors (Lemmon et al. (1997) Gene Therapy
4:791-796). Previous studies have shown that aerobic bacteria can survive
and grow in tumors (See co-pending U.S. application Ser. Nos. 11/238,025,
10/872,156 and 10/866,606). Accordingly, a bacteria used in the methods
provided herein can include a bacteria that can survive and grow in an
oxygenated environment. In some embodiments, the bacteria must be in an
oxygenated environment in order to survive and grow. In other
embodiments, the bacteria prefer an oxygenated environment to grow but
can survive and grow in an oxygen-free environment, facultative
anaerobic.
[0574]A variety of aerobic bacteria, some of which are facultative
anaerobes, are known in the art and include, but are not limited to
Vibrio species, Streptococcus species, Listeria species, Salmonella
species, Lactobacillus species, Bacillus species, Pseudomonas species,
and Escherichia species. Exemplary bacteria include, but are not limited
to Vibrio cholerae, V. cholerae strain CVD-HgR, Streptococcus pyogenes,
Streptococcus mitis, Streptococcus gordonii, Streptococcus oralis,
Streptococcus salivarius, Streptococcus sanguis Streptococcus mutans,
Escherichia coli, Listeria monocytogenes, Salmonella typhimurium,
Lactobacillus gasseri, Lactobacillus reuteri, Lactobacillus ruminis, and
Lactobacillus salivarius, Bacillus subtilis, Shigella flexneri,
Pseudomoas fluorescens, Pseudomonas putida, and enterovasive E. coli
(EIEC). Exemplary E. coli strains include, for example, E. coli strain
DH5.alpha., E. coli Top10, E. coli MACH-1 and E. coli OMNIMAX.
[0575]A further example of aerobic bacteria, some of which are facultative
anaerobes, provided herein are probiotic bacteria. Exemplary probiotic
microorganisms include, but are not limited to, Streptococcus species,
including Streptococcus thermolphilus, Bacillus species, including
Bacillus cereus, Bacillus licheniformis, Bacillus pumilus, Bacillus
clausii, Bacillus coagulans, Bacillus polyfermenticus, Brevibacillus
species, including Brevibacillus brevis laterosporus, Lactococcus
species, including Lactococcus lactis, Lactobacillus species, including
Lactobacillus acidophilus, Lactobacillus amylovorus, Lactobacillus
bifidum, Lactobacillus casei, Lactobacillus crispatus, Lactobacillus
fermentum, Lactobacillus gallinarum, Lactobacillus gasseri, Lactobacillus
helveticus, Lactobacillus johnsonii, Lactobacillus lactis, Lactobacillus
paracasei, Lactobacillus plantarum, Lactobacillus reuteri, Lactobacillus
rhamnosus, Lactobacillus salivarius, Escherichia species, including E.
coli strain Nissle 1917 ("Nissle;" Schultz et al. (2005) J. Microbiol.
Methods 61(3):389-398) and other examples, such as Leuconostoc
mesenteroides, Enterococcus faecium, Pediococcus acidilactici, and
Sporolactobacillus inulinus.
[0576]E. coli strain Nissle 1917 lacks defined virulence factors such as
alpha-hemolysin and other toxins, mannose-resistant hemagglutinating
adhesins, P-fimbrial adhesins, and the semi-rough lipopolysaccharide
phenotype (Blum et al. (1996) Infection. 23(4):234-236). The unique LPS
structure furthermore contributes to its decreased immunotoxicity while
maintaining serum sensitivity. Serum sensitivity can contribute to
selective colonization of Nissle 1917 in immunoprivileged areas such as
tumors, since the bacteria would colonize those sites, such as tumors
which are sequestered from the immune system. Nissle 1917 possesses
enhanced fitness properties in part due to the expression of at least six
different iron uptake systems, including siderophores such as aerobactin,
salmochelin, enterobactin and yersiniabactin; chu heme transport locus
and a ferric dicitrate transport system. The lack of pathogenicity and
probiotic properties have lead to its use for the treatment of gut
disorders, such as ulcerative colitis, chronic constipation, Crohn's
disease, pouchitis, irritable bowel syndrome, and other forms of colitis
and gut perturbations.
[0577]b. Anaerobic Bacteria
[0578]A bacteria used in the methods provided herein can include a
bacteria that does not require oxygen to survive and grow. In some
embodiments, the bacteria must be in an oxygen-free environment in order
to survive and grow. In other embodiments, the bacteria prefer an
oxygen-free environment to grow but can survive and grow in an oxygenated
environment, facultative anaerobic.
[0579]A variety of anaerobic bacteria are known in the art, including
Clostridium species, Bifodobacterium species and Staphylococcus species.
Exemplary anaerobic bacteria include Clostridium histolyticum,
Clostridium butyricum, Clostridium novyi, Clostridium sordellii,
Clostridium absonum, Clostridium bifermentans, Clostridium difficile,
Clostridium histolyticum, Clostridium perfringens, Clostridium
beijerinckii, Clostridium sporogenes, Clostridium butyricum,
Bifodobacterium adolescentis, Bifidobacterium adolescentis,
Bifidobacterium bifidum, Bifidobacterium infantis, Bifidobacterium
laterosporus, Bifodobacterium longum, Bifidobacterium animalis,
Staphylococcus aureus, Staphylococcus epidermidis, Actinomyces israelii,
Eubacterium lentum, Peptostreptococcus anaerobis, Peptococcus prevotti,
and Acidaminococcus fermentans.
[0580]A further example of anaerobic bacteria provided herein are
probiotic bacteria. Exemplary probiotic microorganisms include, but are
not limited to Bifodobacterium species, including Bifodobacterium breve,
Bifodobacterium lactus, Bifodobacterium longum and Bifidobacterium
bifidum, and Clostridium species, including Clostridium butyricum.
[0581]A further example of anaerobic bacteria provided herein are other
intestinal flora bacteria, including but not limited to, Bacteroides
species, including Bacteroides ovatus, Bacteroides thetaiotaomicron,
Bacteroides fragilis, Bacteroides vulgatus, or Bacteroides gracilis,
Eubacterium species, including Eubacterium limosum, Eubacterium
aerofaciens (aka Collinsella aerofaciens), Eubacterium rectale or
Eubacterium cylindroids.
[0582]A further example of anaerobic bacteria provided herein is magnetic
bacteria. Such bacteria allow tumor detection through the accumulation of
iron-based contrast agents. Magnetic bacteria can be isolated from fresh
and marine sediments. Magnetic bacteria can produce magnetic particles
(Fe.sub.3O.sub.4; Blakemore (1982) Annu. Rev. Microbiol. 36:217-238). To
do so, the magnetic bacteria have efficient iron uptake systems, which
allow them to use both insoluble and soluble forms of iron.
Magnetospirillum magnetic AMB-1 is an example of such magnetic bacteria
that has been isolated and cultured for magnetic particle production
(Yang et al. (2001) Enzyme Microb. Technol. 29:13-19). As provided
herein, these magnetic bacteria (naturally occurring or genetically
modified, including modification of gene(s) that limit growth conditions,
e.g., temperature restriction), when injected intravenously, can
selectively accumulate in tumor. Accordingly, these bacteria can be used
for accumulating iron-based contrast agents in the tumors, which in turn
allows tumor detection by MRI. Similarly, other naturally isolated metal
accumulating strains of bacteria can be used for enrichment of bacterial
strains, tumor targeting, absorption of metals from contrast agents,
tumor imaging, tumor therapy or a combination thereof. Alternatively,
metal acquisition systems of metal accumulating strains of bacteria can
be transferred to other bacteria.
[0583]3. Viruses
[0584]Exemplary microorganisms provided herein include viruses. Such
viruses typically have one or more of the microorganism characteristics
provided herein. For example, viruses provided herein can have attenuated
pathogenicity, reduced toxicity, preferential accumulation in
immunoprivileged cells and tissues, such as tumor, the ability to
activate an immune response against tumor cells, immunogenicity,
replication competence, the ability to express exogenous proteins, and
combinations thereof. In some embodiments, the viruses have an ability to
activate an immune response against tumor cells without aggressively
killing the tumor cells. In other embodiments, the viruses can be
modified to express one or more detectable genes, including genes that
can be used for imaging. In other embodiments, the viruses can be
modified to express one or more genes for harvesting the gene products
and/or for harvesting antibodies against the gene products.
[0585]The viruses provided herein can be cytoplasmic viruses, such as
poxviruses, or can be nuclear viruses such as adenoviruses. The viruses
provided herein can have as part of their life cycle lysis of the host
cell's plasma membrane. Alternatively, the viruses provided herein can
have as part of their life cycle exit of the host cell by non-lytic
pathways such as budding or exocytosis. In one embodiment, the viruses
cause lysis or apoptosis of the virus-infected tumor cells.
Alternatively, the viruses provided herein can cause a host organism to
develop an immune response to virus-infected tumor cells as a result of
lysis or apoptosis induced as part of the viral life cycle. The viruses
provided herein also can be genetically engineered to cause a host
organism to develop an immune response to virus-infected tumor cells,
regardless of whether or not lysis or apoptosis is induced as part of the
viral life cycle. In some embodiments, the viruses provided herein can
cause the host organism to mount an immune response against tumor cells
without lysing or causing cell death of the tumor cells.
[0586]One skilled in the art can select from any of a variety of viruses,
according to a variety of factors, including, but not limited to, the
intended use of the virus (e.g., exogenous protein production, antibody
production or tumor therapy), the host organism, and the type of tumor.
[0587]a. Cytoplasmic Viruses
[0588]The viruses provided herein can be cytoplasmic viruses, where the
life cycle of the virus does not require entry of viral nucleic acid
molecules in to the nucleus of the host cell. A variety of cytoplasmic
viruses are known, including, but not limited to, pox viruses, African
swine flu family viruses, and various RNA viruses such as picorna
viruses, calici viruses, toga viruses, corona viruses and rhabdo viruses.
In some embodiments, viral nucleic acid molecules do not enter the host
cell nucleus throughout the viral life cycle. In other embodiments, the
viral life cycle can be performed without use of host cell nuclear
proteins. In other embodiments, the virulence or pathogenicity of the
virus can be modulated by modulating the activity of one or more viral
proteins involved in viral replication.
[0589]i. Poxviruses
[0590]In one embodiment, the virus provided herein is selected from the
pox virus family. Pox viruses include Chordopoxyirinae such as
orthopoxvirus, parapoxvirus, avipoxvirus, capripoxvirus, leporipoxvirus,
suipoxvirus, molluscipoxvirus and yatapoxvirus, as well as
Entomopoxyirinae such as entomopoxvirus A, entomopoxvirus B, and
entomopoxvirus A. Chordopoxyirinae are vertebrate poxviruses and have
similar antigenicities, morphologies and host ranges; thus, any of a
variety of such poxviruses can be used herein. One skilled in the art can
select a particular genera or individual chordopoxyirinae according to
the known properties of the genera or individual virus, and according to
the selected characteristics of the virus (e.g., pathogenicity, ability
to elicit and immune response, preferential tumor localization), the
intended use of the virus, the tumor type and the host organism.
Exemplary chordopoxyirinae genera are orthopoxvirus and avipoxvirus.
[0591]Avipoxviruses are known to infect a variety of different birds and
have been administered to humans. Exemplary avipoxviruses include
canarypox, fowlpox, juncopox, mynahpox, pigeonpox, psittacinepox,
quailpox, peacockpox, penguinpox, sparrowpox, starlingpox and turkeypox
viruses.
[0592]Orthopoxviruses are known to infect a variety of different mammals
including rodents, domesticated animals, primates and humans. Several
orthopoxviruses have a broad host range, while others have narrower host
range. Exemplary orthopoxviruses include buffalopox, camelpox, cowpox,
ectromelia, monkeypox, raccoon pox, skunk pox, tatera pox, uasin gishu,
vaccinia, variola and volepox viruses. In some embodiments, the
orthopoxvirus selected can be an orthopoxvirus known to infect humans,
such as cowpox, monkeypox or vaccinia virus. Optionally, the
orthopoxvirus known to infect humans can be selected from the group of
orthopoxviruses with a broad host range, such as cowpox, monkeypox or
vaccinia virus.
[0593](a) Vaccinia Virus
[0594]One exemplary orthopoxvirus is vaccinia virus. A variety of vaccinia
virus strains are available, including Western Reserve (WR), Copenhagen,
Tashkent, Tian Tan, Lister, Wyeth, IHD-J, and IHD-W, Brighton, Ankara,
MVA, Dairen I, L-IPV, LC16M8, LC16MO, LIVP, WR 65-16, Connaught, New York
City Board of Health. Exemplary vaccinia viruses are Lister or LIVP
vaccinia viruses, or any known vaccinia virus or modifications thereof
that correspond to those provided herein or known to those of skill in
the art to reduce toxicity of a vaccinia virus. Generally, however, the
mutation will be a multiple mutant and the virus will be further selected
to reduce toxicity.
[0595]The linear dsDNA viral genome of vaccinia virus is approximately 200
kb in size, encoding a total of approximately 200 potential genes. Viral
gene expression can be divided into three stages. In the early stage,
gene expression is mainly for viral replication, and for defense against
the host's immune system. In the intermediate stage, genes not available
for expression in the early stage can be expressed, including late stage
transactivators. In the late stage, active transcription is mainly for
viral structural components for building mature viruses.
[0596]Vaccinia virus possesses a variety of features for use in cancer
gene therapy and vaccination. It has a broad host and cell type range.
Vaccinia is a cytoplasmic virus, thus, it does not insert its genome into
the host genome during its life cycle. Unlike many other viruses that
require the host's transcription machinery, vaccinia virus can support
its own gene expression in the host cell cytoplasm using enzymes encoded
in the viral genome. The vaccinia virus genome has a large carrying
capacity for foreign genes, where up to 25 kb of exogenous DNA fragments
(approximately 12% of the vaccinia genome size) can be inserted. The
genomes of several of the vaccinia strains have been completely
sequenced, and many essential and nonessential genes identified. Due to
high sequence homology among different strains, genomic information from
one vaccinia strain can be used for designing and generating modified
viruses in other strains. Finally, the techniques for production of
modified vaccinia strains by genetic engineering are well established
(Moss (1993) Curr. Opin. Genet. Dev. 3:86-90; Broder and Earl (1999) Mol.
Biotechnol. 13:223-245; Timiryasova et al. (2001) Biotechniques
31:534-540).
[0597]Historically, vaccinia virus was used to immunize against smallpox
infection. More recently, modified vaccinia viruses are being developed
as vaccines to combat a variety of diseases. Attenuated vaccinia virus
can trigger a cell-mediated immune response. Strategies such as
prime/boost vaccination, vaccination with non-replicating vaccinia virus
or a combination of these strategies, have shown promising results for
the development of safe and effective vaccination protocols. Mutant
vaccinia viruses from previous studies exhibit a variety of shortcomings,
including a lack of efficient delivery of the viral vehicle to the
desired tissue only (e.g., specific accumulation in a tumors), a lack of
safety because of possible serious complications (e.g., in young
children, eczema vaccinatum and encephalitis, and in adults disseminated
or progressive vaccinia can result if the individual is severely
immunodeficient).
[0598](b) Modified Vaccinia Viruses
[0599]Provided herein are vaccinia viruses with insertions, mutations or
deletions, as described more generally elsewhere herein. The vaccinia
viruses are modified or selected to have low toxicity and to accumulate
in the target tissue. Exemplary of such viruses are those from the LIVP
strain.
[0600]Exemplary insertions, mutations or deletions are those that result
in an attenuated vaccinia virus relative to the wild type strain. For
example, vaccinia virus insertions, mutations or deletions can decrease
pathogenicity of the vaccinia virus, for example, by reducing the
toxicity, reducing the infectivity, reducing the ability to replicate or
reducing the number of non-tumor organs or tissues to which the vaccinia
virus can accumulate. Other exemplary insertions, mutations or deletions
include, but are not limited to, those that increase or decrease
antigenicity of the microorganism, those that permit detection or
imaging, those that increase toxicity of the microorganism (optionally,
controlled by an inducible promoter). For example, modifications can be
made in genes that are involved in nucleotide metabolism, host
interactions and virus formation. Any of a variety of insertions,
mutations or deletions of the vaccinia virus known in the art can be used
herein, including, but not limited to, insertions, mutations or deletions
of the thymidine kinase (TK) gene, the hemagglutinin (HA) gene, the VGF
gene (as taught in U.S. Pat. Pub. No. 2003/0031681); a hemorrhagic region
or an A type inclusion body region (as taught in U.S. Pat. No.
6,596,279); Hind III F, F13L, or Hind III M (as taught in U.S. Pat. No.
6,548,068); A33R, A34R, A36R or B5R genes (see, e.g., Katz et al. (2003)
J. Virology 77:12266-12275); SalF7L (see, e.g., Moore et al. (1992) EMBO
J. 11:1973-1980); N1L (see, e.g., Kotwal et al. (1989) Virology
171:579-587); M1 lambda (see, e.g., Child et al. (1990) Virology.
174:625-629); HR, HindIII-MK, HindIII-MKF, HindIII-CNM, RR, or BamF (see,
e.g., Lee et al. (1992) J. Virol. 66:2617-2630); C21L (see, e.g., Isaacs
et al. (1992) PNAS U.S.A; 89:628-632); or F14.5L (also known as F3 locus
see e.g., U.S. Pat. Pub. No. 2005-0031643-A1, SEQ ID NOS:44 (nucleotide)
and 45 (amino acid translation)).
[0601]The viruses provided herein also can contain two or more insertions,
mutations or deletions. Thus, included are vaccinia viruses containing
two or more insertions, mutations or deletions of the loci provided
herein or other loci known in the art.
[0602](c) The Lister Strain
[0603]In another embodiment, the viruses and methods provided herein can
be based on modifications to the Lister strain of vaccinia virus. Lister
(also referred to as Elstree) vaccinia virus is available from any of a
variety of sources. For example, the Elstree vaccinia virus is available
at the ATCC under Accession Number VR-1549. The Lister vaccinia strain
has high transduction efficiency in tumor cells with high levels of gene
expression. The LIVP strain has a reduced pathogenicity while maintaining
a high transduction efficiency. For example, as provided herein,
F3-interrupted modified LIVP vaccinia virus can selectively replicate in
tumor cells in vivo.
[0604]In one embodiment, the Lister strain can be an attenuated Lister
strain, such as the LIVP (Lister virus from the Institute of Viral
Preparations, Moscow, Russia) strain, which was produced by further
attenuation of the Lister strain. The LIVP strain was used for
vaccination throughout the world, particularly in India and Russia, and
is widely available and the sequence of nucleotides encoding the LIVP
strain is set forth in SEQ ID NO:47.
[0605]ii. Other Cytoplasmic Viruses
[0606]Also provided herein are cytoplasmic viruses that are not
poxviruses. Cytoplasmic viruses can replicate without introducing viral
nucleic acid molecules into the nucleus of the host cell. A variety of
such cytoplasmic viruses are known in the art, and include African swine
flu family viruses and various RNA viruses such as arenaviruses,
picornaviruses, caliciviruses, togaviruses, coronaviruses,
paramyxoviruses, flaviviruses, reoviruses, and rhaboviruses. Exemplary
togaviruses include Sindbis viruses. Exemplary arenaviruses include
lymphocytic choriomeningitis virus. Exemplary rhaboviruses include
vesicular stomatitis viruses. Exemplary paramyxo viruses include
Newcastle Disease viruses and measles viruses. Exemplary picornaviruses
include polio viruses, bovine enteroviruses and rhinoviruses. Exemplary
flaviviruses include Yellow fever virus; attenuated Yellow fever viruses
are known in the art, as exemplified in Barrett et al. (1997) Biologicals
25:17-25, and McAllister et al. (2000) J. Virol. 74:9197-9205.
[0607]Also provided herein are modifications of the viruses provided above
to enhance one or more characteristics relative to the wild type virus.
Such characteristics can include, but are not limited to, attenuated
pathogenicity, reduced toxicity, preferential accumulation in tumor,
increased ability to activate an immune response against tumor cells,
increased or decreased immunogenicity, increased or decreased replication
competence, and the ability to express exogenous proteins, and
combinations thereof. In some embodiments, the modified viruses have an
ability to activate an immune response against tumor cells without
aggressively killing the tumor cells. In other embodiments, the viruses
can be modified to express one or more detectable genes, including genes
that can be used for imaging. In other embodiments, the viruses can be
modified to express one or more genes for harvesting the gene products
and/or for harvesting antibodies against the gene products.
[0608]b. Adenovirus, Herpes, Retroviruses
[0609]Further provided herein are viruses that include in their life cycle
entry of a nucleic acid molecule into the nucleus of the host cell. A
variety of such viruses are known in the art, and include herpesviruses,
papovaviruses, retroviruses, adenoviruses, parvoviruses and
orthomyxoviruses. Exemplary herpesviruses include herpes simplex type I
viruses, cytomegaloviruses, and Epstein-Barr viruses. Exemplary
papovaviruses include human papillomavirus and SV40 viruses. Exemplary
retroviruses include lentiviruses. Exemplary orthomyxoviruses include
influenza viruses. Exemplary parvoviruses include adeno associated
viruses.
[0610]Also provided herein are modifications of the viruses provided above
to enhance one or more characteristics relative to the wild type virus.
Such characteristics can include, but are not limited to, attenuated
pathogenicity, reduced toxicity, preferential accumulation in tumor,
increased ability to activate an immune response against tumor cells,
increased or decreased immunogenicity, increased or decreased replication
competence, and the ability to express exogenous proteins, and
combinations thereof. In some embodiments, the modified viruses have an
ability to activate an immune response against tumor cells without
aggressively killing the tumor cells. In other embodiments, the viruses
can be modified to express one or more detectable genes, including genes
that can be used for imaging. In other embodiments, the viruses can be
modified to express one or more genes for harvesting the gene products
and/or for harvesting antibodies against the gene products.
[0611]4. Eukaryotic Cells
[0612]Also encompassed within the cells provided herein and the methods of
making and using such cells are eukaryotic cells, including cells from
multi-cellular eukaryotes, including mammals such as primates, where
exemplary cells are human cells. Typically the cells are isolated cells.
For example, eukaryotic cells can be tumor cells, including mammalian
tumor cells such as primate tumor cells, where exemplary primate tumor
cells are human tumor cells such as human breast cancer cells. In another
example, eukaryotic cells can include fibrosarcoma cells such as human
fibrosarcoma cells. Exemplary human fibrosarcoma cells include HT1080
(ATCC Accession Nos. CCL-121, CRL-12011 or CRL-12012). In another
example, eukaryotic cells can include stem cells, including mammalian
stem cells such as primate stem cells, where exemplary primate stem cells
are human stem cells.
[0613]Also provided herein are modifications of eukaryotic cells to
enhance one or more characteristics relative to the wild type cells. Such
characteristics can include, but are not limited to, attenuated
pathogenicity, reduced toxicity, preferential accumulation in tumor,
increased ability to activate an immune response against tumor cells,
increased or decreased immunogenicity, increased or decreased replication
competence, and are able to express exogenous proteins, and combinations
thereof. In some embodiments, the modified eukaryotic cells have an
ability to activate an immune response against tumor cells without
aggressively killing the tumor cells. In other embodiments, the modified
eukaryotic cells have an ability to kill tumor cells or activate an
immune response against tumor cells that kills the tumor cells. In other
embodiments, the eukaryotic cells can be modified to express one or more
detectable genes,
F. IMAGING
[0614]Tumor and or metastasis size can be imaged and/or monitored by any
of a variety of methods known in the art, including external assessment
methods or other imaging methods such as, for example, tomographic or
magnetic imaging.
[0615]Microorganisms and cells can be imaged and/or monitored by any of a
variety of methods known in the art. Exemplary imaging/monitoring methods
include any of a variety magnetic resonance methods such as magnetic
resonance imaging (MRI) and magnetic resonance spectroscopy (MRS), and
also include any of a variety of tomographic methods including computed
tomography (CT), computed axial tomography (CAT), electron beam computed
tomography (EBCT), high resolution computed tomography (HRCT),
hypocycloidal tomography, positron emission tomography (PET), gamma rays
(after annihilation of a positron and an electron in PET scanning),
single-photon emission computed tomography (SPECT), spiral computed
tomography and ultrasonic tomography. Other exemplary imaging methods
include low-light imaging, X-rays, ultrasound signal, fluorescence,
absorption.
[0616]In a particular embodiment, the diagnostic or pharmaceutical
composition of the provided herein contains a microorganism or cell
containing a DNA sequence encoding a protein capable of inducing a signal
detectable by magnetic resonance imaging (MRI), e.g., metal-binding
proteins. Furthermore, the protein can bind contrast agents,
chromophores, ligands or compounds required for visualization of tissues.
[0617]For generating the DNA sequences and for constructing expression
vectors, bacteria, eukaryotic cells or viruses which contain the DNA
sequences, it is possible to use general methods known in the art. These
methods include e.g., in vitro recombination techniques, synthetic
methods and in vivo recombination methods as described in Sambrook et
al., Molecular Cloning A Laboratory Manual, 2.sup.nd edition (1989) Cold
Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y., for example.
Methods of transfecting cells, of phenotypically selecting transfectants
and of expressing the DNA sequences by using vectors are known in the
art. Methods of transforming cells, of phenotypically selecting
transformants and of expressing the DNA sequences by using vectors are
known in the art.
[0618]Contrast agents are used for magnetic resonance imaging. Exemplary
contrast agents are iron, gold, gadolinium and gallium. Gallium imaging
is a nuclear medicine method for the detection of infections and cancers.
Gallium-67 (.sup.67Ga) binds to transferrin, lactoferrin and bacterial
siderophores. Iron imaging also provides for a nuclear medicine method
for the detection of infections and cancer. Iron binds to extracellular
proteins such as transferrin, lactoferrin and bacterial siderophores.
Microorganisms and cells provided herein can be modified to express, for
example, recombinant transferrin receptors, lactoferrin receptors and
outer membrane proteins. It is also taken up by cancer cells in an
increased amount. An increased uptake and, thus, increased radiation
levels, indicates an infection of cancer.
[0619]Labels appropriate for magnetic resonance imaging are known in the
art, and include, for example, fluorine, gadolinium chelates, metals and
metal oxides, such as for example, iron, gallium, gold, gadolinium,
magnesium, 1H, .sup.19F, .sup.13C, and .sup.15N labeled compounds, etc.
Use of chelates in contrast agents is known in the art. Labels
appropriate for tomographic imaging methods are known in the art, and
include, for example, .beta.-emitters such as .sup.11C, .sup.13N,
.sup.15O or .sup.64Cu or (b) .gamma.-emitters such as .sup.123I. Other
exemplary radionuclides that can, be used, for example, as tracers for
PET include .sup.55Co, .sup.67Ga, .sup.68Ga, .sup.60Cu(II),
.sup.67Cu(II), .sup.99Tc, .sup.57Ni, .sup.52Fe and .sup.18F. Examples of
useful radionuclide-labeled agents are, for example, proteins, peptides,
antibodies, .sup.18FDG, .sup.99Tc, .sup.64Cu-labeled engineered antibody
fragment, .sup.64Cu-labeled somatostatin,
64Cu-pyruvaldehyde-bis(N4-methylthiosemicarbazone)(.sup.64Cu-PTSM),
.sup.52Fe-citrate, .sup.52Fe/.sup.52mMn-citrate and .sup.52Fe-labeled
iron (III) hydroxide-sucrose complex (Wu et al. (2002) PNAS USA
97:8495-8500; Lewis et al. (1999) J. Med. Chem. 42:1341-1347; Adonai et
al. (2002) PNAS USA 99:3030-3035; Leenders et al. (1994) J. Neural.
Transm. Suppl. 43:123-132; Calonder et al. (1999) J. Neurochem.
73:2047-2055; Beshara et al. (1999) Br. J. Haematol. 104:288-295,
296-302). Metabolic compounds that are only taken up by bacteria could be
labeled with .sup.13C and injected into the animal. Likewise, .sup.18F
compounds can be injected that are either metabolized or used in prodrug
formulations (like 5-FC) with the microorganisms and cells expressing a
prodrug converting enzyme (like cytosine deaminase) can be used in the
imaging methods provided herein.
[0620]In any of the imaging methods provided herein, the microorganisms
and cells can express a gene that can bind a detectable compound or that
can form a product that can bind a detectable compound. A variety of gene
products, such as proteins, that can specifically bind a detectable
compound are known in the art including, but not limited to, receptors,
metal binding proteins (e.g., siderophores and ferritins), ligand binding
proteins and antibodies. In one embodiment, the diagnostic composition is
a microorganism or cell containing a DNA sequence encoding a protein
capable of inducing a signal detectable by magnetic resonance imaging
(MRI). Furthermore, the protein can bind contrast agents, chromophores,
ligands or compounds required for visualization of tissues.
[0621]In any of the imaging methods provided herein, the microorganisms
and cells that express a gene that can bind a detectable compound or that
can form a product that can bind a detectable compound can be regulated
by an inducible promoter. Exemplary inducible promoters are described
elsewhere herein and include, for example, an arabinose inducible system
(e.g., P.sub.BAD). Methods of imaging microorganisms and cells that
express a detectable gene product gene regulated by inducible promoter
can include imaging prior to and following administration of an agent for
induction of gene expression. Such agents include inducer molecules, such
as a sugar (e.g., arabinose) for the induction of gene expression. In a
non-limiting example, bacteria that express an iron binding protein, such
as a ferritin, can be imaged following administration of the bacteria to
a subject but prior to administration of the inducing agent, and then
imaged after administration of the inducing agent. Comparison of imaging
before and after the administration of the inducing agent can the be used
to determine the location of the bacteria.
[0622]An exemplary list of radionuclides useful for the imaging methods
provided herein includes, for example, .sup.11Carbon, .sup.11Fluorine,
.sup.13Carbon, .sup.13Nitrogen, .sup.15Nitrogen, .sup.15Oxygen,
.sup.18Flourine, .sup.19Flourine, .sup.24Sodium, .sup.32Phosphate,
.sup.42Potassium, .sup.51Chromium, .sup.55Iron, .sup.59Iron,
.sup.57Cobalt, .sup.60Cobalt, .sup.64Copper, .sup.67Gallium,
.sup.68Gallium, .sup.75Selenium, .sup.81Krypton, .sup.82Rubidium,
.sup.89Strontium, .sup.92Strontium, .sup.90Yttirum, .sup.99Technetium,
.sup.103Palladium, .sup.106Ruthenium, .sup.111Indium, .sup.117Lutetium,
.sup.123Iodine, .sup.125Iodine, .sup.131Iodine, .sup.133Xenon,
.sup.137Cesium, .sup.153Samarium, .sup.153Gadolinium, .sup.165Dysprosium,
.sup.166Holmium, .sup.169Ytterbium, .sup.177Leutium .sup.186Rhenium,
.sup.188Rhenium, .sup.192Iridium, .sup.198Gold, .sup.201Thallium,
.sup.211Astatine, .sup.212Bismuth and .sup.213Bismuth. One of skill in
the art can alter the parameters used in different imaging methods (MRI,
for example) in order to visualize different radionuclides/metals. For
example, T2 weighted imaging MRI is used to visualize iron, while T1
weighted imaging can be used to visualize gadolinium.
[0623]In general, for practice of the methods herein and when using the
microorganisms provided herein for detection of a tumor, the tumor is not
excised, and can be imaged externally to the subject. Methods of excising
tumor tissue for analysis, including assessment of accumulation of the
microorganism and/or gene expression, however, are not excluded and can
be used alone or in combination with the methods of detection provided
herein.
[0624]1. Ferritins
[0625]Most reporter genes developed for MRI rely on exogenous
administration of contrast material. Because of the crystalline
ferrihydrite core, ferritins have an anomalously high super-paramagnetism
and a marked effect on solvent NMR relaxation rates, making ferritins
ideal molecules to express for in vivo MRI studies (Genove et al. (2005)
Nature Medicine 11(4):450-454; Cohen et al. (2005) Neoplasia
7(2):109-117).
[0626]Recombinant gene technology can be used to over-express ferritin,
which accumulates iron, and thereby, generates its own contrast agent.
Microorganisms and cells can be used to specifically target and replicate
in tumors. Using such microorganisms and cells engineered to over-express
ferritins to target tumors, increased iron accumulation can increase
tumor detection by MRI. Alternatively metals such as .sup.67Ga which are
compatible with SPECT or other imaging modalities can be chelated in vivo
in ferritins or similar molecules.
[0627]Bacteria can be used to increase iron accumulation for
visualization. For example, tumor tissues can be specifically infected by
intravenously injected bacteria (e.g., E. coli Nissle 1917) carrying
genes encoding, for example, expressing or over-expressing endogenous or
exogenous ferritin-like molecules. Expression of the ferritin-like
molecules in the bacteria cells will mark these cells for increased iron
storage. Internalization iron storage causes increased contrast agent for
in vivo imaging. In addition, internalization of iron by the bacteria can
deplete iron from the tumor environment, thereby causing tumor cell
lysis. Bacteria can be further recombinantly engineered to over-express
siderophores and siderophore receptors, thereby increasing the contrast
agent in vivo.
[0628]Viruses (such as Vaccinia virus) also can be used to increase iron
accumulation by tumor cells for visualization. For example, the tumor
tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously injected engineered
Vaccinia virus carrying genes encoding ferritin-like molecules.
Expression of the ferritin-like molecules in the tumor cells will mark
these cells for increased iron storage. Internalization iron storage in
the tumor cells causes increased contrast agent for in vivo imaging.
Following imaging of the tumor, iron conjugated to an anti-cancer agent
can be intravenously administered, thereby causing tumor cell lysis. In
addition, viruses can be further recombinantly engineered to carry genes
encoding iron-uptake receptors, such as the transferrin receptor or the
lactoferrin receptor (along with a signal sequence for cell surface
expression) for increased iron capture.
[0629]Eukaryotic cells can be used to increase iron accumulation for
visualization. For example, tumor tissues can be specifically infected by
intravenously injected eukaryotic cells carrying genes encoding, for
example, expressing or over-expressing endogenous or exogenous
ferritin-like molecules. For example, eukaryotic cells can be engineered
to over-express H chains, L chains, or a combination of both. In another
example, eukaryotic cells can be engineered to express or over-express a
bacterial ferritin-like molecule. Expression of the ferritin-like
molecules in the eukaryotic cells will mark these cells for increased
iron storage. Internalization iron storage accumulation causes increased
contrast agent for in vivo imaging. In addition, internalization of iron
by the eukaryotic cells can deplete iron from the tumor environment,
thereby causing tumor cell lysis. Eukaryotic cells can be further
recombinantly engineered to express or over-express such as the
transferrin receptor or the lactoferrin receptor (along with a signal
sequence for cell surface expression) thereby increasing iron
accumulation for in vivo imaging.
[0630]Thus, microorganisms, e.g., bacteria, viruses and eukaryotic cells
can be recombinantly engineered to express ferritin-like molecules that
can be used to detect primary and metastatic tumors.
[0631]These systems are advantageous because they target the tumor
specifically without affecting normal tissue and the location of the
delivery system inside the tumor cells (i.e., viruses and intracellular
bacteria) or in the tumor environment (i.e., bacteria and eukaryotic
cells) can be verified by direct visualization before delivering a
therapeutic agent conjugated to the ligand.
[0632]Accordingly, one embodiment relates to a diagnostic composition
containing a microorganism or cell containing a DNA sequence encoding one
or more ferritin-like molecules. Any microorganism or cell is useful for
the diagnostic methods provided herein, provided that they replicate in
the tumor cell (i.e., virus) or in the tumor environment (i.e., bacteria
and eukaryotic cells), are not pathogenic for the organism e.g.,
attenuated, and are recognized by the immune system of the organism, etc.
[0633]2. Siderophores
[0634]Bacteria can bind and take up siderophores complexed to iron. The
siderophores can then be recycled or metabolized and the bacteria can
used the free iron for their metabolism or store it in molecules, such as
ferritin. Loaded (radio-) labeled siderophores can be systemically
injected into tumor-bearing patients having bacteria-colonized tumors.
The intra-tumoral bacteria specifically bind and take up the complexed
siderophores, thereby taking up the radiolabel which, in turn, can be
visualized using PET, SPECT or autoradiography. Either complexed iron or
the siderophore itself will be radiolabeled. (Buss et al. (2004) Curr Top
Med Chem. 4(15):1623-35). Bacteria can be recombinantly engineered as
described elsewhere herein to over-express endogenous or exogenous
siderophores. The bacteria can also be recombinantly engineered to
express heterologous siderophore receptors or over-express their own
siderophore receptors. Alternatively, or in addition, bacteria can be
recombinantly engineered as described elsewhere herein such that genes
involved in siderophore biosynthesis are inactivated/deleted.
[0635]Inactivation of bacterial metal-regulatory systems (e.g., Fur) in
combination with or without over-expression of siderophores will
up-regulate metal-scavenging pathways, e.g., siderophore receptors, which
will bind host metal chelates or delivered compounds and render the
bacteria more visible to imaging modalities. Such bacteria can be used in
magnetic resonance imaging methods provided herein to increase
accumulation of an endogenous contrast agent (i.e., iron) and,
optionally, an exogenously administered contrast agent (e.g., .sup.67Ga).
[0636]Bacteria can be used to increase iron accumulation for
visualization. For example, tumor tissues can be specifically infected by
intravenously injected bacteria (e.g., E. coli Nissle 1917) carrying
genes encoding, for example, expressing or over-expressing endogenous or
exogenous siderophores and expressing or over-expressing endogenous or
exogenous siderophore receptors. Expression of the siderophore receptor
on the bacteria cell surface will mark these cells for increased
targeting by siderophore-metal pairs. Internalization of the
siderophore-metal (e.g., iron, gadolinium or gallium) pair allows the
internalization of the contrast agent. In addition, internalization of
iron by the bacteria can deplete iron from the tumor environment, thereby
causing tumor cell lysis. Bacteria can be further recombinantly
engineered to over-express ferritin-like compounds, thereby increasing
the contrast agent in vivo.
[0637]Viruses (such as Vaccinia virus) also can be used to increase iron
(or another detectable contrast agent) accumulation by tumor cells for
visualization. For example, the tumor tissues can be specifically
infected by intravenously injected engineered Vaccinia virus carrying,
e.g., a siderophore receptor gene and, optionally, a siderophore gene
(also encoding signal peptides for cell surface expression and
secretion). Expression of the siderophore receptor on the tumor cell
surface will mark these cells for targeting by siderophores. Tumor cell
internalization of the siderophore-metal (e.g., iron, gadolinium or
gallium) pair allows the internalization of the contrast agent.
Alternatively, when a siderophore is itself radiolabeled, tumor cell
internalization of the siderophore allows the internalization of the
contrast agent. In addition, internalization of the siderophore-metal
(e.g., iron, gadolinium or gallium) pair can result in accumulation of
iron to a toxic level, thereby causing tumor cell lysis.
[0638]Eukaryotic cells also can be used to increase iron accumulation.
Eukaryotic cells also can be used to bind a diagnostic and/or a
therapeutic label as described elsewhere herein. For example, the tumor
tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously injected engineered
eukaryotic cells carrying, e.g., a siderophore receptor gene (also
encoding signal peptides for cell surface expression). The eukaryotic
cells can also carry a gene encoding an enzyme involved in siderophore
biosynthesis (also encoding signal peptides for expression and
secretion). Expression of the siderophore receptor on the eukaryotic cell
surface will mark these cells for targeting by siderophores.
Internalization of the siderophore-metal (e.g., iron, gadolinium or
gallium) pair allows the internalization of the contrast agent. In
addition, internalization of the siderophore-metal (e.g., iron,
gadolinium or gallium) pair can result depletion of iron from the tumor
environment, thereby killing tumor cells.
[0639]Thus, microorganisms, e.g., bacteria, viruses and eukaryotic cells
can be recombinantly engineered to secrete siderophores and their cell
surface receptors that can be used to detect primary and metastatic
tumors. Microorganisms and cells can also be recombinantly engineered to
have inactivated/deleted siderophore genes or genes that encode enzymes
that process siderophores. Cell surface receptors can bind ex vivo
siderophores and, thus, can be used to detect primary and metastatic
tumors.
[0640]These systems are advantageous because they target the tumor
specifically without affecting normal tissue and the location of the
delivery system inside the tumor cells (i.e., viruses and intracellular
bacteria) or in the tumor environment (i.e., bacteria and eukaryotic
cells) can be verified by direct visualization before delivering a
therapeutic agent conjugated to the ligand.
[0641]Accordingly, one embodiment relates to a diagnostic composition
containing a microorganism or cell containing a DNA sequence encoding one
or more siderophores and cell-surface receptors. Any microorganism or
cell is useful for the diagnostic methods provided herein that they
replicate in the tumor cell (i.e., virus) or in the tumor environment
(i.e., bacteria and eukaryotic cells), are not pathogenic for the
organism e.g., attenuated compared to the wild-type microorganism.
Optionally, the microorganism or cell is recognized by the immune system
of the subject, etc.
[0642]3. Surface Ligands
[0643]Tumor targeting/replicating bacteria can be used to display specific
peptides on their surface to attract and bind single molecules/fusion
products and/or nanoparticles. This binding can lead to enhanced
diagnostic signals. For example, bacteria can express peptides on their
surface that can be visualized using ligand conjugates. Ligand conjugates
can be, for example, enzymes, antibodies, peptides, nanoparticles or
fusions or combinations thereof, and can be, optionally, labeled with a
diagnostic moiety (e.g., a fluorophore, a luminescent protein, a
fluorescent protein, etc.).
[0644]Bacteria (such as E. coli Nissle 1917) can be used to label the
bacteria cell surface with receptor proteins. For example, the tumor
tissues can be specifically infected by intravenously injected engineered
E. coli Nissle 1917 carrying, e.g., a transferrin receptor gene (also
encoding a signal peptide for cell surface expression). Expression of the
transferrin receptor on the bacteria cell surface will mark these cells
for targeting by diagnostic- and/or therapeutic-ligand fusion proteins.
In this case, the ligand is the transferrin protein, and the diagnostic
moiety protein could be, for example, labeled iron. Bacteria cell
internalization of the transferrin/transferrin receptor pair allows the
internalization of the labeled iron, which in turn delivers the
diagnostic moiety specifically to the tumor cells.
Transferrin/transferrin receptor pair is only one of many examples of
ligand-receptor pairs that can be used. In addition, mutant ligands and
mutant receptors with highly specific affinity toward each other can be
used to avoid the binding to endogenous proteins. In one non-limiting
example, a cell surface protein carries an exposed surface peptide and an
antibody immunoreactive with the peptide conjugated to a diagnostic
moiety is administered. In a further embodiment, a subsequent
administration of a therapeutic agent using any of the methods described
herein can be used to treat a subject that has been diagnosed as having a
cancer, tumor or metastasis.
[0645]Viruses (such as Vaccinia virus) also can be used to label the tumor
cell surface with receptor proteins. For example, the tumor tissues can
be specifically infected by intravenously injected engineered Vaccinia
virus carrying, e.g., a transferrin receptor gene (also encoding a signal
peptide for cell surface expression). Expression of the transferrin
receptor on the tumor cell surface will mark these cells for targeting by
therapeutic-ligand fusion proteins. In this case, the ligand is the
transferrin protein, and the diagnostic moiety protein could be, for
example, labeled iron. Tumor cell internalization of the
transferrin/transferrin receptor pair allows the internalization of the
labeled iron, which in turn delivers the diagnostic moiety specifically
to the tumor cells. Transferrin/transferrin receptor pair is only one of
many examples of ligand-receptor pairs that can be used. In addition,
mutant ligands and mutant receptors with highly specific affinity toward
each other can be used to avoid the binding to endogenous proteins. In
one non-limiting example, a cell surface protein carries an exposed
surface peptide and an antibody immunoreactive with the peptide
conjugated to a diagnostic moiety is administered. In a further
embodiment, a subsequent administration of a therapeutic agent using any
of the methods described herein can be used to treat a subject that has
been diagnosed as having a cancer, tumor or metastasis.
[0646]Eukaryotic cells can be recombinantly engineered to express any of
the ligand pairs described herein for use in imaging of tumors. For
example, a eukaryotic cell can be recombinantly engineered to express an
outer membrane protein with a streptavidin binding peptide (Omp/SA-B) in
one of the outer loops on the cell surface. The Omp/SA-B complex will
mark these cells for targeting by diagnostic- and/or therapeutic-ligand
fusion proteins. In this case, the ligand is streptavidin, and the by
diagnostic- and/or therapeutic-ligand fusion proteins could be any of
those provided herein. Internalization of the ligand-receptor pair, or
attachment to the cell surface of, the diagnostic moiety or therapeutic
agent targets the cells, and therefore the tumors, for imaging and/or
therapy. The streptavidin binding peptide-streptavidin pair is only one
of many examples of peptide-ligand-pairs that can be used. In addition,
mutant ligands and mutant receptors with highly specific affinity toward
each other can be used to avoid the binding to endogenous proteins.
[0647]Thus, microorganisms, e.g., bacteria, viruses and eukaryotic cells
can be recombinantly engineered to express receptors or cell surface
ligands that can be used to detect primary and metastatic tumors.
[0648]These systems are advantageous because they target the tumor
specifically without affecting normal tissue; the expression and
secretion of the gene constructs can be under the control of an inducible
promoter, enabling secretion to be switched on or off; and the location
of the delivery system inside the tumor can be verified by direct
visualization before delivering a therapeutic agent conjugated to the
ligand.
[0649]Accordingly, one embodiment relates to a diagnostic composition
containing a microorganism or cell containing a DNA sequence encoding a
cell-surface protein. Any microorganism or cell is useful for the
diagnostic methods provided herein, provided that they replicate in the
tumor cell (i.e., viruses or intracellular bacteria) or in the tumor
environment (i.e., extracellular bacteria and eukaryotic cells), are not
pathogenic for the organism.
[0650]In another embodiment, Gene-Directed Enzyme Prodrug Therapy (GDEPT),
for example, can be used in which extracellular bacteria and/or
eukaryotic cells are engineered to secrete an enzyme, or to express a
cell-surface attached enzyme, that converts a non-toxic prodrug into a
cytotoxic drug. Alternatively, or in addition to, viruses can be
engineered to promote tumor cell expression of a secreted or cell-surface
attached enzyme that converts a non-toxic prodrug into a cytotoxic drug.
Following administration of the engineered bacteria, eukaryotic cells
and/or viruses, the microorganisms and cells are allowed to proliferate
and produce the prodrug converting enzyme at the site of the tumor. After
a period of time the prodrug is delivered intravenously, or by
alternative delivery method, and the prodrug is converted to the
cytotoxic form at the site of the tumor, causing toxicity in the
surrounding tumor cells.
[0651]Optionally, the prodrug converting enzymes can be expressed by the
microorganism or cell in conjunction with a ligand or receptor. The
prodrug converting enzymes can also be expressed as a fusion protein with
a ligand or receptor. Prodrugs can be engineered with an attached moiety
that promotes localization of the prodrug to the site of the tumor. The
moiety can include, but is not limited to an antibody, a ligand, a small
molecule or other detectable molecule that binds to the ligand or
receptor expressed by the engineered microorganism.
[0652]Exemplary prodrug converting enzymes with their prodrug partners
include, but are not limited to, Herpes simplex virus thymidine
kinase/gancyclovir, varicella zoster thymidine kinase/gancyclovir,
cytosine deaminase/5-fluorouracil, purine nucleoside
phosphorylase/6-methylpurine deoxyriboside, beta
lactamase/cephalosporin-doxorubicin, carboxypeptidase
G2/4-[(2-chloroethyl)(2-mesuloxyethyl)amino]benzoyl-L-glutamic acid,
cytochrome P450/acetominophen, horseradish peroxidase/indole-3-acetic
acid, nitroreductase/CB 1954, rabbit
carboxylesterase/7-ethyl-10-[4-(1-piperidino)-1-piperidino]carbonyloxycam-
potothecin, mushroom
tyrosinase/bis-(2-chloroethyl)amino-4-hydroxyphenylaminomethanone 28,
beta galactosidase/1-chloromethyl-5-hydroxy-1,2-dihyro-3H-benz[e]indole,
beta glucuronidase/epirubicin-glucoronide, thymidine
phosphorylase/5'-deoxy-5-fluorouridine, deoxycytidine kinase/cytosine
arabinoside, beta-lactamase and linamerase/linamarin.
[0653]4. Detectable Gene Products
[0654]In other embodiments, the microorganism or cell can express a gene
that encodes a product that can bind a detectable compound, encodes a
product that emits a detectable light or that can form a product that can
bind a detectable compound. A variety of gene products, such as proteins,
that can specifically bind a detectable compound are known in the art,
including receptors, metal binding proteins, ligand binding proteins, and
antibodies. A variety of gene products, such as proteins that emit a
detectable light, including luciferases and fluorescent proteins can be
used. Any of a variety of detectable compounds can be used, and can be
imaged by any of a variety of known imaging methods. Exemplary compounds
include receptor ligands and antigens for antibodies. The ligand can be
labeled according to the imaging method to be used.
[0655]The person skilled in the art knows DNA sequences encoding
luminescent or fluorescent proteins that can be used in the diagnostic or
pharmaceutical methods provided herein. During the past decade, the
identification and isolation of structural genes encoding light-emitting
proteins from bacterial luciferase from Vibrio harveyi and from Vibrio
fischerii, firefly luciferase, click beetle luciferase, aequorin from
Aequorea Victoria, Renilla luciferase from Renilla reniformis and green
fluorescent protein (GFP) from Aequorea victoria (Prasher et al. (1987)
Gene 111:229-233) or Renilla sea pansy, and other sea anemone and coral
species, and variants thereof, including yellow fluorescent protein
(YFP), orange fluorescent protein (OFP), cyan fluorescent protein (CFP),
and blue fluorescent protein (BFP), red fluorescent protein (RFP) and
far-red fluorescent proteins from the corallimorph Discosoma (Matz et al.
(1999) Nature Biotechnology 17:969-973), Heteractis reef coral and other
sea anemone and coral species, as well as variants thereof including
DsRed2 (Clontech, Palo Alto, Calif.), DsRed-T1 (Bevis and Glick (2002)
Nat. Biotechnol., 20:83-87), mPlum (Wang et al. (2004) PNAS USA.
101(48):16745-9), HcRed1 and t-HcRed (Clontech, Palo Alto, Calif.), and
near-infrared fluorescent proteins have been described that allow the
tracing of bacteria or viruses based on light emission (Belas et al.
(1982) Science 218:791-793; Bevis and Glick (2002) Nat. Biotechnol.
20:83-87; Foran and Brown, Nucleic acids Res. 16:177 (1988); de Wet et
al. (1987) Mol. Cell. Biol. 7:725-737; Matz et al. (1999) Nature
Biotechnology 17:969-973; Prasher et al. (1987) Biochem. 26:1326-1332;
Lorenz et al. (1991) PNAS USA 88:4438-4442; Prasher et al. (1987) Gene
111:229-233). Transformation and expression of these genes in bacteria
allows detection of bacterial colonies with the aid of a low light
imaging camera or individual bacteria under a fluorescent microscope
(Engebrecht et al. (1985) Science 227:1345-1347; Legocki et al. (1986)
PNAS 83:9080-9084; Chalfie et al. (1994) Science 263:802-805).
[0656]Luciferase genes have been expressed in a variety of organisms.
Promoter activation based on light emission, using luxAB fused to the
nitrogenase promoter, was demonstrated in Rhizobia residing within the
cytoplasm of cells of infected root nodules by low light imaging (Legocki
et al. (1986) PNAS 83:9080-9084; O'Kane et al. (1988) J. Plant Mol. Biol.
10:387-399). Fusion of the luxA and luxB genes resulted in a fully
functional luciferase protein (Escher et al. (1989) PNAS 86:6528-6532).
This fusion gene (Fab2) was introduced into Bacillus subtilis and
Bacillus megaterium under the xylose promoter and then fed into insect
larvae and was injected into the hemolymph of worms. Imaging of light
emission was conducted using a low light video camera. The movement and
localization of pathogenic bacteria in transgenic Arabidopsis plants,
which carry the pathogen-activated PAL promoter-bacterial luciferase
fusion gene construct, was demonstrated by localizing Pseudomonas or
Erwinia spp. infection under the low light imager as well as in tomato
plant and stacks of potatoes (Giacomin and Szalay (1996) Plant Sci.
116:59-72).
[0657]All of the luciferases expressed in bacteria require exogenously
added substrates such as decanal or coelenterazine for light emission. In
contrast, while visualization of GFP fluorescence does not require a
substrate, an excitation light source is needed. More recently, the gene
cluster encoding the bacterial luciferase and the proteins for providing
decanal within the cell, which includes luxCDABE was isolated from
Xenorhabdus luminescens (Meighen and Szittner (1992) J. Bacteriol.
174:5371-5381) and Photobacterium leiognathi (Lee et al. (1991) Eur. J.
Biochem. 201:161-167) and transferred into bacteria resulting in
continuous light emission independent of exogenously added substrate
(Fernandez-Pinas and Wolk(1994) Gene 150:169-174). Bacteria containing
the complete lux operon sequence, when injected intraperitoneally,
intramuscularly, or intravenously, allowed the visualization and
localization of bacteria in live mice indicating that the luciferase
light emission can penetrate the tissues and can be detected externally
(Contag et al. (1995) Mol. Microbiol. 18:593-603).
[0658]An exemplary use of the microorganisms and cells described above is
the preparation of a diagnostic composition for tumor-imaging. The
diagnostic compositions provided herein can be used, for example, during
surgery, to identify tumors and metastasis. Furthermore, the diagnostic
compositions provided herein are useful for monitoring a therapeutic
tumor treatment. Suitable devices for analyzing the localization or
distribution of luminescent and/or fluorescent proteins in an organism,
organ or tissue are well known to the person skilled in the art and,
furthermore described in the literature cited above as well as the
Examples, below.
[0659]It is the object of the methods provided herein to provide a means
for the efficient and reliable diagnosis of tumors.
[0660]Light-emitting recombinant bacteria (e.g., B. subtilis, V. cholerae,
S. flexneri, E. coli DH5a, EIEC 4608-58, and E. coli Nissle 1917) which
were injected intravenously into mice could be visualized in whole
animals under a low light imager as shown in the Examples. Three days
post-injection of bacteria, mice were administered an arabinose solution
to induce gene expression of the diagnostic moiety. Six-hours
post-arabinose injection, increasing light emission originating from the
tumor regions was observed, but not non-tumor regions or internal organs.
This observation indicates a continuous bacterial replication in the
tumor tissue. The extent of light emission is dependent on the bacterial
strain used. E. coli Nissle 1917 light-emitting bacteria replicated
better, and for a longer period of time, in tumors than did other
bacteria tested. See Example 5.
[0661]As shown in co-pending U.S. application Ser. Nos. 10/872,156 and
11/238,025, when Vaccinia virus (LIVP strain) carrying the light emitting
fusion gene construct was injected intravenously into nude mice, the
virus particles were found to be cleared from all internal organs within
4 days, as determined by extinction of light emission. In contrast, when
Vaccinia virus was injected intravenously into nude mice bearing tumors
(e.g., glioma, human prostate tumor cells, human breast tumors, human
bladder tumors), virus particles were found to be retained over time in
tumor tissues, resulting in lasting light emission. The presence and
amplification of the virus-encoded fusion proteins in the same tumor were
monitored in live animals by observing GFP fluorescence under a
stereomicroscope and by collecting luciferase-catalyzed light emission
under a low-light video-imaging camera. Tumor-specific light emission was
detected 4 days after viral injection, became more intense after the 4th
post-injection day and lasted for 30 to 45 days, indicating continued
viral replication. Further, mammalian cells expressing GFP fusion
proteins, upon injection into the bloodstream, have been found to home
into and propagate in glioma tumors.
[0662]Thus, light-emitting cells or microorganisms, e.g., bacteria,
viruses and eukaryotic cells can be used to detect primary and metastatic
tumors.
[0663]These systems are advantageous because they target the tumor
specifically without affecting normal tissue; the expression and
secretion of the gene constructs can be under the control of an inducible
promoter, enabling secretion to be switched on or off; and the location
of the delivery system inside the tumor can be verified by direct
visualization before activating gene expression and protein delivery.
[0664]Accordingly, one embodiment relates to a diagnostic composition
containing a microorganism or cell containing a DNA sequence encoding a
detectable protein or a protein capable of inducing a detectable signal.
Any microorganism or cell is useful for the diagnostic methods provided
herein, provided that they replicate in the tumor cell (i.e., viruses and
intracellular bacteria) or in the tumor environment (i.e., extracellular
bacteria and eukaryotic cells), are not pathogenic for the organism e.g.,
attenuated and, are recognized by the immune system of the organism, etc.
In a particular embodiment, the diagnostic or pharmaceutical composition
is a microorganism or cell containing a DNA sequence encoding a
luminescent and/or fluorescent protein.
G. THERAPY
[0665]Provided herein are therapeutic methods, including methods of
treating, delaying progression of immunoprivileged cells or tissue, or
preventing immunoprivileged cells or tissue, including cancerous cells,
tumors and metastases. The methods provided herein include administering
a microorganism or cell to a subject containing one or more tumor(s)
and/or metastases. The microorganisms and cells and methods provided
herein can be administered to kill tumor cells, decrease the tumor size,
or prevent or delay expansion of the tumor.
[0666]Tumors that can be treated with the microorganisms or cells provided
herein include, but are not limited to, bladder tumors, breast tumors,
prostate tumors, glioma tumors, adenocarcinomas, ovarian carcinomas, and
pancreatic carcinomas, liver tumors and skin tumors. In one example, the
human malignancy treated is a cancer such as, but not limited to,
pancreatic cancer, non-small cell lung cancer, multiple myeloma or
leukemia. In addition, other metastatic diseases can be treated by the
methods provided herein. Cancers can also be cancer-forming solid tumors,
such as lung and bronchus, breast, colon and rectum, kidney, stomach,
esophagus, liver and intrahepatic bile duct, urinary bladder, brain and
other nervous system, head and neck, oral cavity and pharynx, cervix,
uterine corpus, thyroid, ovary, testes, prostate, malignant melanoma,
cholangiocarcinoma, thymoma, non-melanoma skin cancers, as well as
hematologic tumors and/or malignancies, such as childhood leukemia and
lymphomas, multiple myeloma, Hodgkin's disease, lymphomas of lymphocytic
and cutaneous origin, acute and chronic leukemia such as acute
lymphoblastic, acute myelocytic or chronic myelocytic leukemia, plasma
cell neoplasm, lymphoid neoplasm and cancers associated with AIDS.
[0667]The administered microorganisms and cells can posses one or more
characteristics including attenuated pathogenicity, low toxicity,
preferential accumulation in tumors, increased ability to capture,
transport and or store iron, immunogenicity, replication competence, an
ability to express or over-express exogenous genes, an ability to
over-express endogenous genes and an ability to bind ligands.
[0668]The microorganisms provided herein can be administered to a subject
without causing microorganism-induced disease in the subject. In some
embodiments, the microorganisms can accumulate in tumors or metastases.
In some embodiments, the microorganisms can elicit an anti-tumor response
in the subject, where typically the microorganism-mediated anti-tumor
response can develop over several days, such a week or more, 10 days or
more, two weeks or more, or a month or more, as a result of little or no
microorganism-cause tumor cell death. In some exemplary methods, the
microorganisms or cells can be present in the tumor, and can cause an
anti-tumor response without the microorganism or cell itself causing
enough tumor cell death to prevent tumor growth.
[0669]Also provided herein are methods for inhibiting tumor growth in a
subject, where the methods include administering to a subject a
microorganism or cell that can accumulate in a tumor and/or metastasis,
and/or can cause or enhance an anti-tumor response. The anti-tumor
response induced as a result of tumor or metastases-accumulated
microorganisms or cells can result in inhibition of tumor growth,
shrinkage and/or elimination of the tumor.
[0670]Also provided herein are methods for delaying or inhibiting growth
or formation of a metastasis in a subject, where the methods include
administering to a subject a microorganism or cell that can accumulate in
a tumor and/or metastasis, and/or can cause or enhance an anti-tumor
response. The anti-tumor response induced as a result of tumor or
metastasis-accumulated microorganisms or cells can result in inhibition
of metastasis growth or formation.
[0671]Also provided herein are methods for decreasing the size of a tumor
and/or metastasis in a subject, where the methods include administering
to a subject a microorganism or cell that can accumulate in a tumor
and/or metastasis, and can cause or enhance an anti-tumor response. The
anti-tumor response induced as a result of tumor or
metastasis-accumulated microorganisms or cells can result in a decrease
in the size of the tumor and/or metastasis. The administered
microorganisms can posses one or more characteristics including
attenuated pathogenicity, low toxicity, preferential accumulation in
tumors, increased ability to capture, transport and or store iron,
immunogenicity, replication competence, an ability to express or
over-express exogenous genes, an ability to over-express endogenous
genes, an inactivation/deletion of an endogenous gene(s) and an ability
to bind ligands.
[0672]Also provided herein are methods for eliminating a tumor and/or
metastasis from a subject, where the methods include administering to a
subject microorganisms or cells that can accumulate in a tumor and/or
metastasis, and can cause or enhance an anti-tumor response. The
anti-tumor response induced as a result of tumor or
metastasis-accumulated microorganisms or cells can result in elimination
of the tumor and/or metastasis from the subject. The administered
microorganisms or cells can posses one or more characteristics including
attenuated pathogenicity, low toxicity, preferential accumulation in
tumors, increased ability to capture, transport and or store iron,
immunogenicity, replication competence, an ability to express or
over-express exogenous genes, an ability to over-express endogenous
genes, an inactivation/deletion of an endogenous gene(s) and an ability
to bind ligands.
[0673]Methods of reducing inhibiting tumor growth, inhibiting metastasis
growth and/or formation, decreasing the size of a tumor or metastasis,
eliminating a tumor or metastasis, or other tumor therapeutic methods
provided herein include causing or enhancing an anti-tumor response in
the host, depleting a vital nutrient (e.g., iron) from the tumor
environment, or delivering a therapeutic agent to the tumor. The response
of the host, being anti-tumor in nature, can be mounted against tumors
and/or metastases in which microorganisms or cells have accumulated, and
can also be mounted against tumors and/or metastases in which
microorganisms or cells have not accumulated, including tumors and/or
metastases that form after administration of the microorganisms or cells
to the subject. Accordingly, a tumor and/or metastasis whose growth or
formation is inhibited, or whose size is decreased, or that is
eliminated, can be a tumor and/or metastasis in which the microorganisms
or cells have accumulated, or also can be a tumor and/or metastasis in
which the microorganisms or cells have not accumulated. Accordingly,
provided herein are methods of reducing inhibiting tumor growth,
inhibiting metastasis growth and/or formation, decreasing the size of a
tumor or metastasis, eliminating a tumor or metastasis, or other tumor
therapeutic methods, where the method includes administering to a subject
a microorganism, where the microorganism or cell accumulates in at least
one tumor or metastasis and causes or enhances an anti-tumor response in
the subject, and the response also is mounted against a tumor and/or
metastasis in which the microorganism or cell did not accumulate. In
another embodiment, methods are provided for inhibiting or preventing
recurrence of a neoplastic disease or inhibiting or preventing new tumor
growth, where the methods include administering to a subject a
microorganism or cell that can accumulate in a tumor and/or metastasis,
and can cause or enhance an anti-tumor response, and the anti-tumor
response can inhibit or prevent recurrence of a neoplastic disease or
inhibit or prevent new tumor growth.
[0674]Also provided herein are methods for inhibiting tumor growth in a
subject, where the methods include administering to a subject a
microorganism or cell that can accumulate in a tumor and/or metastasis,
and/or can cause lysis of the tumor cells and an immune response is
elicited to the lysed tumor components. The anti-tumor immune response
induced as a result of lysed tumor components can result in, or enhance,
inhibition of tumor growth, shrinkage and/or elimination of the tumor.
[0675]The tumor or neoplastic disease therapeutic methods provided herein,
such as methods of reducing inhibiting tumor growth, inhibiting
metastasis growth and/or formation, decreasing the size of a tumor or
metastasis, eliminating a tumor or metastasis, or other tumor therapeutic
methods, also can include administering to a subject a microorganism or
cell that can cause tumor cell lysis or tumor cell death, that can bind a
ligand that cause tumor cell lysis or tumor cell death, or deplete a
vital nutrient from the tumor environment. Such a microorganism or cell
can be the same microorganism or cell as the microorganism or cell that
can cause or enhance an anti-tumor response in the subject.
Microorganisms and cells, such as the microorganisms and cells provided
herein, can cause cell lysis or tumor cell death. Additionally, the
microorganisms and cells provided herein, can cause cell lysis or tumor
cell death as a result of expression of iron sequestration or binding of
a compound that sequesters iron or carries a therapeutic agent,
expression of a toxin, enzyme, etc.
[0676]1. Selection of Bacteria
[0677]Bacteria can be used in the methods provided herein. Any of a
variety of bacteria possessing the desired characteristics can be used.
[0678]It has been determined that facultative aerobic bacteria can survive
and grow in tumors. Accordingly, a bacteria used in the methods provided
herein can include a bacteria that can survive and grow in an oxygenated
environment. A variety of bacteria (facultative aerobic and anaerobic)
for use in the methods provided herein are known in the art and include,
but are not limited to, Vibrio species, Lactobacillus species,
Streptococcus species, Escherichia species, Listeria species, Salmonella
species, Clostridium species, Shigella species, and Bacillus species.
Exemplary bacteria include, but are not limited to Vibrio cholerae, V.
cholerae CVD-HgR, Escherichia coli, E. coli DH5a, E. coli Nissle 1917,
Bacillus subtilis, Shigella flexneri, EIEC, Streptococcus pyogenes,
Listeria monocytogenes, Salmonella typhimurium, Clostridium histolyticus,
Clostridium butyricum, Bifodobacterium longum, Bifodobacterium
adolescentis, Clavibacter michiganensis subsp. michiganensis,
Agrobacterium tumefaciens, Erwinia herbicola, Azorhisobium caulinodans,
Xanthomonas campestris pv. vesicatoria, and Xanthomonas campestris pv.
campestris. Exemplary bacteria used in the methods provided herein are
the E. coli Nissle 1917 bacteria (Grozdanov et al. (2004) Journal of
Bacteriology 186(16):5432-5441; Nissle 1917 nucleic acid sequence for
Genomic Islands I-III: SEQ ID NOS:12-14)
[0679]Bacteria used in the anti-tumor therapies can be modified using any
of the techniques described herein. Modified bacteria exhibit one or more
enhanced characteristics relative to the wild-type bacteria. Such
characteristics can include, but are not limited to, attenuated
pathogenicity, decreased or increased toxicity, preferential accumulation
in tumor, increased of increased ability to capture, transport or store
iron, increased or decreased replication competence, enhanced or reduced
capacity to express endogenous polypeptides, ability to express exogenous
proteins, ability to induce expression of target genes with an exogenous
signal, and combinations thereof. In other embodiments, the bacteria can
be further modified to express one or more detectable genes, including
genes that can be used for imaging.
[0680]The tumor-colonizing capability of a variety of bacteria can be
directly measured by injecting bacteria into appropriate tumor-bearing
animal models and the tumors assessed for colonization. Additionally,
specificity of the bacteria to localize to the tumors compared to
non-tumorous tissues can be measured.
[0681]2. Administration
[0682]In performing the methods provided herein, a microorganism or cell
can be administered to a subject, including a subject having a tumor, a
metastasis, neoplastic cells, or a subject to be immunized. An
administered microorganism or cell can be a microorganism or cell
provided herein or any other microorganism or cell known for
administration to a subject, for example, any known microorganism or cell
known for therapeutic administration to a subject, including antigenic
microorganisms such as any microorganism or cell known to be used for
vaccination. In some embodiments, the microorganism or cell administered
is a microorganism or cell having one or more characteristics including
attenuated pathogenicity, low toxicity, preferential accumulation in
tumors, increased ability to capture, transport and or store iron,
immunogenicity, replication competence, an ability to express or
over-express exogenous genes, an ability to over-express endogenous
genes, an inactivation/deletion of endogenous genes and an ability to
bind ligands.
[0683]a. Steps Prior to Administering the Microorganism
[0684]In some embodiments, one or more steps can be performed prior to
administration of the microorganism or cell to the subject. Any of a
variety of preceding steps can be performed, including, but not limited
to, diagnosing the subject with a condition appropriate for
microorganismal administration, determining the immunocompetence of the
subject, immunizing the subject, treating the subject with a
chemotherapeutic agent, treating the subject with radiation, or
surgically treating the subject.
[0685]For embodiments that include administering a microorganism or cell
to a tumor-bearing subject for therapeutic purposes, the subject has
typically been previously diagnosed with a neoplastic condition.
Diagnostic methods also can include determining the type of neoplastic
condition, determining the stage of the neoplastic conditions,
determining the size of one or more tumors in the subject, determining
the presence or absence of metastatic or neoplastic cells in the lymph
nodes of the subject, or determining the presence of metastases of the
subject. Some embodiments of therapeutic methods for administering a
microorganism or cell to a subject can include a step of determination of
the size of the primary tumor or the stage of the neoplastic disease, and
if the size of the primary tumor is equal to or above a threshold volume,
or if the stage of the neoplastic disease is at or above a threshold
stage, a microorganism or cell is administered to the subject. In a
similar embodiment, if the size of the primary tumor is below a threshold
volume, or if the stage of the neoplastic disease is at or below a
threshold stage, the microorganism or cell is not yet administered to the
subject; such methods can include monitoring the subject until the tumor
size or neoplastic disease stage reaches a threshold amount, and then
administering the microorganism or cell to the subject. Threshold sizes
can vary according to several factors, including rate of growth of the
tumor, ability of the microorganism to infect a tumor, and
immunocompetence of the subject. Generally the threshold size will be a
size sufficient for a microorganism or cell to accumulate and replicate
in or near the tumor without being completely removed by the host's
immune system, and will typically also be a size sufficient to sustain a
microorganismal infection for a time long enough for the host to mount an
immune response against the tumor cells, typically about one week or
more, about ten days or more, or about two weeks or more. Threshold
neoplastic disease stages also can vary according to several factors,
including specific requirement for staging a particular neoplastic
disease, aggressiveness of growth of the neoplastic disease, ability of
the microorganism to infect a tumor or metastasis, and immunocompetence
of the subject. Generally the threshold stage will be a stage sufficient
for a microorganism to accumulate and replicate in a tumor or metastasis
without being completely removed by the host's immune system, and will
typically also be a size sufficient to sustain a microorganismal
infection for a time long enough for the host to mount an immune response
against the neoplastic cells, typically about one week or more, about ten
days or more, or about two weeks or more. Exemplary threshold stages are
any stage beyond the lowest stage (e.g., Stage I or equivalent), or any
stage where the primary tumor is larger than a threshold size, or any
stage where metastatic cells are detected.
[0686]In another embodiment, the subject can have administered thereto a
microorganism or cell without any previous steps of cancer treatment such
as chemotherapy, radiation therapy or surgical removal of a tumor and/or
metastases. The methods provided herein take advantage of the ability of
the microorganisms or cells to enter or localize near a tumor, where the
tumor cells can be protected from the subject's immune system; the
microorganisms or cells can then proliferate in such an immunoprotected
region and can deplete the tumor of iron, or bind a ligand conjugated to
a therapeutic agent. Provided herein are methods of treating a tumor,
metastases or neoplastic disease in which microorganisms or cells are
administered to a subject with a tumor or neoplastic disease without
removing the primary tumor, or to a subject with a tumor or neoplastic
disease in which at least some tumors or neoplastic cells are
intentionally permitted to remain in the subject.
[0687]In some cancer treatment methods, such as chemotherapy or radiation
therapy, such methods typically have a side effect of weakening the
subject's immune system. This treatment of a subject by chemotherapy or
radiation therapy can reduce the subject's ability to mount an anti-tumor
immune response. Thus, for example, provided herein are methods of
treating a tumor or neoplastic disease in which microorganisms or cells
are administered to a subject with a tumor or neoplastic disease without
treating the subject with an immune system-weakening therapy, such as
chemotherapy or radiation therapy.
[0688]In an alternative embodiment, prior to administration of a
microorganism or cell to the subject, the subject can be treated in one
or more cancer treatment steps that do not remove the primary tumor or
that do not weaken the immune system of the subject. A variety of more
sophisticated cancer treatment methods are being developed in which the
tumor can be treated without surgical removal or immune-system weakening
therapy. Exemplary methods include administering a compound that
decreases the rate of proliferation of the tumor or neoplastic cells
without weakening the immune system (e.g., by administering tumor
suppressor compounds or by administering tumor cell-specific compounds)
or administering an angiogenesis-inhibiting compound. Thus, combined
methods that include administering a microorganism or cell to a subject
can further improve cancer therapy. Thus, provided herein are methods of
administering a microorganism or cell to a subject, along with prior to
or subsequent to, for example, administering a compound that slows tumor
growth without weakening the subject's immune system or a compound that
inhibits vascularization of the tumor.
[0689]b. Mode of Administration
[0690]Any mode of administration of a microorganism or cell to a subject
can be used, provided the mode of administration permits the
microorganism or cell to enter a tumor or metastasis. Modes of
administration can include, but are not limited to, intravenous,
intraperitoneal, subcutaneous, intramuscular, topical, intratumor,
multipuncture (e.g., as used with smallpox vaccines), inhalation,
intranasal, oral, intracavity (e.g., administering to the bladder via a
catheter, administering to the gut by suppository or enema), aural,
ocular, transdermal, subcutaneous, intra-arterial (e.g., hepatic artery
infusion), intravesicular perfusion, or intrapleural administration. One
skilled in the art can select any mode of administration compatible with
the subject and the microorganism, and that also is likely to result in
the microorganism or cell reaching tumors and/or metastases. The route of
administration can be selected by one skilled in the art according to any
of a variety of factors, including the nature of the disease, the kind of
tumor, and the particular microorganism or cell contained in the
pharmaceutical composition. Administration to the target site can be
performed, for example, by ballistic delivery, as a colloidal dispersion
system, or systemic administration can be performed by injection into an
artery, such as the hepatic artery.
[0691]c. Dosage
[0692]The dosage regimen can be any of a variety of methods and amounts,
and can be determined by one skilled in the art according to known
clinical factors. Dosages can be determined empirically by the amount
needed to produce a detectable signal or amount to effect a physiological
response. As is known in the medical arts, dosages for any one patient
can depend on many factors, including the subject's species, size, body
surface area, age, sex, immunocompetence, and general health, the
particular microorganism or cell to be administered, duration and route
of administration, the kind and stage of the disease, for example, tumor
size, and other compounds such as drugs being administered concurrently.
Exemplary routes of administration, such as topical, local or systemic
administration can differ in the dosage given. For example, dosages for
injections intravenously, intraperitoneally, or intratumorally can
differ. Thus, dosages delivered directly into a tumor (i.e., intratumoral
injection) can be administered at lower effective dosages. In addition to
the above factors, such levels can be affected by the infectivity of the
microorganism, and the nature of the microorganism, as can be determined
by one skilled in the art. At least some of the viruses used the in the
methods provided herein can be more infectious than the bacteria used
herein. Thus, in some embodiments of the present methods, virus can be
administered at lower levels than bacteria. In the present methods,
appropriate minimum dosage levels of microorganisms or cells can be
levels sufficient for the microorganism or cell to survive, grow and
replicate in a tumor or metastasis. Appropriate maximum dosage levels of
microorganisms or cells can be levels that are not toxic to the host,
levels that do not cause splenomegaly of 3.times. or more, levels that do
not result in colonies or plaques in normal tissues or organs after about
1 day or after about 3 days or after about 7 days. Exemplary levels for
administering a bacterium to a 65 kg human can include 1.times.10.sup.3
or about 1.times.10.sup.3 cfu colony forming units (cfu),
1.times.10.sup.4 or about 1.times.10.sup.5 cfu, 1.times.10.sup.4 or about
1.times.10.sup.5 cfu, 1.times.10.sup.6 or about 1.times.10.sup.6 cfu,
1.times.10.sup.7 or about 1.times.10.sup.7 cfu, 5.times.10.sup.7 or about
5.times.10.sup.7 cfu, 1.times.10.sup.8 or about 1.times.10.sup.8 cfu,
1.times.10.sup.9 or about 1.times.10.sup.9 cfu, 1.times.10.sup.10 or
about 1.times.10.sup.10 pfu, 5.times.10.sup.10 or about 5.times.10.sup.10
pfu, 1.times.10.sup.11 or about 1.times.10.sup.11 pfu, 5.times.10.sup.11
or about 5.times.10.sup.11 cfu, or more cfu. Dosages injected
intratumorally can be lower, for example, 100 cfu or more. Exemplary
dosages for administering a virus to a 65 kg human can include
5.times.10.sup.5 or about 5.times.10.sup.5 plaque forming units (pfu),
1.times.10.sup.6 or about 1.times.10.sup.6 pfu, 5.times.10.sup.6 or about
5.times.10.sup.6 pfu, 1.times.10.sup.7 or about 1.times.10.sup.7 pfu,
1.times.10.sup.8 or about 1.times.10.sup.8 pfu, 1.times.10.sup.9 pfu or
about 1.times.10.sup.9 pfu, 5.times.10.sup.9 or about 5.times.10.sup.9
pfu, 1.times.10.sup.10 or about 1.times.10.sup.10 pfu, or
5.times.10.sup.10 or about 5.times.10.sup.10 pfu, or more pfu.
[0693]d. Number of Administrations
[0694]The methods provided herein can include a single administration of a
microorganism or cell to a subject or multiple administrations of a
microorganism or cell to a subject. In some embodiments, a single
administration is sufficient to establish a microorganism or cell in a
tumor, where the microorganism or cell can proliferate and can cause or
enhance an anti-tumor response in the subject; such methods do not
require additional administrations of a microorganism or cell in order to
cause or enhance an anti-tumor response in a subject, which can result,
for example in inhibition of tumor growth, inhibition of metastasis
growth or formation, reduction in tumor or metastasis size, elimination
of a tumor or metastasis, inhibition or prevention of recurrence of a
neoplastic disease or new tumor formation, or other cancer therapeutic
effects. In other embodiments, a microorganism or cell can be
administered on different occasions, separated in time, typically, by at
least one day. Separate administrations can increase the locations on a
tumor or metastasis where microorganism or cell proliferation can occur
or can otherwise increase the titer of microorganism or cell accumulated
in the tumor, and also can, optionally, increase the level of
microorganism-based tumor lysis or tumor cell death. Separate
administrations of a microorganism or cell can further extend a subject's
immune response against microorganismal antigens, which can extend the
host's immune response to tumors or metastases in which microorganisms or
cells have accumulated, and can increase the likelihood a host mounting
an anti-tumor immune response.
[0695]When separate administrations are performed, each administration can
be a dosage amount that is the same or different relative to other
administration dosage amounts. In one embodiment, all administration
dosage amounts are the same. In other embodiments, a first dosage amount
can be a larger dosage amounts than one or more subsequent dosage
amounts, for example, at least 10.times. larger, at least 100.times.
larger, or at least 1000.times. larger than subsequent dosage amounts. In
one example of a method of separate administrations in which the first
dosage amount is greater than one or more subsequent dosage amounts, all
subsequent dosage amounts can be the same, smaller amount relative to the
first administration.
[0696]Separate administrations can include any number of two or more
administrations, including two, three, four, five or six administrations.
One skilled in the art can readily determine the number of
administrations to perform or the desirability of performing one or more
additional administrations according to methods known in the art for
monitoring therapeutic methods and other monitoring methods provided
herein. Accordingly, the methods provided herein include methods of
providing to the subject one or more administrations of a microorganism,
where the number of administrations can be determined by monitoring the
subject, and, based on the results of the monitoring, determining whether
or not to provide one or more additional administrations. Deciding of
whether or not to provide one or more additional administrations can be
based on a variety of monitoring results, including, but not limited to,
indication of tumor growth or inhibition of tumor growth, appearance of
new metastases or inhibition of metastasis, the subject's
anti-microorganism or cell antibody titer, the subject's anti-tumor
antibody titer, the overall health of the subject, the weight of the
subject, the presence of microorganism or cell solely in tumor and/or
metastases, the presence of microorganism or cell in normal tissues or
organs.
[0697]The time period between administrations can be any of a variety of
time periods. The time period between administrations can be a function
of any of a variety of factors, including monitoring steps, as described
in relation to the number of administrations, the time period for a
subject to mount an immune response, the time period for a subject to
clear microorganism or cell from normal tissue, or the time period for
microorganismal proliferation in the tumor or metastasis. In one example,
the time period can be a function of the time period for a subject to
mount an immune response; for example, the time period can be more than
the time period for a subject to mount an immune response, such as more
than about one week, more than about ten days, more than about two weeks,
or more than about a month; in another example, the time period can be
less than the time period for a subject to mount an immune response, such
as less than about one week, less than about ten days, less than about
two weeks, or less than about a month. In another example, the time
period can be a function of the time period for a subject to clear
microorganism or cell from normal tissue; for example, the time period
can be more than the time period for a subject to clear microorganism or
cell from normal tissue, such as more than about a day, more than about
two days, more than about three days, more than about five days, or more
than about a week. In another example, the time period can be a function
of the time period for microorganismal proliferation in the tumor or
metastasis; for example, the time period can be more than the amount of
time for a detectable signal to arise in a tumor or metastasis after
administration of a microorganism or cell expressing a detectable marker,
such as about 3 days, about 5 days, about a week, about ten days, about
two weeks, or about a month.
[0698]3. Co-administrations
[0699]Also provided are methods in which an additional therapeutic
substance, such as a different therapeutic microorganism or cell or a
therapeutic compound is administered. In some embodiments, the additional
therapeutic substance is, for example, a siderophore, an antibody, a
peptide, a protein (e.g., lactoferrin, transferrin, etc.), a molecule for
induction of gene expression (e.g., arabinose), a nanoparticle, another
therapeutic microorganism or cell or any other compound provided herein
that can be administered as a therapeutic composition. These can be
administered simultaneously, sequentially or intermittently with the
first microorganism. The additional therapeutic substance can interact
with the microorganism or cell or a gene product thereof, or the
additional therapeutic substance can act independently of the
microorganism. Any mode of administration of a microorganism or cell to a
subject can be used, provided the mode of administration permits the
microorganism or cell to enter a tumor or metastasis.
[0700]Modes of administration for a co-administered substance can be the
same mode of administration as the microorganism or cell or can be via a
different mode of administration. Modes of administration can include,
but are not limited to, intravenous, intraperitoneal, subcutaneous,
intramuscular, topical, intratumor, multipuncture, inhalation,
intranasal, oral, intracavity (e.g., administering to the bladder via a
catheter, administering to the gut by suppository or enema), aural,
ocular, transdermal, subcutaneous, intra-arterial (e.g., hepatic artery
infusion), intravesicular perfusion, or intrapleural administration. One
skilled in the art can select any mode of administration compatible with
the subject and the microorganism or cell, and that also is likely to
result in the co-administered substance reaching the microorganism or
cell or tumors and/or metastases. The route of administration can be
selected by one skilled in the art according to any of a variety of
factors, including the nature of the disease, the kind of tumor, and the
particular microorganism or cell contained in the pharmaceutical
composition. Administration to the target site can be performed, for
example, by ballistic delivery, as a colloidal dispersion system, or
systemic administration can be performed by injection into an artery,
such as the hepatic artery. In one non-limiting example provided herein a
co-administered molecule, such as arabinose for the induction of gene
expression, is administered by intravenous injection or provided orally.
[0701]a. Other Therapeutic Agents, Compounds and Gene Products
[0702]The methods can include administering one or more therapeutic
compounds to the subject in addition to administering a microorganism or
cell or plurality thereof to a subject. Therapeutic compounds can act
independently, or in conjunction with the microorganism, for tumor
therapeutic affects. Therapeutic compounds that can act independently
include any of a variety of known chemotherapeutic compounds that can
inhibit tumor growth, inhibit metastasis growth and/or formation,
decrease the size of a tumor or metastasis, eliminate a tumor or
metastasis, without reducing the ability of a microorganism or cell to
accumulate in a tumor, replicate in the tumor, and cause or enhance an
anti-tumor immune response in the subject.
[0703]Therapeutic compounds that act in conjunction with the
microorganisms or cells include, for example, compounds that alter the
expression of the microorganism or cell or compounds that can interact
with a microorganism-expressed gene and/or gene product, or compounds
that can inhibit microorganismal proliferation, including compounds toxic
to the microorganism. Therapeutic compounds that can act in conjunction
with the microorganism or cell include, for example, therapeutic
compounds that increase the proliferation, toxicity, tumor cell killing,
or immune response eliciting properties of a microorganism, and also can
include, for example, therapeutic compounds that decrease the
proliferation, toxicity, immune response-eliciting, or cell killing
properties of a microorganism. Thus, provided herein are methods of
administering to a subject one or more therapeutic compounds that can act
in conjunction with the microorganism or cell to increase the
proliferation, toxicity, tumor cell killing, or immune response eliciting
properties of a microorganism. Also provided herein are methods of
administering to a subject one or more therapeutic compounds that can act
in conjunction with the microorganism or cell to decrease the
proliferation, toxicity, immune response-eliciting, or cell killing
properties of a microorganism.
[0704]Also provided herein are pharmaceutical compositions containing a
microorganism or cell as described above, wherein the microorganism or
cell furthermore contains one or more expressible DNA sequence(s)
encoding (a) protein(s) or a functional RNA suitable for tumor therapy
and/or elimination of metastatic tumors, such as a cytotoxic protein, a
cytostatic protein, a protein inhibiting angiogenesis, or a protein
stimulating apoptosis. Such proteins are well-known to the person skilled
in the art. Exemplary therapeutic proteins include, but are not limited
to, a cell-surface receptor, a cytokine, a chemokine, an apoptotic
protein, an antimitotic oligopeptide, a toxin, a tumor antigen, a prodrug
converting enzyme), an RNA (e.g., ribozyme, RNAi, siRNA), or a compound
that is generated by an encoded polypeptide and, in some examples, the
cellular machinery of the tumor or immunoprivileged tissue or cells
(e.g., a metabolite, a converted prodrug).
[0705]Therapeutic agents that can be administered to the subject in
addition to administering a microorganism or cell or plurality thereof to
a subject can be, for example, an anti-cancer agents including, but are
not limited to, cytokines, growth factors, photosensitizing agents,
radionuclides, toxins, anti-metabolites, signaling modulators,
anti-cancer antibiotics, anti-cancer antibodies, angiogenesis inhibitors,
radiation therapy, chemotherapeutic compounds or a combination thereof.
[0706]Exemplary cytokines and growth factors include, for example,
interleukins, such as interleukin-1, interleukin-2, interleukin-6 and/or
interleukin-12, tumor necrosis factors, such as tumor necrosis factor
alpha (TNF-.alpha.), interferons such as interferon gamma (IFN-.gamma.),
granulocyte macrophage colony stimulating factor (GM-CSF), angiogenins,
and a tissue factors.
[0707]Exemplary photosensitizing agents include, for example, indocyanine
green, toluidine blue, aminolevulinic acid, texaphyrins, benzoporphyrins,
phenothiazines, phthalocyanines, porphyrins, such as sodium porfimer,
chlorins, such as tetra(m-hydroxyphenyl)chlorin or tin(IV) chlorin e6,
purpurins, such as tin ethyl etiopurpurin, purpurinimides,
bacteriochlorins, pheophorbides, a pyropheophorbides and cationic dyes.
[0708]Exemplary radionuclides include, for example, .sup.11Carbon,
.sup.11Fluorine, .sup.13Carbon, .sup.13Nitrogen, .sup.15Nitrogen,
.sup.15Oxygen, .sup.18Flourine, .sup.19Flourine, .sup.24Sodium,
.sup.32Phosphate, .sup.42Potassium, .sup.51Chromium, .sup.55Iron,
.sup.59Iron, .sup.57Cobalt, .sup.60Cobalt, .sup.64Copper, .sup.67Gallium,
.sup.68Gallium, .sup.75Selenium, .sup.81Krypton, .sup.82Rubidium,
.sup.89Strontium, .sup.92Strontium, .sup.90Yttirum, .sup.99Technetium,
.sup.103 Palladium, .sup.106Ruthenium, .sup.111Indium, .sup.117Lutetium,
.sup.123Iodine, .sup.125Iodine, 131Iodine, .sup.133Xenon, .sup.137Cesium,
.sup.153Samarium, .sup.153 Gadolinium, .sup.165Dysprosium,
.sup.166Holmium, .sup.169Ytterbium, .sup.177Leutium .sup.186Rhenium,
.sup.188Rhenium, .sup.192Iridium, .sup.198Gold, .sup.201Thallium,
.sup.211Astatine, .sup.212Bismuth or .sup.213Bismuth.
[0709]Exemplary toxins include, for example, 5-fluorouridine,
calicheamicin and maytansine.
[0710]Exemplary anti-metabolites include, for example, methotrexate,
5-fluorouracil, 6-mercaptopurine, cytosine arabinoside, hydroxyurea and
20-chlorodeoxyadenosine.
[0711]Exemplary signaling modulators include, for example, an inhibitors
of macrophage inhibitory factor, a toll-like receptor agonists and stat 3
inhibitors.
[0712]Exemplary anti-cancer antibiotics include, for example,
anthracyclines, pleomycins, such as pleomycin and peplomycin sulfate,
mitomycins such as mitomycin C, actinomycins such as actinomycin D,
zinostatinstimalamer, polypeptides such as neocarzinostatin, and
anthracyclines, such as doxorubicin hydrochloride (adriamycin),
idarubicin hydrochloride, daunorubicin hydrochloride, aclarubicin
Hydrochloride, epirubicin hydrochloride, and purarubicin hydrochloride.
[0713]Exemplary anti-cancer antibodies include, for example, Rituximab,
ADEPT, Trastuzumab (Herceptin), Tositumomab (Bexxar), Cetuximab
(Erbitux), Ibritumomab (Zevalin), Alemtuzumab (Campath-1H), Epratuzumab
(Lymphocide), Gemtuzumab ozogamicin (Mylotarg) and Bevacimab (Avastin),
Tarceva (Erlotinib), SUTENT (sunitinib malate), Panorex (Edrecolomab),
RITUXAN (Rituximab), Zevalin (90Y-ibritumomab tiuexetan), Mylotarg
(Gemtuzumab Ozogamicin) and Campath (Alemtuzumab).
[0714]Exemplary angiogenesis inhibitors include, for example, collagenase
inhibitors such as metalloproteinases and tetracyclines such as
minocycline, naturally occurring peptides such as endostatin and
angiostatin, fungal and bacterial derivatives, such as fumagillin
derivatives like TNP-470, aptamer antogonist of VEGF batimastat,
Captopril, cartilage derived inhibitor (CDI), genistein, interleukin 12
Lavendustin A, medroxypregesterone acetate, recombinant human platelet
factor 4(rPF4), taxol, D-gluco-D-galactan sulfate (Tecogalan(=SP-PG,
DS4152)), thalidomide, thrombospondin.
[0715]Exemplary radiation therapy includes, but is not limited to,
photodynamic therapy, radionuclides, radioimmunotherapy and proton beam
treatment.
[0716]Exemplary chemotherapeutic compounds provided herein are alkylating
agents such as thiotepa and cyclosphosphamide; alkyl sulfonates such as
busulfan, improsulfan and piposulfan; aziridines such as benzodopa,
carboquone, meturedopa and uredopa; ethylenimines and methylamelamines
including altretamine, triethylenemelamine, trietylenephosphoramide,
triethylenethiophosphaoramide and trimethylolomelamime nitrogen mustards
such as chiorambucil, chlomaphazine, cholophosphamide, estramustine,
ifosfamide, mechlorethamine, mechlorethamine oxide hydrochloride,
melphalan, novembichin, phenesterine, prednimustine, trofosfamide, uracil
mustard; nitrosureas such as carmustine, chlorozotocin, fotemustine,
lomustine, nimustine, ranimustine; antibiotics such as aclacinomysins,
actinomycin, authramycin, azaserine, bleomycins, cactinomycin,
calicheamicin, carabicin, caminomycin, carzinophilin, chromomycins,
dactinomycin, daunorubicin, detorubicin, 6-diazo-5-oxo-L-norleucine,
doxorubicin, epirubicin, esorubicin, idarubicin, marcellomycin,
mitomycins, mycophenolic acid, nogalamycin, olivomycins, peplomycin,
potfiromycin, puromycin, quelamycin, rodorubicin, streptonigrin,
streptozocin, tubercidin, ubenimex, zinostatin, zorubicin;
anti-metabolites such as methotrexate and 5-fluorouracil (5-FU); folic
acid analogues such as denopterin, methotrexate, pteropterin,
trimetrexate; purine analogs such as fludarabine, 6-mercaptopurine,
thiamiprine, thioguanine; pyrimidine analogs such as ancitabine,
azacitidine, 6-azauridine, carmofur, cytarabine, dideoxyuridine,
doxifluridine, enocitabine, floxuridine; androgens such as calusterone,
dromostanolone propionate, epitiostanol, mepitiostane, testolactone;
anti-adrenals such as aminoglutethimide, mitotane, trilostane; folic acid
replenisher such as frolinic acid; aceglatone; aldophosphamide glycoside;
aminolevulinic acid; amsacrine; bestrabucil; bisantrene; edatraxate;
defofamine; demecolcine; diaziquone; elformithine; elliptinium acetate;
etoglucid; gallium nitrate; hydroxyurea; lentinan; lonidamine;
mitoguazone; mitoxantrone; mopidamol; nitracrine; pentostatin; phenamet;
pirarubicin; podophyllinic acid; 2-ethylhydrazide; procarbazine;
polysaccharide-K; razoxane; sizofuran; spirogermanium; tenuazonic acid;
triaziquone; 2,2',2''-trichlorotriethylamine; urethan; vindesine;
dacarbazine; mannomustine; mitobronitol; mitolactol; pipobroman;
gacytosine; cytosine arabinoside; cyclophosphamide; thiotepa; taxoids,
e.g., paclitaxel and doxetaxel; chlorambucil; gemcitabine; 6-thioguanine;
mercaptopurine; methotrexate; platinum analogs such as cisplatin and
carboplatin; vinblastine; platinum; etoposide (VP-16); ifosfamide;
mitomycin C; mitoxantrone; vincristine; vinorelbine; navelbine;
novantrone; teniposide; daunomycin; aminopterin; xeloda; ibandronate;
CPT11; topoisomerase inhibitor RFS 2000; difluoromethylomithine (DMFO);
retinoic acid; esperamicins; capecitabine; and pharmaceutically
acceptable salts, acids or derivatives of any of the above. Also included
in this definition are anti-hormonal agents that act to regulate or
inhibit hormone action on tumors such as anti-estrogens including for
example tamoxifen, raloxifene, aromatase inhibiting 4(5)-imidazoles,
4-hydroxytamoxifen, trioxifene, keoxifene, LY117018, onapristone and
toremifene (Fareston); and antiandrogens such as flutamide, nilutamide,
bicalutamide, leuprolide and goserelin; and pharmaceutically acceptable
salts, acids or derivatives of any of the above. Such chemotherapeutic
compounds that can be used herein include compounds whose toxicities
preclude use of the compound in general systemic chemotherapeutic
methods. Particular exemplary platinum coordination complexes include,
but are not limited to, cisplatin, carboplatin and oxaliplatin.
[0717]In other embodiments, the microorganism or cell can express a
protein that converts a less active compound into a compound that causes
tumor cell death. The protein can be an enzyme converting an inactive
substance (pro-drug) administered to the organism into an active
substance, i.e., toxin, which kills the tumor or metastasis. Exemplary
methods of conversion of such a prodrug compound include enzymatic
conversion and photolytic conversion. For example, the enzyme can be
glucuronidase converting the less toxic form of the chemotherapeutic
agent glucuronyldoxorubicin into a more toxic form. Exemplary prodrugs
include, but are not limited to, 5-fluorouracil, gancyclovir,
6-methylpurine deoxyriboside, cephalosporin-doxorubicin,
4-[(2-chloroethyl)(2-mesuloxyethyl)amino]benzoyl-L-glutamic acid,
indole-3-acetic acid,
7-ethyl-10-[4-(1-piperidino)-1-piperidino]carbonyloxycampotothecin,
bis-(2-chloroethyl)amino-4-hydroxyphenylaminomethanone
28,1-chloromethyl-5-hydroxy-1,2-dihyro-3H-benz[e]indole,
epirubicin-glucoronide, 5'-deoxy5-fluorouridine, cytosine arabinoside,
and linamarin. A large variety of protein/prodrug compound pairs are
known in the art, and include, but are not limited to, Herpes simplex
virus thymidine kinase/gancyclovir, varicella zoster thymidine
kinase/gancyclovir, cytosine deaminase/5-fluorouracil, purine nucleoside
phosphorylase/6-methylpurine deoxyriboside, beta
lactamase/cephalosporin-doxorubicin, carboxypeptidase
G2/4-[(2-chloroethyl)(2-mesuloxyethyl)amino]benzoyl-L-glutamic acid,
cytochrome P450/acetominophen, horseradish peroxidase/indole-3-acetic
acid, nitroreductase/CB1954, rabbit
carboxylesterase/7-ethyl-10-[4-(1-piperidino)-1-piperidino]carbonyloxycam-
potothecin, mushroom
tyrosinase/bis-(2-chloroethyl)amino-4-hydroxyphenylaminomethanone 28,
beta galactosidase/1-chloromethyl-5-hydroxy-1,2-dihyro-3H-benz[e]indole,
beta glucuronidase/epirubicin-glucoronide, thymidine
phosphorylase/5'-deoxy-5-fluorouridine, deoxycytidine kinase/cytosine
arabinoside, beta-lactamase and linamerase/linamarin.
[0718]In a particular example, the gene encoding the prodrug converting
enzyme is directed by a promoter which is inducible additionally ensuring
that the conversion of the pro-drug into the toxin only occurs in the
target tissue, i.e., tumor. Such promoters include, for example, IPTG-,
antibiotic-, heat-, pH-, light-, metal-, aerobic-, host cell-, drug-,
cell cycle-, sugar (e.g., arabinose, xylose, etc.) or tissue
specific-inducible promoters.
[0719]Additional examples of suitable therapeutic proteins are human
endostatin and the chimeric PE37/TGF-alpha fusion protein. Endostatin is
a carboxyterminal peptide of collagen XVIII which has been characterized
(Ding et al. (1998) PNAS USA 95:10443). It has been shown that endostatin
inhibits endothelial cell proliferation and migration, induces G1 arrest
and apoptosis of endothelial cells in vitro, and has anti-tumor effect in
a variety of tumor models. Intravenous or intramuscular injection of
viral DNA and cationic liposome-complexed plasmid DNA encoding endostatin
result in limited expression levels of endostatin in tumors. However
intratumoral injection of purified endostatin shows remarkable inhibition
of tumor growth. Pseudomonas exotoxin (PE) is a bacterial toxin secreted
by Pseudomonas aeruginosa. PE elicits its cytotoxic effect by
inactivating elongation factor 2 (EF-2), which results in blocking of
protein synthesis in mammalian cells. Single chain PE is functionally
divided into three domains: domain Ia is required for binding to cell
surface receptor, domain II is required for translocating the toxin into
the target cell cytosol and domain III is responsible for cytotoxicity by
inactivating EF-2. PE40 is derived from wild type Pseudomonas exotoxin
that lacks the binding domain Ia. Other proteins such as antibody
fragments or protein ligands can be inserted in place of the binding
domain. This will render the PE40-ligand fusion protein specific to its
receptor. One of the highly specific engineered chimeric toxins is the
TGF alpha/PE40 fusion protein, where the C-terminus of TGF alpha
polypeptide has been fused in frame with the N-terminus of the PE40
protein. TGF alpha is one of the ligands of epidermal growth factor
receptor (EGFR), which has been shown to be preferentially expressed on
the surface of a variety of tumor cells. TGF alpha-PE40 fusion protein
has been shown to be highly toxic to tumor cells with elevated EGFRs on
the cell surface and while it is less toxic to nearby cells displaying
fewer numbers of surface EGFR. The toxicity of TGF alpha-PE40 chimeric
protein is dependent on a proteolytic processing step to convert the
chimeric protein into its active form, which is carried out by the
target. To overcome the requirement for proteolysis, a new chimeric toxin
protein that does not require processing has been constructed by Theuer
et al. (1992) J. Biol. Chem. 267:16872. The novel fusion protein is
termed PE37/TGF alpha, which exhibited higher toxicity to tumor cells
than the TGF alpha-PE40 fusion protein. Thus, in one embodiment of the
pharmaceutical composition, the protein suitable for tumor therapy is
endostatin (for inhibition of tumor growth) or recombinant chimeric toxin
PE37/transforming growth factor alpha (TGF-alpha) (for cytotoxicity to
tumor cells).
[0720]Moreover, the delivery system of the present application even allows
the application of compounds which could so far not be used for tumor
therapy due to their high toxicity when systemically applied. Such
compounds include proteins inhibiting elongation factors, proteins
binding to ribosomal subunits, proteins modifying nucleotides, nucleases,
proteases or cytokines (e.g., IL-2, IL-12 etc.), since experimental data
suggest that the local release of cytokines might have a positive effect
on the immunosuppressive status of the tumor.
[0721]b. Therapeutic Gene Product Expression
[0722]The microorganisms and cells provided herein can express one or more
genes whose products cause cell death or whose products cause an
anti-tumor immune response; such genes can be considered therapeutic
genes. A variety of therapeutic gene products, such as toxic or apoptotic
proteins, or siRNA, are known in the art, and can be used with the
viruses provided herein. The therapeutic genes can act by directly
killing the host cell, for example, as a channel-forming or other lytic
protein, or by triggering apoptosis, or by inhibiting essential cellular
processes, or by triggering an immune response against the cell, or by
interacting with a compound that has a similar effect, for example, by
converting a less active compound to a cytotoxic compound. A large number
of therapeutic proteins that can be expressed for tumor treatment are
known in the art, including, but not limited to, tumor suppressors,
toxins, cytostatic proteins and costimulatory molecules such as cytokines
and chemokines. Costimulatory molecules for the methods provided herein
include any molecules which are capable of enhancing immune responses to
an antigen/pathogen in vivo and/or in vitro. Costimulatory molecules also
encompass any molecules which promote the activation, proliferation,
differentiation, maturation or maintenance of lymphocytes and/or other
cells whose function is important or essential for immune responses. An
exemplary, non-limiting list of therapeutic proteins includes WT1, p53,
p16, Rb, BRCA1, cystic fibrosis transmembrane regulator (CFTR), Factor
VIII, low density lipoprotein receptor, beta-galactosidase,
alpha-galactosidase, beta-glucocerebrosidase, insulin, parathyroid
hormone, alpha-1-antitrypsin, rsCD40L, Fas-ligand, TRAIL, TNF,
antibodies, microcin E492, diphtheria toxin, Pseudomonas exotoxin,
Escherichia coli Shig toxin, Escherichia coli Verotoxin 1, and
hyperforin. Exemplary cytokines include, but are not limited to,
chemokines and classical cytokines, such as the interleukins, including
for example, interleukin-1, interleukin-2, interleukin-6 and
interleukin-12, tumor necrosis factors, such as tumor necrosis factor
alpha (TNF-.alpha.), interferons such as interferon gamma (IFN-.gamma.),
granulocyte macrophage colony stimulating factor (GM-CSF) and exemplary
chemokines inc